Manual ProSteel
Manual ProSteel
C.Trinkner / G.Griesing
C. Trinkner
Table of content
Table of content
A
INTRODUCTION
A.1
General Information
A.1.1
A.1.2
13
15
15
17
A.2
Language Selection
19
A.3
Dialog Framework
21
A.3.1
A.3.2
A.3.3
A.3.4
A.3.5
A.4
Input Options
A.4.1
A.4.2
A.4.3
A.5
Project Manager
A.5.1
A.5.2
A.6
Global Settings
21
24
29
30
31
33
33
34
35
39
40
42
45
83
B.1
Layer Functions
85
B.2
Construction Utilities
89
B.2.1
B.2.2
Construction lines
Measure of distances
89
94
Table of content
B.3
B.3.1
B.3.2
B.3.3
B.3.4
B.3.5
B.3.6
B.3.7
B.4
B.4.1
B.4.2
B.4.3
B.4.4
B.4.5
B.4.6
B.4.7
B.5
B.5.1
B.5.2
B.5.3
B.5.4
B.5.5
B.5.6
B.5.7
B.6
B.6.1
B.6.2
B.6.3
B.6.4
B.6.5
B.6.6
B.6.7
B.6.8
B.6.9
B.7
3D Object Views
Object View / Object-UCS
Surface View / Surface-UCS
Global View
Top View
Free View
Cutting Plane
Perspective View
Work Frames
Rectangular Work Frame
Cylindrical Work Frame
Wedge-Shaped Work Frame
Pyramidal Work Frame
Create Views
Axes Names
Additional Axes (Border Lines)
Options
User-defined Blocks
Choose View
95
95
97
98
99
100
101
103
107
108
109
110
111
113
115
116
117
117
119
120
122
123
127
129
133
134
138
139
140
141
143
146
147
149
151
Table of content
B.8
Insert Shapes
B.8.1
B.8.2
B.8.3
B.8.4
B.8.5
B.8.6
B.8.7
B.9
Straight Shapes
Bent Shapes
Additional Settings
Shape Series
Shape Segment
Girder Position
Automatic Insertion
Insert Plates
B.9.1
B.9.2
B.9.3
B.9.4
B.9.5
153
154
160
161
163
165
167
169
173
173
178
179
180
185
B.10
Insert Solids
187
B.11
3D-Modifications
191
B.11.1
B.11.2
B.11.3
B.11.4
B.11.5
B.11.6
B.11.7
B.12
Plate Editor
B.12.1
B.12.2
B.12.3
B.13
Bolts
B.14.1
B.14.2
B.14.3
B.14.4
B.15
Boolean Operations
Chamfer / Rounding Off
Edge Processing
B.13.1
B.13.2
B.13.3
B.14
Divide / Combine
Modify Shapes
Modify Plates
Wall Processing
Additional Settings
Notch betwen two Shapes
Boolean Operations
Bolting parts
Bolt Style Management
Insertion of Threaded Rods
Sort
Insert Stiffeners
192
202
205
207
209
211
220
223
224
226
228
231
232
236
238
243
244
246
254
255
257
5
Table of content
B.16
Plate Connections
B.16.1
B.16.2
B.16.3
263
264
276
279
B.17
281
B.18
Web Angle
287
B.19
Shear Plates
297
B.20
Splice Joints
305
B.21
Purlin Connection
311
B.22
Gusset Plates
321
B.23
Dynamic Bracing
325
B.23.1
B.23.2
B.23.3
B.23.4
B.24
Common Settings
Shape Bracing
Rod Bracing
Pipe Bracing
Static Bracing
B.24.1
B.24.2
Settings
Creation of Bracing Parts
326
331
334
337
339
340
344
B.25
Haunches
349
B.26
Connection Editor
353
B.27
Group Structure
357
B.27.1
B.27.2
B.27.3
B.27.4
357
359
363
367
Table of content
B.28
Positioning
B.28.1
B.28.2
B.28.3
B.28.4
B.28.5
B.28.6
B.28.7
Automatic Positioning
Manual Insertion
Automatic Insertion (Distribution)
Other Auxiliary Commands
Add Drawing Number
Depiction of Position Flags
Management of Styles
369
370
382
387
393
395
396
400
B.29
Drawing Information
403
B.30
405
B.30.1
B.30.2
B.31
B.31.1
B.31.2
B.31.3
B.31.4
B.32
Containment List
B.32.1
B.32.2
DETAILING
C.1
DetailCenter
C.1.1
C.1.2
C.1.3
C.1.4
C.1.5
C.1.6
C.1.7
C.1.8
C.1.9
C.1.10
C.1.11
C.1.12
The 2D-Detailing
Detailing with the DetailCenter
Launching DetailCenter
General Information Scale and Dimension Styles
General Information - Detail Types
General Information Group Structure
Intelligent 2D-Details
Display of Construction Component Lists
Component Overview
Views Overview
Detail Block Overview (Insert)
Global Settings
406
411
421
421
424
430
431
433
433
435
443
445
445
447
454
455
457
462
466
468
475
489
498
505
Table of content
C.1.13
C.1.14
C.1.15
C.1.16
C.1.17
C.2
C.2.1
C.2.2
C.2.3
C.2.4
C.2.5
C.2.6
C.2.7
C.3
C.3.1
C.3.2
C.3.3
C.4
C.4.1
C.4.2
C.4.3
C.5
C.5.1
C.5.2
C.5.3
C.5.4
C.6
C.6.1
C.6.2
C.6.3
C.6.4
C.6.5
Automatic Translation
Transfer Drawing Paths
Direct Detailing
Modification Management
Replace Detail Blocks
Detailing Style
Working with Detailing Styles
General Info
Global Settings
Dimensioning
Label Settings
Settings for ProConcrete 3D Parts
Example Detailing of a Single Part
DetailCenter Express
Running DetailCenter Express
Selection Pages
Single Sheet Output
DetailCenter Composer
Start DetailCenter Composer
Manual Insertion Mode
Batch Insertion Mode
Format File
RevisionCenter
What is the RevisionCenter?
Structure of the RevisionCenter
Document Overview
Component Overview
Conflict Overview
512
515
522
524
533
535
535
536
539
576
678
686
687
689
689
692
694
707
708
709
730
739
740
743
755
757
759
759
762
765
768
769
C.7
Cranked 2D-View
773
C.8
North Symbol
775
C.9
781
C.10
785
Table of content
C.11
Global Scale
787
C.12
Drawing Border
789
C.13
Manual 2D-Cut
793
C.14
Manual Dimensioning
799
C.15
Elevation Flags
811
C.16
Weld Symbols
819
C.17
Short 2D manually
829
C.18
2D-Cutout
831
C.19
Hole Display
833
C.20
Automatic 2D-Cut
837
C.21
Flatten Viewport
841
MISCELLANEOUS
845
D
D.1
D.1.1
D.1.2
D.1.3
D.1.4
D.2
D.2.1
D.2.2
D.2.3
D.2.4
D.2.5
D.3
BlockCenter
Structure of the BlockCenter
Creation and Edition of Blocks
Insert Blocks
Display of Block Structure
Database of Block Data
Roof/Wall Panels
847
847
848
857
861
863
864
866
868
870
873
883
Table of content
D.4
D.4.1
D.4.2
D.4.3
D.5
Auxiliary Tools
D.5.1
D.5.2
D.5.3
D.5.4
D.5.5
D.5.6
D.5.7
Collision Check
Center of Gravity
Tube Unfold
Move Objects
Create ACIS-DWG
Create AutoCAD Drawing
Convert ADT shapes
889
890
893
894
897
897
900
901
903
904
906
908
D.6
909
D.7
Data Exchange
913
D.7.1
D.7.2
D.7.3
D.7.4
D.7.5
D.7.6
D.7.7
D.7.8
APPENDIX
913
915
921
923
928
933
934
952
971
E.1
973
E.2
983
E.3
995
E.4
1023
E.5
1029
E.6
1033
10
Table of content
E.7
1039
E.8
1047
E.9
1057
E.9.1
E.9.2
E.9.3
E.9.4
E.9.5
E.9.6
E.9.7
E.9.8
E.9.9
E.9.10
E.9.11
E.9.12
E.9.13
E.9.14
E.9.15
E.9.16
E.9.17
Shapes
Plates
Bolts
Volume Solids / Basic Primitives
Special Parts
Assemblies
Work Frames / Views
Structural Elements
Roof/Wall-Objects
Position Flags, Elevations, Weld Marks,..
Drawing Parts Lists
3D Modifications
Flat Cuts
Poly-Cuts
Edge Processing
Notches (Outlets)
Common Properties
1058
1072
1078
1083
1085
1086
1088
1088
1088
1088
1088
1089
1092
1093
1094
1095
1096
E.10
1101
E.11
Own Notes
1107
11
Table of content
12
Introduction
14
General Information
A.1
General Information
Welcome to ProSteel
You decided to buy our ProSteel program because you are convinced that you
will cope with your daily tasks faster and in a more reliable way in the future by
using a CAD software package which is successful, well tried and tested all over
the world.
We are pleased that you selected a product of our company and we hope that
for a long time we will be your reliable partners.
15
General Information
16
General Information
17
General Information
18
Language Selection
A.2
Language Selection
In ProSteel you can select the language of the menu prompt and thus of the
configuration, too while the program is running.
The displayed dialog offers all languages which are installed at the very
moment. To switch over to another language check the field beside the flag and
confirm the modification with the OK-button.
Apart from the language of the menu prompt, the modified settings for the
configuration will be loaded as well when the program is started for the next
time.
If you switch over e. g. from German to English, nothing will happen first in the
running mode except the language of the dialogs. However, if you start ProSteel
anew together with the modified language setting, the configuration of the
language setting will be loaded as well from the currently installed language set.
This means that a plate will not be created with the name Blech but with the
name Plate.
The search paths of the program for blocks, temp- and varia-directories will
change as well and another ProSteel configuration will be available.
Please refer to the chapter Installation to see which installations depend on the
language.
19
Language Selection
20
Dialog Framework
A.3
Dialog Framework
The standard elements (lower button bar) as well as the general behaviour of
the dialogs are described below. When the different commands are described,
these things wont be explained any more.
21
Dialog Framework
Dialog-Commands
OK
By clicking on this button, you close the dialog and the last settings such
as content of the dialog, position on the screen, selected dialog tab, etc.
are stored.
Depending on the command, you are prompted to continue with other things like
e.g. selection of component parts, etc.
CANCEL
By clicking on this button, you close the dialog and the command is
cancelled. If possible, the previous status is restored as it was before
selection of the command
HELP
When you click on this button, the Online-help is opened.
TEMPLATE
By clicking on this button, you can save or load again the complete
settings of the dialog for the selected command under any template name
you like.
Here, another dialog of ProSteel template management opens which is
described separately in this subordinate chapter.
CLONE
By clicking on this button, you can read the settings of an existing
connection and import it onto another one. This function is especially
suitable for automatic connections.
It helps you to obtain an identical connection to an existing one, the exact
default settings of which, however, you dont know any more. For more detailed
information, please refer to the descriptions of the individual functions.
22
Dialog Framework
UPDATE
When you click on this button, the connection, structure or the component
part are updated according to your default settings.
Normally in ProSteel, you are working in a dynamic mode. Each
modification of a parameter is directly translated into a modification of the
corresponding object so that you can see the results immediately.
In case of very complex structures or less powerful computers, it may be
reasonable to deactivate this automatic update in the global settings of ProSteel
and to activate it manually if need be.
ROLL-OVER
By clicking on this button, you alternatively switch on or off the so-called
Roll-Over-mechanism.
When RollOver is switched on, the visible dialog area depends on the
current mouse position. For more detailed information, please refer to the
separate description in this chapter.
GRAPHIC
When you click on this button, the auxiliary graphics of the corresponding
dialogs are alternatively switched on or off. This influences the size of the
dialog on the screen.
23
Dialog Framework
The methods of working within the template management are very similar to
those of Windows Explorer. For example, you can organize the templates
structure in different list branches and easily modify this structure at any time via
Drag&Drop.
24
Dialog Framework
Dialog-Commands
LOAD
When you click on this button, the template marked in the selection list is
loaded and the input fields of the dialog box are filled in accordingly. Then,
the dialog will be closed immediately.
You can also double-click the list entry for this command.
SAVE
By clicking on this button, you can save the settings entered in the dialog
frame using a name indicated by you. You first have to select the desired
list branch where your template has to be saved and then click the SAVE
button.
Now an entry with a standard name will be created the name of which can be
modified immediately or at a later moment.
To overwrite an existing entry, select the corresponding entry instead of a list
branch.
NEW FOLDER
By clicking on this button, you can create a new branch (folder) on the
topmost level or even within a list branch to save your templates.
You first have to select the desired list branch and then you haver to click
the NEW FOLDER button.
IMPORT
Click on this button to add other templates of the same type to your
current template file. This may be a single template, a list branch or the
complete file.
A file selection dialog opens where you can select the template file to be
imported. It is checked whether you selected the same type.
If the name of some list branches of the imported template file is identical with
the entry in the existing file, you can decide for each branch individually whether
the existing data have to be overwritten or not.
The new branches or templates are only added; they may be re-organized later
by using Drag&Drop.
25
Dialog Framework
Order
Click on this button, and the alphabetical order of the display list is turned
upside down. You can reach entries which are placed further down
without having to scroll up and down the list.
First, you have to select a list branch the order of which has to be changed.
Sorting can be defined for each branch individually.
Context Menu
Most of the dialog commands can be reached via the context menu of the right
mouse key. Further commands are available here.
REMOVE
Select this command to delete the selected template or a complete branch
including all subordinate branches.
EXPORT
Select this command to save the selected template or a complete branch
including all subordinate branches under any file name you like. The data can
be added again at any time using the IMPORT command or they can be made
accessible to other users for import.
After selection of the command, the file selection dialog opens where you can
select a file name or a file path.
FAVOURITES
Select this command to add the selected template to the favourites list or to
remove it from this list.
BLOCK
Select this command to block the selected template against overwriting. This
function is only available in expert mode.
UNBLOCK
Select this command to unblock templates which were blocked against
overwriting. This function is only available in expert mode.
26
Dialog Framework
Version Control
You are perhaps used to the fact that in other programs and in previous
ProSteel versions already defined templates were often lost during an update.
This is the reason why the data structure of template file was equipped with a
version and type control. Your new defined templates remain compatible with
the following versions and when former files are loaded, any new added values
will have a standard value.
27
Dialog Framework
Favourites
You can collect selected templates individually in a favourites list. These lists
are displayed in the dialogs of the functions to have a quick selection of
templates available.
First click on the corresponding entry to define a template as favourite. Then,
select the option Add to favourites in the context menu. Now, the entry is
displayed in bold type.
To remove an entry, click on the entry again and select the entry Remove from
Favourites in the context menu.
28
Dialog Framework
A.3.3 RollOver-Mechanism
The so-called RollOver-mechanism allows for a better use of your drawing
surface in ProSteel because the dialogs are only displayed completely if you
probably intend to enter something or to control the settings.
Otherwise, the dialogs are reduced to the title bar allowing you at any time to
recognize which dialogs are open at the moment.
The change from complete to reduced
status depends on the movements of
your mouse.
When you leave the input area of a
dialog with the mouse, it will be folded
up except for the title bar shortly
afterwards and you can look at your
construction. It is not until you move to the title bar again with the mouse, that
the dialog is displayed completely because the program now assumes that you
are going to modify something.
Individual Control
Due to the fact that perhaps you dont want to have a RollOver-mechanism
activated for each dialog, it can be switched on or off for each dialog individually.
You may even completely deactivate the RollOver-mechanism in the global
settings if you dont like this way of working at all. However, your individual
defaults are kept in each dialog frame and become valid again when the
mechanism is activated.
29
Dialog Framework
Auxiliary Graphics
The auxiliary graphics show a depiction in the form of a diagram, e.g. a
connection or a structural element with the most important dimensions, which
can be modified in the dialog frame.
Here, different numbers which you will find again in the
labelling of input fields and which allow for a clear
assignment marks the dimensions. In some dialog
frames, the graphics change depending on the selection
of an option or even of an input field. Thus they are
sufficient in most cases as help for the parameters.
Monitor
The monitor frame helps you to define the reference points e.g. at the insertion
of shapes.
In this case, you usually find small circles serving as
marks to be clicked. The activated reference point then
is displayed in red.
In addition, the monitor also shows a preview of your
current default settings e.g. at the definition of position
flags. In contrast to the auxiliary graphics, its proportions
change.
30
Dialog Framework
Pick Lengths
Most input fields for entering distances allow picking the distance in your
drawing. Then, the picked length is entered into the input field. This extension
permits comfortable seizing of distances from your construction.
To do so, select the entry Add Picked Length in the corresponding field via the
context menu; the dialog frame is temporarily hidden, and you can pick the
distance via two points.
If you select the entry Add Picked Length (without Z) instead, the distance will
be calculated without Z-coordinates.
Pocket Calculator
Most input fields for entering distances alternatively allow the use of an
integrated pocket calculator to calculate the values. The new calculated value
then is entered into the input field.
To do so, select the entry Add Calculated Value via the context menu; the
pocket calculator is displayed. If a value was entered into the input field before,
it will be automatically displayed in the pocket calculator.
31
Dialog Framework
32
Input Options
A.4
Input Options
Additional Functions
Pick Length
If you select this function, the dialog is hidden and you can
pick two points in the drawing. The distance from one point to
the other is calculated and the result is entered into the
corresponding dialog field. Then, the dialog is displayed again.
Pick Length without Z If you select this option, the z-coordinates are removed
at distance calculation. Running is the same as described
above.
Pocket Calculator A small pocket calculator is displayed when you use this
option.
When selected, the calculator takes over the content of the
current field and you can directly calculate with this value.
When the calculation is finished and you want to copy the
result into the current input field, just quit the calculator using
the COPY button.
33
Input Options
In most of the functions, and in the case you want to select all
parts, you can answer the selection with RETURN. Then, all
parts of the current drawing will be selected.
Filter
When you interrupt the selection with ESC and SHIFT, the
filter function is selected and the function is not left.
In this case you would filter your input for all parts being longer than 2000 mm. If
you press the OK-button, the parts are selected on which the filtering is based.
Then, the original function is carried out together with the filter result.
For a detailed description of the filter possibilities, please refer to the description
of PS_SEARCH command.
34
Input Options
The bolted joint command saves the last created bolt to avoid
searching through the database if the next bolt is a bolt of the
same type and length, etc. When you keep the CTRL-key
pressed during bolted joint command, the stored data are
deleted and the program is forced to read the bolt data from a
file.
Select View
Display Class
NC-Data
Positioning
Work Frame
Positioning
35
Input Options
Use of ALT-Key
General
Render Export
Object View
Free View
Osnap
Handrail
Truss Girders
Lattice Girders
Select View
Hangar Frame
36
Input Options
Haunch
Ladder
Insert Shapes
Stiffeners
Copy
Working Areas
Line Cut
Connect
ArcShape
Bolt Grips
Purlin Connect.
Plate Grips
Shape
2D Details
37
Input Options
Grips
38
Project Manager
A.5
Project Manager
In all ProSteel versions it is possible to store drawing files, parts list files or
similar things on the folder you like. This feature is often very useful; on the
other hand, however, the problem is to keep all files of a project together.
Up to now, it was not possible to store the pre-settings, templates or even
configurations related to the project. In the current version, a project manager
has been implemented offering exactly these options.
39
Project Manager
40
Project Manager
41
Project Manager
Project Name
Model Files
42
Project Manager
Detail Files This is the path for your detail drawings. The Detail Centre takes
over the selection made here as pre-setting.
Parts Lists..
This is the path for your parts list files. The file for the creation
of parts lists takes over the selection made here as presetting. Of course, only the new selection is concerned. If
another project was activated at the last selection of the parts
list creation, the path still is the one set for this project.
NC Files
This is the path for your NC files. The NC-creation takes over
the selection made here as pre-setting. Of course, only the
new selection is concerned. If another project was activated at
the last selection of the NC-creation, the path still is the one
set for this project.
PPS Files
This is the path for your PPS files. The PPS-function takes
over the selection made here as pre-setting. Of course, only
the new selection is concerned. If another project was
activated at the last selection of the PPS-function, the path still
is the one set for this project.
Export Files
This is the path for your export files. The export function takes
over the selection made here as pre-setting. Of course, only
the new selection is concerned. If another project was
activated at the last selection of the NC-creation, the path still
is the one set for this project.
Temp Project
Temp Files
Copy from
Enter the path from which all existing temporary files have to
be copied into the new directory. You dont have to work with
a bare installation, but you will find the usual environment,
even if from now on it will only be valid for this project.
Templates Proj... If this option is activated, you can store the template files
separated from the standard storing place and organize your
settings related to the project.
In the template files, all data are stored which have been
created via the template management.
Template Files
Copy from
Enter the path from which all existing template files have to be
copied into the new directory. You dont have to work with a
bare installation, but you will find the usual environment, even
if from now on it will only be valid for this project.
43
Project Manager
Styles Project
Style File
Enter the path for your style files. This path is used to file the
corresponding subdirectories for the 5 types of style files.
Copy From
Enter the path from which all existing style files have to be
copied into the new directory. You dont have to work with a
bare installation, but you will find the usual environment, even
if from now on it will only be valid for this project.
DWG Project
DWG Frame
Copy From
Enter the path from which all existing Dwg frames have to be
copied into the new directory.
Project Descr.
44
Global Settings
A.6
Global Settings
This dialog box and its pages allow you to enter the standard settings for several
functions. You access the dialog by selecting the ProSteel/Options item via the
context menu of the right mouse button when no objects are selected.
Identical values for the corresponding ProSteel-components resulting from these
settings can be modified at any time for each part via the Change PS
Properties command.
Most entries are explained with the individual functions; therefore just some
settings will be explained in the following.
Options
General settings
Grips
Shapes
Straight Plates
Bolts
Work Frame
Assembly
Values
LogLinks
Revision
Display
Colours
Monitor
Configuration
Dialogs
Files
45
Global Settings
Options
Analysis View
Double Click
Unit Dialog
Enable DSTV
46
Global Settings
Remove Modifications Drill holes e.g. which lie outside of the shape after a
length modification has been performed, are deleted
automatically.
Remove Links
Recalculate Parts
Execute Boolean
47
Global Settings
Shapes as Acis New shapes are created by means of the Acis modeller.
Plates as Acis
Grips
Shapes
Modify Length
Move Cuts
A grip is created for the section. You might now have one grip
for changing the length and one for changing the section.
Please note: When you move a section grip in a way to shorten the length of the
shape, the length grip is moved simultaneously.
When you move the length grip over the section grip, the shape will be cut off at
the same spot, because you have not moved the sectional plane. When you
move the section grip over the length grip, you eliminate the section from the
shape (although the sectional plane remains at the section grip) the section grip
seizes the sectional plane, while the length grip seizes the shape length.
When you stretch a cut shape, the section angle within the shape remains the
same, just like in reality.
48
Global Settings
Move Holes
Move Polycuts
Only Along Center Line Shapes can only be stretched along their axis, i. e. a
change of position is not possible.
Layout
When you have entered a value > 0 in this input field, the
length of the shape can only be changed via grips in preset
modular steps. When you have entered 0, any kind of change
can be performed.
Plates
Modify Plate Size
Move Cuts
All other plates fields have same definition as the shape fields.
Please refer to this chapter for more detailed information.
49
Global Settings
Shapes
With the exception of the additional dialog tabs and some specifications, most of
the settings can be found under the section describing the shape properties.
Offset Centre Line You specify the length beyond which the centre line has to
exceed the shape ends.
Maximum Shape
50
If you enter a value bigger than 0 and you have checked the
entry Verify Shape Lengths under Options, and shapes are
inserted, a message is displayed drawing your attention to the
fact that the maximum delivery length is exceeded by some
shapes.
A hint dialog appears and the corresponding shapes are
highlighted in colour.
Global Settings
Shapes...Labels
51
Global Settings
Text Size
Distance
Enter the distance between labelling and the upper side of the
shape. However, dont forget that the actual size depends on
the set global scale of the drawing.
Position No. Prefix This designation is put in front of the position number.
Text Style
Label
Note2
52
Global Settings
Dynamic
Shape Type not to be labelled In this input field you enter the shape types,
which have to be excluded from labelling. The advantage is
that only shape sizes differing from a default value will be
output individually.
Shapes...Sketch Display
Sketch Size
Sketch Length
You can enter the length of sketch display from the centre in
the Value input field below to outline the shape as solid. If you
enter the value 0, the result will only be a cross-section display
at the centre.
53
Global Settings
Relative Length You can enter the relative size of sketch display related t o the
overall length of the shape in the Value input field below.
End Offset
You can enter the distance of the end points of the displayed
system line towards the actual insertion points in the Value
input field below.
Layout
Insertion Line
Middle Line
Here, you can see an example for a sketch display as well as some
corresponding dimensions:
54
Global Settings
Shapes...Name Conventions
Input Fields
55
Global Settings
Shapes...Flat Steel Selection
Select from List Dimensions of e.g. end plates which are preferably produced
of flat steel can only be selected from flat steels existing in the
database.
When the option is not activated, you can indicate any lengths
and widths.
Metrical/Imperial
List
After decimal
56
Global Settings
Straight Plates
With the exception of the additional dialog tabs and some specifications, most of
the settings can be found under the section describing the shape properties.
Grid lengthwise Here you enter the lengthwise grid distances if a grid is to be
displayed.
Grid cross-wise Here you enter the cross-wise grid distances if a grid is to be
displayed.
Grid Length
Grid Height
Grid = Thickness The grid height always corresponds to the current plate
thickness.
57
Global Settings
Offset Middle Line If you selected the display as middle line, this is where you
enter a projection of the middle line over the two plate
surfaces.
In contrast to shapes, the centre line of plates is not running
along the longitudinal direction but along the plate thickness.
Input Thickness You can indicate the plate thickness in the insertion dialog, as
you like. Otherwise, only the values of a selection list are
available (preference values).
Volume Weight
58
Global Settings
Plates...Labels
Since this dialog tab is identical with the shape labelling, please refer to this
chapter for the meaning of the input fields.
Plates...Description
59
Global Settings
Export
Here, you specify the format default of the plate name at the
export of parts list data.
Format Default Structure:
The names like e.g. $(N) serve as variable for the current
value of the corresponding plate and are explained in the
dialog itself. The Name of the plate is the constant part like
plate, grating, etc.
In the input fields of the corresponding description, you can
enter a text consisting of the variables and any other
characters.
When the program is running, the variables are replaced by
the current values e.g. for the length and the other characters
will be kept as in the original input.
Round at...
60
Global Settings
Plates...Calculation
Here, a dialog tab opens where you can determine the method for calculating
the weight of the plate resp. the surface to be painted. These specifications
influence the result in the parts list output.
The values can be defined according to the exact form, according to the rubber
tape-method (as if a rubber tape was tightened around the plate) or according to
the smallest surrounding rectangle.
For plates having a grid (e.g. to display a gridiron) you can reduce the weight to
the percentage value indicated in the input field Weight at Grid.
61
Global Settings
Bolts
Layout
Back to Back
Round bigger...
Search smaller... If a bolt cannot be created with the found size, the next
smaller bolt will be searched and used.
Bolt Weight
62
Global Settings
Work Frame
Frame
Diagonal
Cut Plane
Origin
Area Name
Dynamic...
Size Adjustment The frame text will be adjusted to the particular size of the
display.
Update Shapes Shapes inserted on work frame axes are moved as well if the
work area is modified.
Left Designation The left axis designation will be displayed.
Right Designation The right axis designation will be displayed.
63
Global Settings
Assembly
Depiction
Character Size
64
Global Settings
Values
Resolution:
The input fields are used to specify the resolution for creating
circular volumes. The higher the resolution, the more detailed
the display but the computer processing speed decreases.
Use high-resolution settings only for large scales and
important details.
Due to some special features in the volume-modeller, you
should only specify odd numbers here. However, this only
influences the Facet Modeler.
2D Subpart
Clip Plane Distance Specify the front and rear section plane distances of the
object view.
Rounding Stiffener Thickness Here, you specify the accuracy the plate
thickness of the calculated stiffener thickness has to be
rounded at stiffeners in connections.
An unnecessary accuracy can thus be avoided resp. only
certain plate thicknesses, which are available in the workshop,
will be used.
65
Global Settings
Front/Rear Distance
Here, you specify the front or rear distance
of the sectional area which is used as standard value for a
limited visual depth (sectional area).
Specific Weight Steel
Here you define the specific weight of steel to be used as
basis for weight calculation.
Logical Links
Create Passive
No Update
On Request
66
Global Settings
Revision Check
Length Tolerance
Tolerances
Here, you specify the tolerances to be used
for comparing the component parts. You can specify the values for line length as
well as the comparison of drill holes, lengths and weight.
Modifications are determined by means of a type of comparison which is also
used for positioning.
67
Global Settings
Single Parts
At Changes
Storing
Here, you specify what has to happen with the invalid (former)
position number at a changed single part.
No Storing The position number is ignored.
Confirm The position number is only stored as original
position if this is individually confirmed for each part.
Save The position number is saved as original position.
Groups
Here, you specify the behaviour of the group position number at a changed part.
The possible specifications correspond to those for single parts and are
described there.
Others
Modify Flag
68
Global Settings
Display
Viewport
Shape Clipping
Plate Clipping
Suppress...
69
Global Settings
Cache 2D
The result of all line calculations effected by the volumemodeller (e.g. at a 2D-depiction, object snap, etc) is written
into an intermediate storage. A new calculation is only made in
case of modifications.
Thus the processing speed for the determination of AutoCADobject snap-points especially in case of complex construction
groups is considerably increased.
No Bolts...
Real Bolts...
Real Arc...
Position Flags at Shade All position flags placed in the model will not be
hidden when the function Hide/Shade is selected.
Additional Lines at Shade All lines in the model, like centre lines, gravity lines
or other construction lines will not be hidden when the function
Hide/Shade is selected.
Workframe at Shade All work frames within the model will not be hidden when
the function Hide/Shade is selected.
Structural Objects at Shade
Structural objects are displayed when the function
Hide/Shade is selected.
Display Hole
70
Global Settings
Colours
Input Fields
Here, you set the colours to be used for the different display
markings and objects of the program by indicating the
AutoCAD colour number. Please refer to the corresponding
commands for the meaning of the different markings.
COLOUR SELECTION
You can also select the colour in a comfortable way by clicking
the corresponding input field and then loading the AutoCAD
dialog for colour selection.
71
Global Settings
Monitor Colours
Background
Foreground
Symbol Colour
Marking
COLOUR SELECTION
You can also select the colour in a comfortable way by clicking
the corresponding input field and then loading the AutoCAD
dialog for colour selection.
72
Global Settings
Configuration / Iso-Views
Here you specify how to set the global iso-views of the program. To define a
view, zoom or turn the model into the view to be used as iso-view. Then, press
the button and the pre-set values will be adopted as pre-set view iso1 up to
Iso5. These views are also available in the DetailCenter.
73
Global Settings
Configuration...Layer
This dialog tab is used to realize the configuration of ProSteel. Here you set the
layer names, colours and line types.
74
Global Settings
This dialog is used to set the preset files for flat and wide-flat steel from which
the flat steels have to be taken in the further run of the program.
75
Global Settings
Dialog Settings
Expert Mode
Accuracy
Here you specify the value for the display accuracy of lengths,
angles and other values. If you selected the option Use
AutoCAD settings, the accuracy depends on the system
settings (LUPREC). Otherwise, you specify the desired value
here.
RollOver
Dynamic Point Input This option permits dynamic zoom and pan during the
picking of points or lines.
Tabs one after the other If there isnt enough place, the selection tabs for the
pages of a dialog are displayed one after the other instead of
next to each other.
76
Global Settings
No Updates
Coloured Icons
77
Global Settings
Dialog Settings...ToolTips
Suppress...
Delay
Display Time
78
Global Settings
Dialog Settings...Classes/Families
Here you enter the standard values for the number of available selection,
display, area classes and part families.
79
Global Settings
In this dialog, you can specify the default settings for the properties of individual
object types in ProSteel.
Select the object type in the Selection List. The depiction of the dialog tab will be
adopted. Please refer to the descriptions of the different object types for the
meaning of the entries.
The default settings are used by MatchProp-command in AutoCAD.
80
Global Settings
Configuration Files
The basic configuration of ProSteel is effected via different files which you can
see by corresponding selection and which you can edit using the integrated text
editor.
DELETE TEMPORARY FILES
Click this button to delete any existing files in the temporary directory.
By deleting the temporary files, you reset all command dialogs to the
original state at delivery.
DELETE TEMPLATES
Click this button to delete all existing data in the template directory.
However, please remember that in this case all dialog templates
created by you will be irrevocably deleted. Important templates such as
e.g. certain company standards should be saved elsewhere.
Please note that you have access to this page only via Expert Mode, because
the modifications made here have a decisive influence on the operation of the
program.
81
Global Settings
82
84
Layer Functions
B.1
Layer Functions
The program is equipped with an automatic layer control. Normally you dont
have to take care of this.
If you use the program commands to create different objects such as shapes,
dimensions, welding symbols, etc., these are created on their own layer.
The activation, deactivation, and switching of layers is one of the most
frequently performed tasks when using AutoCAD. ProSteel supplies its own
switching functions for this purpose. Switching to the most important layers can
be done with just one click, and without long searches. Select the command by
clicking its associated button or enter PS_LAYER from the keyboard with the
indicated parameter.
Work Frame On:
LFRAMEON
The layer with the frame for the work area is
activated.
LFRAMEOFF
The layer with the frame for the work area is
deactivated.
LELEMON
The layers for the main elements are activated.
These are the layers for shape, roof/wall shapes,
plates, construction lines, and bolts.
LELEMOFF
The layers for the main elements are deactivated.
These are the layers for shape, roof/wall shapes,
plates, construction lines, and bolts.
85
Layer Functions
Additional Layer On:
LADDION
The layers for the additional elements are activated.
These are the layers for dimensioning, midlines,
position flags, relative heights, welding symbols, etc.
LADDIOFF
The layers for the additional elements are
deactivated.
These are the layers for dimensioning, midlines,
position flags, relative heights, welding symbols, etc.
LOBJECT
The layer for a freely selectable element becomes
the current layer.
You can select the element by clicking it.
LOBJECTOFF
The layer for a freely selectable element is
deactivated.
You can select the element by clicking it.
LCONSTAKT
(black lines)
LCONSTON
(brown lines)
86
Layer Functions
Construction Lines Off:
LCONSTOFF
The layer for the construction lines is deactivated.
Layer 0 Current:
LNULL
The AutoCAD-Layer 0 becomes the current layer.
87
Layer Functions
88
Construction Utilities
B.2
Construction Utilities
Direction
2 Points
Line
Point Line
Line Type
Distance
89
Construction Utilities
Scale
Angle
Number
Offset
Only in Plane
Create Reference Line A construction line is drawn on the reference line as well
(even for a non-existing line indicated with only 2 points).
Loop
90
Construction Utilities
91
Construction Utilities
PS_CONST_HOR
This command creates a horizontal construction line.
Click a point the construction line is to intersect.
PS_CONST_VER
This command creates a vertical construction line.
Click a point the construction line is to intersect.
PS_CONST_PAP
This command creates a construction line running parallel with
a reference line.
First click the reference line and then on a point the
construction line is to intersect.
PS_CONST_PAE
This command creates a construction line running parallel with
a reference line using a specified distance.
First enter the desired distance and then click the reference
line. Finally, click the side of the reference line along which the
parallel line is to be created.
PS_CONST_SAP
This command creates a perpendicular construction line for a
reference line.
Click the reference line and then on a point the construction
line is to intersect.
92
Construction Utilities
PS_CONST_SAE
With Distance: This command creates a perpendicular
construction line for a reference line.
With Distance from a Reference Point: First enter the desired
distance and then click the reference line. Finally, click the
reference point and then on the side of the reference point
where the perpendicular line is to be created.
PS_CONST_DVD
This command divides a reference line into equal segments
and creates corresponding perpendicular construction lines
along this line (also utilizing the start and end point).
First enter the number of sections and then click the reference
line.
PS_CONST_DEL
This command deletes all construction lines drawn up to then
on the layer created for the construction lines.
93
Construction Utilities
The area Coordinates in UCS shows the measuring results regarding the
current user coordinate system!
Start or End X, Y, Z are the coordinates of the two measuring points. Distance in
X, Y, Z is the distance in the direction of the respective coordinate axis. Dist
Direct is the direct distance of the points. Angle is the angle from the start to end
point in reference to the user coordinate x-axis.
The section Coordinates in WCS shows the measuring results regarding the
current world coordinate system.
Start or End X, Y, Z are the coordinates of the two measuring points in the WCS
and Cos X, Y, Z is the so-called directional cosine of the vector from start to
end point (a mathematical size which normally hasn't any further meaning for
you).
94
3D Object Views
B.3
3D Object Views
95
3D Object Views
The following message appears in the command line after the command Object
View has been selected: Pick the steel component defining the view or hit
RETURN to align the view.
After part selection, coloured coordinate crosshairs are displayed on the
selected component and the following message appears in the command line:
Select the desired axis. Now use your mouse to click the corresponding
coloured circle and the object view is displayed with the selected direction.
You want an object view on front. Pick
the shape while keeping the ALT-key
pressed, clicking one of these lines on
the front,...
96
3D Object Views
When you select the function, you first have to click the desired component part
at a bordering edge between two surfaces. Then the coordinate crosshairs are
displayed at this position and you can select the desired view by clicking an
axis.
If you have selected the command PS_FACE_VIEW_CEN, the origin of the view
is situated in the middle of the clicked line.
97
3D Object Views
98
3D Object Views
99
3D Object Views
100
3D Object Views
Off
101
3D Object Views
On
Flip
Distance
102
3D Object Views
Off
Focal Distance
Distance
Here you change the distance of the camera from the target
point.
Lines of vision changes are only possible using coordinates and the pick
function is deactivated. Changing to the model global view does not yield the
desired result until the perspective view is deactivated again.
103
3D Object Views
Remember that the perspective view is only a display view and does not allow
any changes. For that, switch back to the isometric display.
In the following, you will see some examples of the difference between the
perspective and the isometric display as well as the effect of the focal distance
on the isometric display:
Isometric Display
3D Global View
Isometric Display
The point down on the left (0,0,0) is also
the point of origin of the world coordinate
system.
Front View
Isometric Display
You see a view with the settings
Target point = (5000,0,5000)
Source point = (5000,-100,5000)
104
3D Object Views
Perspective Display
Front View
Perspective View
Focal distance = 50
The source and target points are first
set identically to the points of the
isometric view.
However, since the picture is much too
large, the distance from camera to
target is increased to 30000.
This corresponds with the source point
(5000,-30000,5000).
Front View
Perspective View
Focal distance = 100
The focal distance of the camera is
increased but the picture shows only a
section of the result.
105
3D Object Views
106
B.4
The notes about the AutoCAD standard commands mention the fact that
ProSteel objects are treated as AutoCAD elements, and can be copied or
moved the same way. This is correct, but the ProSteel copy and move
commands offer you additional help by offering the option of limiting the
direction of the move. Apart from that, you can specifically take the group
structure into consideration.
Using AutoCAD object snaps in a view may result in points being selected that
are not in the proper plane. The ProSteel copy and move commands prevent
this by limiting the direction of the move to the current user coordinate system
plane or even to one axis direction.
If several individual components have been assembled into construction
modules or groups, this command can be used to process the entire group by
selecting just one part of the group. This will eliminate unnecessary searching
and collecting of the parts within a selection set.
After the command has been selected, a dialog box will become available
featuring the following options, each single tab permitting a certain action.
This button carries out the selected action for single parts
without taking into consideration a possible group.
This button carries out the action for complete groups. In the
options, you can specify whether this selection has to be
made only when the main part is picked or for each part of the
group.
107
B.4.1 Move/Copy
Alignment
Multiple
108
B.4.2 Turn
Axis
Object Axis
Here, you select the desired part axis if the Object Axis
option has been specified.
The selected axis is displayed at the object selected first in
colour for your orientation.
Angle
Turn+Copy
109
B.4.3 Mirror
Method
Mirror+Copy
A copy of the component parts are created first which then will
be mirrored. Otherwise, the original parts will be mirrored.
110
B.4.4 Align
Use this command to align a component or an entire construction group in
respect to a certain plane or coordinate system.
Specify two coordinate systems, which are then aligned congruently with one
another. The calculated required movement and rotation are applied to the
selected parts. You can determine the coordinate systems either by specifying
three points for each one or via element surfaces. There, the point of origin is
always regarded as the bottom point of the surface.
Method
Align+Copy
Surface Method
When applying the surface method, you can only make use of one element.
Select the element at an edge neighbouring the desired surface. Then, you
obtain a coloured display of the surfaces available for selection. The target
surface is selected analogously.
111
112
B.4.5 Clone
Use this command to transfer the manipulations performed on a component or
an entire construction group to other components.
A prerequisite for cloning is that the parts have a position number and that these
match. The manipulations are transferred in such a way that all components are
identical again after the transfer has been concluded. However, there is the
option to limit the manipulations to be transferred to certain types such as only
drill holes, etc.
For example, use this command to apply the same modifications within a model
at a later time. For example, if a hangar has been constructed with many
identical supports and holes have to be added later to each support, they may
be added to just one support and then transferred to all of the others.
Cuts
All normal cuts are transferred. This includes the mitred cuts
as well.
Drill Holes
PolyCut
Notches
Boolean
113
114
B.4.6 Rotate
This command permits a rotated copy with vertical offset to distribute e.g. the
steps of a spiral staircase. Two methods can be applied. The number of steps
and the angle between the steps, or by an angle area and the steps to be
distributed within this area either/or defines the rotation.
Method
Number
Either the total amount or the number via the angle area.
Angle
Vertical Offset
115
B.4.7 Settings
Swap Effect
Group only...
116
B.5
B.5.1 Hide
This command can be used to hide components or whole groups, which means
that the parts are made invisible, and cannot be selected. This command
permits you to hide only selected components or to show only selected
components and to hide all others. This provides a clearer view of the model.
HINT: This command is most practical if individual parts are to be hidden from
view. To hide/show entire groups of parts it is better to use display classes
feature.
PS_Hide
Select the parts to be hidden after selecting the command.
The parts are no longer visible after pressing the ENTER key
or using the right mouse button. The command Regenerate
(not to be confused with the AutoCAD-command
Regenerate) will switch all parts back to visible.
PS_Hide_Exclude
This function is working just the other way round than the
previous one. After selecting the command, you can choose
the parts which you dont want to hide. After pressing the
ENTER key or using the right mouse button, all other parts are
hidden.
PS_Hide_Group
This function is working like PS_HIDE. The only difference is
that the whole group is hidden, if you only selected one part of
the group.
PS_Hide_Group_Exclude
This function is working like PS_HIDE_EXCLUDE. The only
difference is that the whole group remains visible, if you only
selected one part of the group.
PS_Hide_Plane
This function is working like PS_HIDE. The only difference is
that the whole component parts of a work plane are hidden, if
you only selected one work plane.
117
118
B.5.2 Regenerate
This command shows all components hidden by the user or hidden
automatically by the program.
You have to use this command, for example, to generate a parts list since all
processed parts are automatically hidden there for control purposes.
This command is not identical with the AutoCAD-command Regenerate since
the AutoCAD command does not reactivate the components again.
119
Class Name
The available display classes are listed and the desired class
may be selected. In the field Status you see if the elements
are currently shown (On) or hidden (Off). You can edit the
content of the field Class Name by double-clicking it.
Status
Here, you see the current status of a display class. You can
modify the status by double-clicking on it. It is also possible to
highlight several lines and to carry out the modification for all
highlighted lines.
120
Complete Groups
121
122
Display List
Single Parts
Groups
Both
If you click on a button of this line, both the single parts and
the groups are treated at selection of the parts.
123
Count
By double-clicking on a line, you can modify the definition of the part family.
124
Description:
Enter the name of your part family here. The entry appears in
the selection list and the part properties.
Pos Prefix:
Here, you enter the pos. prefix, which appears in front of each
position number itself if the part belongs to this family.
Colour
Enter the colour of the part family here. Indicate the AutoCAD
colour number or select it by clicking the SELECT button.
Detail Style
125
Line Type
Please note that the 2D line settings are only activated if the component parts
are displayed in 2D. These settings dont have any effects on the model display.
126
The process status of the part is another possibility to check or classify the
component parts in the drawing.
This function helps you to check the parts in colour according to certain criteria
and thus to display the current process status in production resp. installation in
the CAD model.
127
Preset File
You can define the preset values of the process status function (the names as
well as the corresponding colours) in a text file. This can be seen and modified
here.
128
B.5.7
Search Parts
Use this command to search for parts and components within a model, which
meet certain requirements.
You can define several conditions, which have to be met at the same time. If
these conditions are met, the part is either marked or all parts not meeting the
requirements are hidden.
Fields
Operator
Compare Value Here you indicate the value that has to be filled. Only values
existing in the drawing are offered.
In case of names, you can also indicate an asterisk (*) for any
other characters such as e.g. HE* for HEA,HEB etc.
Buttons
Specifications
Select the action that has to be carried out with the parts
found.
Mark
Hide
Zoom
Condition List
130
IPE*
1000
3000
131
132
Work Frames
B.6
Work Frames
of one or several
display the basic
aid objects, and
views created by
Basic Types
Before defining a work frame, first decide basic shape desired. The following
choices are possible:
- Rectangular work frames
- Cylindrical (also conical) work frames
- Wedge-shaped work frames
- Pyramidal work frames
133
Work Frames
Workframe-Layout Here you specify the design of the desired work frame.
Length
Width
Height
Absolute
Normally, you enter the height of the different fields. If this field
has been checked, the list data define absolute height values.
Axis Descriptions Axes labels are added according to the settings in the text
pages. The axes labels can be moved to their destination by
means of grips.
Insert Position
134
Work Frames
Roof Angle
If you want to have the form of a gabled roof
for your work frame, you can enter the roof slope in degrees.
Centre Height
If you want to have the form of a gabled roof for your work
frame, you can enter the ridge height.
Ridge Width
If you want to have the form of a gabled roof for your work
frame, you can enter the ridge width. If it is 0 or equal to the
width of the work frame, only a roof surface will be created.
Asymmetrical Divisions
To simplify the input of asymmetrical work frames, you can choose a special
kind of input. The following dialog opens when you keep the ALT-key pressed
while activating one of the three list values:
In the input field, you can either indicate the different fields separated by a
comma or repeated sections by number*distance. This simplifies the input of
complex divisions.
Keeping CTRL-key pressed while activating one of the three list fields, you will
delete the whole field definition in this dimension.
Existing field definitions cannot be modified using this method. They will be
completely overwritten.
135
Work Frames
The entries of the dialogs above result in the following display of a ProSteel
work frame in AutoCAD (no additional rotation):
136
Work Frames
When selecting the views to be created, the overlapping views of the same work
plane of other work frames may be omitted because normally they are of no
further use for you (when selecting the corresponding plane, you will see the
whole view).
In connection with the object-oriented feature of ProSteel there are good
reasons for creating these views. It is e.g. possible to move the complete work
frame and this view is perhaps missing. However, if the above picture
corresponds to the reality, you can omit the front and right side view of the
platform because the hangar work frame already provides them.
137
Work Frames
Base
Top Radius
Height
Segmentation
All further options correspond to those of the rectangular work frame. Please
refer to this chapter for more detailed information.
138
Work Frames
At left
All further options correspond to those of the rectangular work frame. Please
refer to this chapter for more detailed information.
139
Work Frames
Roof Length
Ridge Width
All further options correspond to those of the rectangular work frame. Please
refer to this chapter for more detailed information.
140
Work Frames
Front View
Side View R
Side View L
Back View
Top View
Roof View L
Length Axis
Width Axis
Height Axis
141
Work Frames
Distances Cut.Surfaces
The views can automatically hide all elements situated outside
a certain distance. Here, you specify these distances for all
views of this work frame, separated in front and back.
142
Work Frames
Depiction
Connection Line A line is drawn from the corresponding edge of the work frame
to the text.
Start Value
Size
Scale
Distance
143
Work Frames
Main Axis
When several work frames are involved, you can here enter
the name of the main work frame, if the current frame is rather
considered to be a subordinate frame. It can also be used as
prefix.
Suppress First Axis When frames are used, the axes names can overlap. This
option suppresses the display of the first axis.
Suppress Last Axis When frames are used, the axes names can overlap. This
option suppresses the display of the last axis.
Avoid I, O
Decreasing
Position
2 Lines
Dynamic
Axis Gap
144
Work Frames
Here, you can enter the name and the main axis for each single axis. In
addition, you can specify whether the axis name has to be overwritten manually
(manual) and whether this axis has to be displayed (invisible).
Switch over by double-clicking the entries in the first two columns. The entries of
the last two columns can be edited by double-clicking.
145
Work Frames
This function helps you to create an axis grid completely out of an existing 2Daxis plan. First, you insert a temporary grid into the plan and then you align it to
a reference point as desired. Afterwards, you add the grid axes by clicking on
the existing 2D-axes.
146
Work Frames
B.6.8 Options
No Lines
Axis on Edges
This option has the effect that the axes names are not
displayed in a fixed distance to the work frame edges, but
always at the outer edge of the displayed view. You are
informed about the corresponding position, even if the work
frame edges are invisible.
This option reacts to each command except for the use of
dynamic Pan/Zoom commands. To update the display you can
release a normal zoom or Regenerate.
It is helpful to switch on the 'Dynamic' option.
Height Grid Lines In side or front views the height axes indicating the
corresponding height are displayed as well.
3D Pattern
Within
The grid is displayed within the work frame, too. This enables
snapping the endpoints of the grid on the planes.
Roof
Lock Layer
147
Work Frames
Segmentation
Text Style
Line Type
Select the line type for the connection lines of work frame
edges and axes names.
Text Scale
Colours
With Lines
Without Lines
On Screen Edge
148
Work Frames
From File
Only blocks are used which have already been defined in this
drawing.
DWG Blocks
Block Path
Block Name X
Block Name Y
149
Work Frames
150
Choose View
B.7
Choose View
Use this command to select the views defined by the work frames command or
by adding new views.
Once you select a view, ProSteel places the UCS into the selected work plane
and displays the 3D model looking at the plane vertically. The specified cut
planes are activated at the same time so that only the objects within this area
are visible.
In addition, you have access to all other auxiliary functions for view control using
this dialog.
This dialog shows you the views, which are the result of the settings for a work
frame with the area name R1. The views available in the model are sorted and
displayed in this list. Please note that you can modify the name of a view
manually via Change Properties.
Zoom Extents
Clipping-Plane
151
Choose View
Double Click
152
Insert Shapes
B.8
Insert Shapes
The actual design work with ProSteel starts when shapes are inserted into the
model. However, you need not deal with shape dimensions, representations,
etc., but simply instruct the program which shape shall be inserted where and
the program will carry out the operation. When inserting, you need not pay
attention to overlapping shapes: there are many possibilities of correcting
overlapping afterwards using a mouse click.
First, make sure that the shapes are correctly positioned. Since the shop
drawings are based on this position, proceed with care.
From now on, you will work in work frames of the model that are smaller:
Selection of an appropriate view and creation of further construction
lines, if necessary.
Insertion of some shapes and corrections, if necessary.
Adaptation of the shapes (e.g. shortening) and creation of connections.
Copying of identical parts, if any.
After selection of the command, a dialog window appears where you can specify
the basic behaviour of the command and further settings. You can create any
kinds of straight, bent or cranked shapes.
153
Insert Shapes
Shape Selection
Shape Type
Select the general shape type here. The ProSteel shapes are
divided into 5 different types:
Standard Shapes These are shapes based on a data base
included in the standard delivery range.
Special Shapes These are shape definitions which you can
create yourself by drawing the cross-section once and
creating a shape out of this cross-section.
Roof-Wall-Shapes These are special shapes created by you
which have been optimized for roof-wall installation.
Combination Shapes These are shapes which are combined
out of several already defined types.
Weld Shapes These are also user-defined and permit any
shape which can be welded by means of plates.
Resolution
154
Insert Shapes
Shape Class
Shape Size
Key
Further Defaults
Material
Layer
Part Family
If family classes have been defined, you can set them here.
The selection of the family class can influence the colour of
the part.
Detail Style
If detailing styles have been defined, you can set them here.
Display Class
If display classes have been defined, you can set them here.
Area Class
If area classes have been defined, you can set them here.
Description
Delta X
Delta Y
Item
Length
155
Insert Shapes
Turn
Here, you indicate the angle of rotation used to turn the shape
around the insertion axis.
Create Group
Insertion Points The standard insertion points of the shape are displayed on
the monitor.
User-defined Insertion Points
The user-defined insertion points of the shape are displayed
on the monitor.
Monitor
Insertion of Shapes
After having selected the shape type, resolution, shape class and size, the
shape can be inserted. There are several options to insert shapes.
In general, a shape is always inserted by means of two 3D-points. These points
can either be seized by picking the points or by picking a line. For this purpose,
the shape is positioned in a way that if you stood at the end point and looked
into the direction of the starting point the view corresponds to the depiction on
the monitor.
However, since two points alone dont clearly define the shape position in the
space, a third point is defined which determines the position (rotation)
depending on the situation:
You can indicate the third point.
When the two points are perpendicular in the world coordinate system
(WCS) the alignment is made according to the WCS x-axis.
When the points have been freely selected in the space, the alignment is
made in a way that the x-axis is aligned as parallel as possible towards
the WCS xy-plane.
156
Insert Shapes
Insertion Commands
ALONG LINE
First you are prompted to select a line. The end points of this line are
used as insertion points of the shape.
Since in most cases it is not clear which one of the line points is the
starting and which the end point, the program displays a cone for asymmetrical
shapes. This cone allows exchanging the insertion points and to obtain that the
shape is mirrored at the y-axis.
In the case of a dynamic dialog, this can alternatively be realized via the button.
If the selected line is a poly-line, a cranked shape will be inserted along the polyline. The bend radius is either taken from the input value on the option tab or if
this is 0, the minimum radius will be used.
ALONG 2 POINTS
First you are prompted to pick any two points in the space, which then
are used to insert the shape.
ALONG DIAGONAL
This option is also available if another point than the middle axis has
been selected as insertion point.
First you are prompted to select a line or to select two points using the
P option. Now the shape is inserted along these points as follows: The selected
insertion position at the starting point is kept (e.g. center of the lower edge). At
the end point, however, the opposite position is used (in this case center upper
edge).
If the Select Position after Insertion option is activated as well, the positions are
exchanged with rotations via the left mouse button.
ALONG 3 POINTS
You select the starting and end point where the shape has to be
inserted. Dynamic mode (see options) will be activated automatically. In
addition, you are prompted for the third point defining the alignment.
The shape dynamically follows each move of the mouse pointer and the position
can be determined very precisely.
157
Insert Shapes
Additional Functions
INTERRUPT DIALOG
All inserted shapes are still connected with the dialog, so that
subsequent modifications can also be transferred to already inserted
shapes.
If you dont want this option, you can interrupt the connection using this button.
However, the shape is not deleted in this case.
158
Insert Shapes
SHAPE DATA
Click this button to open the following dialog where all relevant shape
data are displayed:
MIRROR
All inserted shapes, which are still connected with the dialog, are
mirrored along their y-axis. You will obtain this by exchanging the
insertion points.
TURN POSITIVE
The shapes are turned positive (turned left in shape direction) around
their insertion point using the entered value.
TURN NEGATIVE
The shapes are turned negative (turned right in shape direction) around
their insertion point using the entered value.
159
Insert Shapes
Apart from normal straight shapes, you have also the possibility to insert a bent
shape. The bent shapes have a constant bending radius.
All settings for selection of the shape type, material, etc. are the same as in the
case of inserting straight shapes. For information, refer to this chapter.
All settings on this tab are stored separately from the straight shapes so that
your defaults on this page dont disturb the settings for straight shapes.
Insertion Functions
ALONG ARC
First you are prompted to pick an existing arc on the base of which the
shape will be inserted. The position of the arc in the space is not
important.
ALONG 3 POINTS
First you are prompted to pick the center point of the arc, the starting
point and the end point.
The points are perpendicular to the current UCS plane and the shape
then is inserted on the base of these points. It is not possible to insert a shape,
which is positioned in the space using this method. Nor can this command
create an arc of 180 degrees.
160
Insert Shapes
Height
Start Offset
End Offset
Radius
Scale
Horizontal Dist.
Vertical Dist.
Angular Insertion If you select an insertion along a defined length and position,
you can select here which point of the shape has to be used at
the pick point
InsertX,Y Plane All picked points are perpendicular to the current UCS-plane
before being evaluated.
161
Insert Shapes
Orientate
Dynamic
Reference Points The insertion points of the shape are entered as reference
points into the shape. This permits later tracing back of the
original insertion points and, if need be, their dimensioning.
3 Point Method
As 2D-Shape
Close Dialog
Keep Length
Notch Template Select the desired notch template from the available
templates.
Click this button to jump directly into the dialog Notch where
you can specify the settings for the notch and create new
templates.
162
Insert Shapes
SHAPE CATALOGUES
Click this button to limit the displayed catalogues at shape selection to
the types important for you.
In addition, you can freely determine the order of the entries to find
frequently used types on top position in the selection list.
Available Shape Series In this list (on the left) all country specific shape series
available in the program are listed sorted according to
countries. You can completely activate or deactivate the
shape series of a certain country.
The registration of a country is effected via a *.cfg file in the
shape data directory.
Available Shape Classes In this list (in the middle) all shape classes registered
by the activated country specific shape series are listed.
The registration of possible shape classes of a country is
effected via the entries in the corresponding *.cfg file in the
shape data directory.
163
Insert Shapes
Current Shape
In this list (on the right) all shape classes are displayed which
are available in the commands as entry.
These are displayed there in exactly this order.
The database entries of the corresponding shape file define
which shape sizes are available for the shape class.
Metric
Imperial
Automatic
Preferred Level
ADD
The shape class selected in the middle list will be added to the
end of the selection list.
INSERT
DELETE
The shape class marked in the right list will be removed from
the selection list.
INSERT ALL
All shape classes of the middle list will be taken over into the
right list.
DELETE ALL
All shape classes of the right list will be removed from there so
that the list will be empty.
Please note that in all ProSteel functions only the shape classes in the right
selection list are offered for selection.
164
Insert Shapes
165
Insert Shapes
Bent Segment
Radius
Angle
Rotation
The current rotation angle of the segment with regard to the xaxis (longitudinal axis) of the shape
The segment is additionally turned positive (to the left) using
the neighbouring angle.
The segment is additionally turned negative (to the right) using
the neighbouring angle.
Turn Angle
166
Insert Shapes
167
Insert Shapes
Here, you define the desired distances to the corresponding shape ends; a line
displays the position of the shape.
Now the subordinate girder is in any case
inserted in a way that it is aligned to the
upper edge of the main girders (the
position setting in the dialog for shape
insertion doesnt matter).
For the static effect lines and notches,
the same is valid as already described
above under Multiple.
168
Insert Shapes
Insert Columns
This function permits the insertion of columns with previously defined
pitches (e.g. for joints).
After having called the function, the following dialog opens, where you
can define the pitches in the list. Each line corresponds to a shape segment of
the column. Then, you have several insertion variants at disposal.
Starting Height
End Height
169
Insert Shapes
Click on this button to remove all entries from the list.
Insert Girder
This function permits to insert several girders at the work frame axes
(grid). At the intersection points of the axes, they are automatically
divided into segments.
To do so, you should first be in a plan view on the desired area because the
girders are always inserted in the current UCS. Then, you have to click on the
lower left and the upper right point of the area.
Now, all grid axes situated in this area are examined and the girders are
inserted along the axes according to the specifications of the shape insertion
dialog. Finally, these are divided at all intersection points of the grid axes.
Press the ALT-key while calling the function to specify a polygon for the creation
area. Press the STRG-key to specify a rectangular for the creation area.
170
Insert Shapes
The following example shows the automatic insertion of girders in an isometric
view:
In the upper figure, a frame is stretched out over the upper grid lines of the work
frame. The figure below shows the result of the automatic insertion.
171
Insert Shapes
172
Insert Plates
B.9
Insert Plates
Length
Width
Thickness
173
Insert Plates
Insertion Height This is the height of the plate above the current UCS.
X-Offset
Y-Offset
Item No.
Grid
Insertion Plane
174
Insert Plates
Insert Edge
Label
You can take the name of your plate from an editable file. The
content of this file is displayed in this list. The file is
..\Prg\pro_st3d.pdc. In addition to the name, you can
define a weight as well which has to be indicated in plain text.
After selection of a name, the material is directly set as well.
Material
Part Family
If part families are defined, you can set them here. The
selection of part family can influence the colour of the
component part.
Detail Style
Display Class
Area Class
Description
Layer
175
Insert Plates
Insert a plate at any line using this option. The length of the
line determines the plate length; the width and the thickness
are defined by your input.
After having realized this insertion, you can select the position, rotation and the
insertion point via the dialog. The rotation can either be modified in 90
increments or in freely selectable increments. The plate then is rotated around
the insertion line.
+Phi
- Phi
+90
-90
Rotation
CL
176
After insertion, the plates are still connected with the dialog.
Further modifications are still possible. Use this button to
interrupt this connection.
Insert Plates
Dialog-Commands
SURFACE GRID
Click on this button to define the alignment of the surface grid. Usually
this grid is aligned to the plate-ECS, it can be modified using this
button.
PLATE DIMENSIONS
Click on this button to define the calculation direction. First select the
plate and then the direction according to which calculation has to be
made. You can cancel the manual specification of direction in the plate
properties.
BEND
Click on this button to add edged or bent segments to the plate. The
result is a three-dimensionally bent plate which however is representing
a single component part and which can be depicted as flat via unfolding.
A dialog opens where you can select the reference edges and make further
settings (see under Bent plates).
Analysis of Dimensions
The calculation of plate dimensions is either carried out according to an
automatic pattern or it can be specified manually. At automatic calculation, the
following order is respected:
1) Are there any parallel edges and is their distance sufficient?
2) Is there any rectangular corner?
3) Search for the longest side
Depending on the geometry, the found direction is recognized as length
direction and the plate dimensions are aligned to this direction.
177
Insert Plates
178
Insert Plates
B.9.3 Gratings
Gratings are a special case in plate production. In principle, you can call any
plate a grating, but often customers ask to fall back on standard sizes
depending on the manufacturer. Another problem is to determine the weight for
the parts list which traditionally can only be calculated in an insufficient way.
ProSteel is able to manage gratings (resp. tear plates, fence elements, etc) in
their own database files indicating the exact weight per piece. Here, you can
comfortably select and insert these elements.
Selection List
179
Insert Plates
Flange Length
Front Distance Edge Here, you enter the front offset in the direction towards
the reference edge. Positive values mean that inwards the
segment becomes smaller.
180
Insert Plates
Rear Distance Edge Here, you enter the rear offset in the direction towards
the reference edge. Positive values mean that inwards the
segment becomes smaller.
Bending Radius The radius of the bend related to the neutral fibre (half of the
plate thickness). To avoid problems with the volume modeller,
the radius should always be a little bit more that half of the
plate thickness.
Bending Angle
181
Insert Plates
Combine Plates to Bent Plates
Apart from the adding of butt straps, you also have the possibility to create bent
plates from existing plates. In order to do so, select the plates to be connected.
Prerequisite for a correct connection of the plates is that you can generate a
tangential transition between the two plates.
Radius
Inside Radius
Delete
182
Insert Plates
Dependance of Segments
The following example vividly illustrates the connections between the segments
and their dependencies. You see the isometric depiction of a bent plate and the
plan view on the base plate (1).
First, the segment (2a) was added to the base plate (1) by using a bending
angle of 45. Then, the segment (3) was added to segment (2a) by also using a
bending angle of 45, but in addition it was equipped with a front and rear
(positive) distance to the edge. Finally, the segment (2b) was added to the base
plate (1) with a bending angle of 90.
If you now delete or modify the segment (2a), you will also delete or modify the
depending segment (3).
183
Insert Plates
Dialog Commands
ADD SEGMENT
Click on this button to add a new plate edge to the plate. In order to do
so, you have to click on the plate at the desired reference edge of a
plate segment. This determines the alignment of the new segment.
The new plate segment is always subordinate to the reference segment. If the
reference segment is modified later, the new segment will also be modified in
relation to this.
REMOVE SEGMENT
Click on this button to remove an existing plate segment (including all
subordinate segments). In order to do so, you have to click on the plate
segment at any edge you like.
MODIFY SEGMENT
Click on this button to modify an existing plate segment later. In order to
do so, you have to click on the plate segment at any edge you like.
Any subordinate segments of this plate segments will be modified too in
relation to this.
Important Hint: Please take care that you dont modify the basic polygon
of a plate (e.g. by adding an edge, or similar things) when you have
already added segments for a bent plate. The reference edges of the
segments would be modified as well and the consequence could be an
undesired behaviour.
184
Insert Plates
Always ECS
File Path
Grating Catalogue
The desired database file for gratings.
Close
185
Insert Plates
186
Insert Solids
PS_SOLID_SPHERE
This command creates a sphere.
First, you have to enter the central point of the sphere and
then the diameter of the sphere or click it.
Cylinder
PS_SOLID_CYLINDER
This command creates a cylinder.
First, you have to enter starting and end point of the cylinder
and then the radius or click it.
187
Insert Solids
Cone
PS_SOLID_CONE
This command creates a cone or truncated cone.
First, you have to enter starting and end point of the cone axis
or click it and then the starting and end point radius.
Torus
PS_SOLID_TORUS
This command creates a torus.
This requires that you first click or enter the rotation axis and
then enter the outer and inner radius.
PS_SOLID_CONICPIPE
This command creates a pipe that is conical on the inside and
outside.
First, you have to enter or click the longitudinal axis. Then you
can enter the outer and inner radius at the respective starting
and end point.
Pipe->Rectangle PS_SOLID_RECT2CIRCLE
This command creates a transition from a circular to a
rectangular cross-section.
First, you have to enter or click the lower left and upper right
point of the rectangle and then click the circle.
188
Insert Solids
Enveloping Solid PS_SOLID_HULL
This command creates an enveloping solid formed by any
points.
This requires that you click the points that are to form the
envelope. Using this command, you can create almost any
shape (without arcs).
Extrusion
PS_SOLID_EXTRUDE
This command creates a volume by extruding a poly-line,
which you have drawn beforehand.
You first click the poly-line and then enter the desired height.
The poly-line is then extruded along positive Z-direction of
UCS.
189
Insert Solids
190
3D Modifications
B.11 3D-Modifications
It may be necessary to correct the length of shapes and plates already inserted
or to provide bevels, notches, etc.
When inserting the component parts, you have paid attention to inserting the
shape at the correct position using the correct alignment, e.g., you have
positioned the axis on a system line. Very often component parts overlap and
must be adapted subsequently. Additionally, it may be necessary to rework your
model due to modifications.
ProSteel offers a large range of commands for the modification of component
parts. Some operations can (also) be executed using the standard AutoCAD
commands, and the grips. Others, require the corresponding ProSteel
commands.
There are many different commands for a modification depending on purpose.
In the following chapter, these commands are explained in detail. The
modifications are divided into commands for all parts, commands only for
shapes or only for plates, etc.
When you select the command, the following main dialog appears with the
commands for all parts.
191
3D Modifications
B.11.1
Divide / Combine
Cut at Line
This function allows complete shapes to be cut or extended at
boundaries, just like the AutoCAD command for the stretching and
cutting of lines. For this purpose, you first have to click the shape at the
end to be cut and then select the line.
The boundary is formed only by a construction line, which is arranged vertically
to the active UCS, plane and thus creating a cut plane. If the plane is slanted,
the modified shape will have a slanted plane, too. By using this function, shapes
that are too long or too short can be adapted to fit after their insertion.
When you have typed a value in the Distance field of the main dialog, the shape
will be shortened by this value after it has been cut. Please note that the
distance refers to a vertical distance between shape and cut plane.
The shape is cut at an imaginary plane, the line being oriented vertically to the
active UCS-plane. Working in a view simplifies your work, since the shape is cut
at this line. If the shape could intersect with the line (i. e. you consider the line
to be of infinite length!), the shape is cut. To extend the shape, hold down the
ALT key while clicking the end to be extended.
192
3D Modifications
Cut at Shape
The shape is cut or extended at another shape. When the shape is cut,
the shorter section is always cut off.
Click the shape to be cut and then the shape along which this shape is
to be cut.
The plane actually hit by the centerline (or the extended centerline) of the shape
to be cut will be the cut plane. If the centerline does not meet any surface, no
cut can be made!
Please note that a logical link is created between the parts if this option is
applied. The result will be that if one part is modified, the cut will be
automatically updated.
Divide a Shape
By using this function, you can divide a shape at a cutting line into two
shapes. A single shape, a plate or several elements can be divided into
two independent elements.
To start with, select the shape to be divided. Then, click the cutting line. When
you have entered a distance in the main dialog Distance, both new ends will be
shortened by this value. Depending on the setting, you can divide several
elements at the same time.
However, please note that the distance refers to a vertical distance between
shape and cutting line.
Distance
The two new shapes are shortened by this value at the cutting
line. The arising gap has the double distance value.
At Plane
If this option has been checked, you are asked for three
points, which have to form a plane. The parts are divided
along this plane.
193
3D Modifications
The cutting line may be any line. If the line is slanted, the shapes are divided
accordingly. If you indicate only one point, it will be used perpendicular to the
centerlines.
The information for the parts lists is identical for both parts with that of the initial
shape, except for the length. In order to master the course of the cut line better,
it is recommended to work in one of the view.
Example for Platform Design
For example, you can easily create changed girders at platform constructions by
first laying the shapes to be changed as a whole and then dividing them at their
rafters. Vice versa, rafters can be removed rapidly and the changes at this
position can be cancelled.
Let us assume that you want to design a
platform using the following shapes: platform
beams IPE 300, platform edge girders IPE 200,
headers HEA 120.
Create a working area with these dimensions
and insert the shapes at the construction lines
Overlaps can be ignored!
Change to the top view and use the dialog box for the processing of the
elements. As an alternative, you can also process the Y-axes of the general
overview in the front view.
Since IPE 300 has a flange width of 150 mm,
enter the value 75 in the Separation Distance
field and click the button DIVIDE. Zoom the
points of intersection one after the other,
select the uncut part of the cross girder to be
separated, and the construction line as
cutting line.
In the figure on the left, you see that you
have several shape parts now that can be
connected.
You need not insert each partial shape and
the risk for dimensional errors is eliminated. If
you want to remove beams, you can easily
close the gaps between cross girders and
create a continuous shape by clicking the
function Combine.
194
3D Modifications
195
3D Modifications
Width
Height
Depth
Position Width
Position Height
Position Depth
196
3D Modifications
Wedge-Type Outlet
Width
Height
Depth
Position Width
Position Height
Position Depth
Horizontal
Vertical
197
3D Modifications
Circular Outlet
Width
Height
Angle
Position Width
Position Height
Position Depth
Radius
198
3D Modifications
Position
You still have the possibility to rotate the inserted notch or cut-out by any of the
three coordinate axes. Just click the +90/-90 button, if you want to rotate the cutout in 90 steps. If you require a different angle just enter the value into the
Rotation Angle field and then click the +PHI/-PHI button.
The outer edge of the top flange is the cut-out
insertion point, the expected cut-out is defined
by edges.
199
3D Modifications
Polygonal Cut-Outs
Using this command, you can cut out shapes along any freely drawn contour
(poly-line). Thus, you can e.g. create notches that are not covered by the
program via the special notch function.
You can also subtract one shape from another to create penetrations, e.g. to
obtain slotted tubes, penetrated handrail posts or others.
If you have entered a value in the Gap Spacing input field of the main dialog, the
cut-out is regularly extended to all directions by the indicated value to gain some
space for inaccuracies of production.
In any case, the created polygon will be extended to the top and to the bottom in
the UCS Z-plane. Therefore, please pay attention that your UCS has been
selected accordingly. In case of a direct use of this function via the command
bar, the current settings of the main dialog apply.
Click this button if you have not yet a contour in form of a polyline or circle or arc.
You can enter the different points as you like, but be careful
that the lines dont overlap in the polygon.
Click this button if you have already a contour in form of a
poly-line, etc.
Click this button if you want to subtract the contour of another
solid from the selected object (penetration or solid to be
subtracted).
Complete
Gap Spacing
If you have divided a shape using this function, you will not obtain two shapes.
This has to do with the volume modeller of AutoCAD. You must take care not to
create two parts of a shape - e. g., by prior shape shortening.
If you want to obtain two shapes, please use first the function Divide and divide
the shape at a suitable point.
200
3D Modifications
In the following you can see two examples for the working of polygonal cut-outs:
on the left, there is a normal poly-cut and on the right, there is a milling via a
solid to be subtracted.
Create a Penetration
Here is still another example for creating a penetration of tubes:
On the first two pictures, you see the situation in the front
view and in the top view (the cutting planes are switched
off so that you can see the depth.
Put the selection for Poly-Cuts on Remove and click the
button POLY-CUT.
Now click the big tube, then one of the small tubes in
order to cut out the volume, Click the big tube again and
then the other small tube, in order to cut out its volume,
too.
in the third picture, you see the cut-outs in the big tube
(the two slanted tubes have been omitted in this
representation).
201
3D Modifications
B.11.2
Modify Shapes
Shortening
Click this button to shorten a shape by picking two points.
Their perpendicular distance to the center line specifies the
shortening value.
Click this button to shorten a shape by explicitly indicating the
value.
Click this button to shorten the shape by the value indicated
under default.
Default
In all three cases, you have to pick the shape at the end to be modified. If you
pick in the middle third of the shape length, each end is shortened by half the
specified value.
202
3D Modifications
Extend
These functions can be used analogously to shape shortening
in order to extend a shape. However, this doesnt work if the
selected end has been modified by a cut.
Gap
203
3D Modifications
Please note that a logical link is created between the parts at these cutting
commands. The result will be that if one part is modified, the cut will be
automatically updated.
Here, you see some examples for mitered cuts, which have been created using
different variants:
204
3D Modifications
B.11.3
Modify Plates
Modify Contour
Use this function to add another edge to the plate. For this
purpose, you have to pick the plate at the position to be
inserted.
Now, a new contour point will be created at the picked
position, which can be moved using the grips.
Use this function to delete an edge from the plate.
Use this function to transfer the contour of a plate to other
plates.
This function permits to adapt the basic polygon of a plate
processed by cuts to the current form. The corresponding
modifications become superfluous and are deleted.
If may sometimes be easier to modify the edges of a nonprocessed plate. In addition, this can be useful for data export
if modifications of the contour are not supported there.
Mitered Cut
205
3D Modifications
206
3D Modifications
B.11.4
Wall Processing
ProSteel permits you to create wall elements so that you can have displayed for
example the neighbouring buildings of your construction as well, if need be.
These functions help you for further processing the wall elements, e. g. to attach
openings.
Windows/Doors
Height
Width
Radius
Breast Height
207
3D Modifications
Edges
Click on this button to insert an additional vertical edge into an
existing wall element.
Click on this button to remove a vertical edge from an existing
wall element.
Specify Height
Click on this button to specify the height of a vertical edge at
the upper or lower side of the wall anew. Afterwards, the wall
is running diagonally from the neighbouring corner points to
the modified corner point.
Click on this button to specify the height of a wall segment at
the upper or lower side of the wall anew. Afterwards, the wall
is running diagonally from the neighbouring corner points to
the two modified corner points.
208
3D Modifications
B.11.5
Additional Settings
Multiple Selection
Cut at line
Cut at Object
Divide
Polycuts
Loop
Cut at Lines
Cut at Object
Divide
3D Modifications
Connect
Shorten
Lengthen
Poly-Cuts
Mitre Cut
Insert Corner
Delete Corner
Miscellaneous
Close Dialog
210
3D Modifications
B.11.6
Producing a Notch
For this purpose, you first have to click on the shape, which has to be notched,
and then the shape specifying the contour.
When you select the command, the connection is created on the base of your
last setting. Now you can fit the connection in the appearing dialog; you can
check the result immediately in the model.
211
3D Modifications
Layout
Here, you select the shape of the cope. The different variants
are shown in the picture below:
Edge The copes at the shape radii are carried out with a
beveled edge.
Radial The copes at the shape radii are carried out with
adapted radii. In the Radius input field, the determined radius
can be modified later.
Access Holes The holes are drilled in the inner corners of
the cope. In the Radius input field, the radius of the drill holes
can be preset.
Inner Edge
Both Sides Equal The bottom of the notch is carried out with the data of the top
and the data are transferred into the fields.
Exchange Sides The values of top and bottom are exchanged with each other
so that you can turn the connection.
Distances
212
3D Modifications
In the Radius input field, you can indicate the radius of Drill
Holes or Radial option.
Clicking this button allows an unknown shape to be clicked.
The flange thickness is then entered in the input fields for Top
and Bottom Flange Inside. If you have entered a value in the
+Distance field, this value will be added.
Using this function, a flange distance can be swiftly
determined without knowing the shape. As reference, you
should select the setting Outer Edge.
+ Distance:
213
3D Modifications
Standardized Notches
List
214
3D Modifications
Notch Type
Edge Layout
Web Distance
Both Sides Equal The notches are carried out equally on the top and on the
bottom of the shape.
Turn
Center Hole-Flange Distance from the upper / lower notch to the flange of the
shape.
Diameter
215
3D Modifications
Center Hole-End Distance of the notch from the end of the shape without taking
the web distance into consideration.
216
3D Modifications
Different from the notches described up to now, the default settings of this notch
are transformed into a poly-cut. The option for corner treatment is not available
here.
The result then looks as follows:
217
3D Modifications
Web Distance
FW
Flange Thickness
Angle of Intersection
A1, A2
Flange Distance
FF1, FF2
Center Hole-Flange
CT1, CT2
Diameter
D1, D2
Hole Center
FCL1, FCL2
Center Hole-End
B1, B2
218
3D Modifications
Other results of treatment with special shapes would be possible as well:
219
3D Modifications
B.11.7
Boolean Operations
For volume modelling, ProSteel does not use the AutoCAD volume modeller
ACIS but the modeller which is used in Architectural Desktop as well. This
modeller works faster and produces smaller graph files.
Consequently, you cannot process ProSteel objects with the Boolean operations
of AutoCAD (e.g. subtract their volumes). In case you do combine objects, there
will be no errors, but nothing will happen! In order to give you the same
performance range as with AutoCAD, all Boolean operations were redefined
(see also the command
Basic Solids). Another option is to use the ProSteel
properties to convert the ProSteel objects into ACIS volume models and then to
process them with AutoCAD. Your drawings will then become larger and more
sluggish.
Add
PS_ADD
This command creates a new volume by adding two existing
volumes.
You have to click both objects and the newly created object
receives all parts list information of the object you clicked on
first.
Subtract
PS_SUB
This command creates a new volume by subtracting one or
several volumes from an existing volume.
First, you have to click the object from which the other
volumes are to be subtracted. Then click the objects whose
volume is to be subtracted (these will be deleted in the
process!).
The new object receives all parts list information of the object
you clicked on first. Please note, that you will not create two
independent objects in case you split the first object in the
process.
220
3D Modifications
Cut-Set
PS_COMMON
This command creates a new volume by using the cut-set of
two existing volumes, i. e., the new volume is the part the two
objects shared.
You have to click both objects and the new object will receive
all parts list information of the object you clicked on first.
Schnittmenge abziehen
PS_COMMON_SUB
221
3D Modifications
222
Plate Editor
A special plate editor is available for processing of plates. This editor allows for
modifying the contour by adding or separating poly-lines in a fast and
comfortable way. You may see the poly-line as a plate of the same thickness
and position like the plate to be processed.
In addition, you can add chamfers and edges. All commands can also be carried
out via the normal manipulation. The use of the plate editor is recommended
when poly-plates have to be processed in complex situations because it can
hide the other component parts and it automatically enters the plate level.
When loading the function, click the plate to be modified first. Then a dialog
appears where you can enter further indications with regard to the desired
processing.
223
Plate Editor
B.12.1
Boolean Operations
Boolean Opera Here, you specify what kind of processing has to be carried
out: either Add, Subtract or Common.
Side
Contour
Distance
Milling Width
Depth
Hide Parts
Continued
224
Plate Editor
225
Plate Editor
B.12.2
Chamfer
Use this button to select the corresponding corner of the plate
if you want to add a chamfer to a plate. Then, the input fields
are released.
Layout
Radius/1st. Edge Here, you indicate the radius at convex/concave version or the
length of the first edge at straight version.
2nd. Edge
226
Plate Editor
Rounding Off
Use this button to select the corresponding plate edge to
round off an edge. Then, the input fields are released.
You can define the rounding off either via the radius or via the
height of the rounding above the straight edge.
Radius
Min. Radius
Height
Max. Height
227
Plate Editor
B.12.3
Edge Processing
This function serves for processing of one or more edges. The edges can be
chamfered, rounded off, been equipped with a radius or seamed.
228
Plate Editor
Top Side
Bottom Side
The following parameters are valid both for top and bottom side of the plate.
Var1
This value is either the length of the first edge, the rounding
radius or the depth of the seam.
Var2
This value is either the length of the second edge or the height
of the seam.
Selected Edge
Select e. g. 0-1, 2-3 for the edges to be processed, when you want to
process the two opposite sides.
229
Plate Editor
230
231
B.13.1
Layout
Shape/X Dir
Description of drill hole field in shape direction, for plates in xdirection of the UCS.
Cross/Y Dir
232
Radius
The radius of the circle where the drill holes are arranged
around the insertion point
Area
The angle area throughout which the drill holes are distributed.
Start
The starting angle from which on the drill holes are distributed.
Addition
If you dont insert any thread hole, you can enter here the
clearance between bolt diameter and hole diameter. In the
above list, you can also define a Workloose for the bolt
diameters. However, you have to activate the use in the
Global Settings / Bolts. You can enter any value here.
Rectangle Hole Axis If rectangle holes have to be inserted, you enter the length
of the rectangle hole axis here.
Layout
Drill Through Drill holes are created from one material edge
to the other.
Drill Blind Hole The holes have only a certain length.
Weld Crack This is a small marking.
Depth
Specify the depth of the drill hole for the layout Drill Blind
Hole.
Flange
Shape Centre
233
You can also adopt a drill hole field with simultaneous bolted
connection into a new shape so that the new shape is drilled
first and then bolted. First select the properties of the shape
and click on the EDIT button in the Drill Holes tab.
The drill hole dialog described here will be displayed and you
can adopt the drill holes with bolts using Bolts/Add.
Monitor
234
Here you can see the creation of the drill hole field and define
the insertion point.
2*60,200,1*,200,3*40
2*100
You can enter the predefined marking gauges of the shape by typing the letter
W instead of a pitch, e.g. 2*W. If no specific marking gauge has been defined for
the current shape, the program will prompt you to enter one.
235
B.13.2
Bolted Connections
Alternatively to drilling option, you can directly add a bolted connection to the
component parts. For this purpose, you have to select at least 2 component
parts the distance of which is not bigger than specified in the gap input field.
All settings with regard to drill hole field, diameter, etc. are made on the first
page.
Bolt Style
Gap
Normally, drill holes are created along the z-axis of the current
UCS.
At bolted connection option, however, the program can be
prompted to search for contact surfaces. Normally, these are
the surfaces where a bolted connection is inserted. For this
purpose, the UCS doesnt have to be placed normally on
these surfaces.
Single Hole Bolt The insertion of bolts into a part is allowed as well.
Turn
Update auto
237
B.13.3
Additional Settings
Hole Type
Normal Drill
Countersunk
Step Hole
The hole is drilled as step hole. You can determine the Depth
of the step and the upper diameter additionally. The figure
below shows you all three available layouts one beside the
other.
Hole Type
Offset
You can influence the insertion point of the drill hole using an
offset related to the selected insertion point.
Rectangular
238
Polar
In this case you can enter the offset by means of distance and
angle related to the insertion axis. In the case of shapes, the
insertion axis is the longitudinal axis instead of the x-axis.
Shape Centre
Pitch Lines
Centre Lines
Ignore Inner...
Create Thread
239
Edge Distances
ProSteel can automatically verify the admissible edge distance during drilling of
component parts. It is also possible to carry out this control manually for certain
parts.
If an automatic control has to take place, which is activated directly during
drilling, you have to switch on the corresponding option in the global settings.
You can specify the admissible edge distances of shapes and plates for each
hole diameter in a table. The corresponding drill hole then will be verified by
means of this table and the part will be marked in colour if the distance is too
small. If the automatic control is activated, an info window appears during
drilling. However, the drilling will be realized nevertheless.
In this table, you can assign the corresponding minimum distances for any
existing drill hole diameter, separated according to shapes and plates.
Click this button to start controlling the edge distances. You
are prompted to select the parts. If the drill hole distances of a
part are smaller than the selected distances, this part will be
highlighted in colour. You can remove this marking using the
command PS_REGEN.
If you suppress any further display during automatic control,
any existing smaller distances will not be displayed any more.
This button serves for removing the lock of the display.
If you have activated the Expert mode in the global settings,
this button will be additionally displayed. It permits editing of
the diameter table.
240
Dia.
Shapes
Plates
When you quit this dialog with OK, the indicated values are adopted into the
table and this list is sorted anew according to the available diameters.
Automatic Control
If the automatic control of the edge distances has been activated and the
program detects smaller edge distances during an operation, a warning
message will be displayed.
However, this warning is only a hint; the corresponding drill hole will
nevertheless be inserted into the component part. Please note that this
message might not appear before end of the action.
241
242
Bolts
B.14 Bolts
Bolting of component parts is the easiest form of automatic connections
provided by ProSteel. In previous versions, the components to be bolted had to
be drilled first.which now is not necessary any more. Of course, it is still possible
to continue working with the existing combination of drilling/bolting.
Another option is the creation of user-defined bolt styles as well as the check
and update of the bolting via logical links (please refer to ->'Logical Links'). In
some connection dialogs, a lot of settings are not necessary and you can set the
bolts exactly according to your requirements.
After all component parts, to be bolted with each other are selected, the
program checks the position of the parts with regard to possible bolting (if need
be, with regard to drillings which are situated one above the other and having an
allowable tolerance; but it does not check possible mounting). Necessary bolt
lengths are calculated and the bolts are inserted according to your default
settings with regard to type and possible washers. Then, the bolts are adopted
into a bolt list for later parts list.
243
Bolts
B.14.1
Bolting parts
The components are bolted automatically after part selection and selection of
the bolt style. The holes in the component parts are analysed and the
corresponding bolts are selected and inserted.
After having loaded the function, you will get the following screen display:
Bolt style
Work loose
244
Bolts
Length Addition Indicates the value by which the bolts are extended. This is
valid for all kinds of insertion.
Gap distance
Angle difference This is the difference of the angles of the drilled holes in
degrees. If this value is exceeded, the holes don't align and
cannot be bolted.
Colours
245
Bolts
B.14.2
Bolt Style
nd
Washer
nd
nd
washer. It
Tapered Washer
Activate this option if your style definition is to be
nd
equipped with a 2 wedge washer.
nd
246
Bolts
Tapered washer
Washer
Nut
Safety nut
247
Bolts
Bolt Definition
When the button for bolt definition is pressed, the following dialog opens:
Style name
Data file
Indicates which data file is used for bolts with this style. Only
bolt files are displayed.
Export name
Material
Tension
Length Addition Enter the additional length of the bolts. The bolt will be
extended by this value after length calculation.
248
Bolts
Layout
Units
Coating
Colour
Bitmap
Countersunk head
The bolt is displayed as countersunk bolt.
Parts list entry
Inner Hexagon
No DM Check
Enter the width of the mounting space at the bolt head either
as absolute value, i.e. as many times the amount of the
diameter via *xx or as addition to the diameter via +xx.
Enter the length of the mounting space at the bolt head either
as absolute value, i.e. as many times the amount of the length
via *xx or as addition to the length via +xx.
249
Bolts
Lower Area
250
Enter the width of the mounting space at the bolt base either
as absolute value, i.e. as many times the amount of the
diameter via *xx or as addition to the diameter via +xx.
Enter the length of the mounting space at the bolt base either
as absolute value, i.e. as many times the amount of the nut
height via *xx or as addition to the nut height via +xx.
Bolts
Nut Definition
Data file
Indicates which data files are used for nuts with this style.
Only nut files are displayed.
Partlist entry
Export name
Material
Partlist Entry
251
Bolts
Washer Definition
Data file
Indicates which data files are used for washers with this style.
Only washer files are displayed.
Export name
Material
Partlist entry
252
Bolts
Data file
Indicates which data files are used for washers with this style.
Only washer files are displayed.
Material
Partlist entry
253
Bolts
B.14.3
On this page, you can define threaded rods and insert them into the model.
Bolt Style
Diameter
End Offset
Round to
254
Bolts
B.14.4
Sort
This dialog page serves for management of bolt style selection lists and for
creation of new bolt styles.
Serves for creation of new bolt styles. After selection, you are
asked for the name of the new style. Then, the style is created
and is equipped with the settings of the current style.
Allows loading of a style from the file. The style is inserted at
the current position.
The currently checked style is deleted without further query.
The currently checked style is moved upwards in the list.
The currently checked style is moved downwards in the list.
All style definitions stored in your corresponding files will be
updated. The styles are stored as objects in the drawing.
When the style definition is modified on the hard disk, normally
the modifications are not transferred to the internal objects.
They are carried out for all styles by this function.
255
Bolts
256
Insert Stiffeners
Insertion of Stiffeners
You can insert stiffeners either in views or in the global view. When you have
selected normal stiffeners (i.e. stiffeners running vertically to the shape axis),
you are prompted to specify the shape where the stiffeners are to be inserted.
After selection, the program prompts you to specify the center of the insertion
point of the stiffeners. Click the point you want on the shape or on a construction
line. Your pick point is generally placed perpendicular to the shape axis.
When you have selected Full Stiffener, the stiffener is inserted to fit. When you
have selected Half Stiffener or To Measure, you are prompted to specify the
fastening side of the stiffeners. Click the flange side with which the stiffeners are
to be in contact.
Lets assume that you have drawn the construction lines on the upper flange in
the top view as shown on the left. If you click the line at any point, the pick point
is always positioned perpendicular to the axis and used as the insertion point of
the stiffeners.
257
Insert Stiffeners
Dimensions
Layout
Use Flat..
Full Stiffener
Half Stiffener
The stiffener height stretches over half the web height of the
shape where the side is determined by the picked side.
By Length
258
Insert Stiffeners
Square
Thickness
Flange Offset
Web Distance
Length
This is the value for the stiffener length when you have
selected the stiffener length To Measure.
Offset
Round to
Radius
In the Radius input field you specify the radius of the ribbed
plate at the shape radii. If this value is 0, the shape radius is
imported. If you have selected the create Insert at Slant, the
radius is bridged by a slanted edge.
Click this button to move the stiffener with respect to the
insertion point.
After insertion, the stiffener first is placed in the middle of the
insertion point. However, you can also align it to the upper or
lower edge of the stiffener by clicking repeatedly on it.
259
Insert Stiffeners
Connect
On this page you specify the weld style in the case the stiffeners have to be
welded directly. You can also attach weld cracks to mark the stiffeners in the
shape.
Weld Style
Flange Side
Thickness
Web Side
Thickness
Weld Mark
260
Insert Stiffeners
Create Group
Options
Angle insertion
261
Insert Stiffeners
Angle
Here you can enter the position angle related to the centerline.
2D-Section
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is
possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the
component part and then select the settings.
Oblique Stiffeners
In principle, the insertion of oblique stiffeners is the same as described above,
except for the fact that you are prompted to define a position line of the
stiffeners. Click a (construction) line showing the orientation of the stiffeners.
Now, the stiffeners are inserted into the shape in an oblique position. The
distances refer to the outer corners of the stiffener plates.
If you select the command via PS_RIP_ANGLE, you will be prompted for the
position line right during input and can then click it.
Show the center line of the shape in the top view and use the virtual point of
intersection without Z, in order to get an exact center point of insertion using the
point of intersection of the axis and the construction line.
262
Plate Connections
263
Plate Connections
B.16.1
Layout of Plate
264
Plate Connections
Thickness
Length
Gap
Offset Top
Offset
Doubler Plate
As Poly-Plate
The inserted end plates are not created as flats but as polyplate.
Rotate Connection In case of asymmetric plates you can define the plate
position here. Use this option to turn the complete connection
by 180 around the insertion axis, if upper and lower side were
exchanged at generation of the connection.
265
Plate Connections
Equal Plates
Gap
Plate Offset
Normal:
PS_ENDPLATE_NORM
As Splice:
PS_ENDPLATE_SPLICE
At Flange:
PS_ENDPLATE_FLANGE
266
Plate Connections
Drill Holes
Without Holes
Group Vertical
The drill hole spacing in a vertical direction (height) is determined. Depending on
the entry, the values have different meanings. Examples are given at the end of
the command description.
Upside
Here, you enter the distance of the upper row of holes from
the plates upper edge. If this value is 0, and the value in the
box Downside is also 0, the only entry that will be used is in
the Middle field.
Middle
Here, you enter the distance of the first and second row of
holes from the upper and lower plate edge. The holes will be
distributed uniformly between the two outer holes if this value
is 0. The other rows of holes will be arranged in the same
manner if the number is greater than 4.
Downside
Here, you enter the distance of the lowest row of holes from
the plates lower edge. If this value is 0, and the value in the
box Upside is also 0, the only entry that will be used is in the
Middle field.
267
Plate Connections
Offset
Asymmetrical
Measured from
Group Horizontal
The drill hole spacing in a horizontal direction (width) is defined here. Examples
are given at the end of the command description.
Left
Here, you enter the distance between the outer left row of
holes and the central left row of holes, if the number of rows is
4.
Middle
Here, you enter the distance between the two inner rows of
holes. The rows of holes are generally arranged centrally,
unless they are offset by an entry in the Offset field.
Right
Here, you enter the distance between the outer right row of
holes and the central right row of holes, if the number of rows
is 4.
Offset
268
Plate Connections
Connect
Bolt Settings
Bolt style
You can select the type of bolts (e.g., DIN 6914) to be used for
the connection using this list.
Dia
Workloose
Weld Settings
Weld Style
Weld...
269
Plate Connections
Stiffening Plates
As Poly-Plate
Backer Plates
Top Plate
Web Plates
Web Plates
Dimensions
Drill Holes
270
Plate Connections
Stiffeners
Stiffener
On the side of the end plate, stiffeners are inserted into the
supporting shape at the level of the flanges.
Inner Stiffeners
Support Stiffeners Here, you can insert additional diagonal ribs into the
supporting shape. With the Height entry, you define the
distance of the lower insertion point to the inner side of the
flange.
The prerequisite for generating this stiffeners is the use of a
bottom flange haunch having a stiffener on the side of the
bottom flange haunch and a cover plate.
Click this button to select the command for insertion or edition
of stiffeners. Here, you can modify the values and create new
templates.
271
Plate Connections
Please note that the settings for stiffeners cannot be made independently here.
You only select a template containing the necessary parameters.
The advantage is that you have to define a certain kind of stiffener only once
and then only select it by using its name. However, you mustnt forget that in
case of modifying this page after having modified this stiffener template
the existing stiffeners are updated as well (i.e. they will obtain the
dimensions of the modified template).
Stiffeners at Bottom Flange Haunch
Supporting Shape Here, you specify the stiffener in the supporting shape at use
of a bottom flange haunch.
Connecting Shape Here you specify the stiffener in the connecting shape at use
of a bottom flange haunch.
Here, you see an example of an end plate connection with bottom flange
haunch, cover plate and diagonal stiffener in the supporting shape:
272
Plate Connections
Select Haunch
Haunch Length
Cut Width
Top Height
Flange Width
273
Plate Connections
... as Plate
Rectangular Plate
Rib Support
Rib Connection
274
Plate Connections
Form Group
With Bolts
With Welds
Safety Notches
Safety Copes...
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is
possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the
component part and then select the settings.
275
Plate Connections
B.16.2
In the selection list, you can see the connections according to DAST, which is
available for the selected shapes. You can control the basic connection data in
this list, and the necessary shape stiffeners are displayed as well.
Tension, Shear... Here, you can enter a maximum load for the connection (in
KN) for the corresponding load type. In the list, only the
connections suitable for these loads will be displayed.
Plate List
No Connection Possible
If - according to the guidelines - no connection is defined for the selected
shapes, no dialog tab will appear after selection of the shapes to define the
connection. In this case, you have to define yourself the dimensions of the
connection.
276
Plate Connections
Width
Thickness
Length
Horizontal
Vertical
Diameter
Bolt Standard
Stiffeners
Backer
Strengthening
Projection
Af
As
277
Plate Connections
278
Plate Connections
B.16.3
User-Defined Connections
Just as the data for plates resistant to deflection and those subject to shear
forces is recorded in databases, you can also create a database containing
user-defined plate connections and later load these stored types using a
selection list.
In principle, this serves the same purpose as storing and then loading free
plates with the template function. User-defined plate connections can display a
larger amount of data in a more clearly organized structure because all
parameters are visible in the view.
You can also process or export the data with any standard dBASE editor.
HINT: Take advantage of this option by creating a database with frequently
utilized and maybe company-specific connections, which are then always
available to all program users within your company.
Since the dialog and process after creation of the database is almost identical
except for the selection - with those for the plates resistant to deflection, you can
refer to this chapter for the meaning of the settings (see Plates Resistant to
Deflection). How to create the database is listed in the technical supplement or
just ask ProSteel dealer.
279
Plate Connections
280
281
Layout
Plate Height
Group Options
In Shape Direction If this option is activated, the plate is always attached
normally beneath the shape. If the shape is slanted in the
space, the plate is slanted as well.
282
As Polyplate
Drill Holes
Hole Distance
Hole Diameter
283
Bolts / Dowels
On this page, you make the settings of anchor bolts or welds. Anchor bolts are
only displayed as symbols and cannot be detailed.
Group Bolts
Tie Bolts
Label
The designation of anchor bolts for the parts list; this name
can contain two variables, $(ID) for inner diameter and
$(OD) for outer diameter.
...Outside
Anchor bolts are inserted for the outer drill hole field as well, if
defined.
Use Dowel
Input Field
In Bolt Partlist
The dowels are taken over into the bolt part list.
No Detailing
Flange Side
Thickness
If you want to overwrite the style thickness, you can enter the
desired thickness for the flange side here.
Web Side
284
Thickness
If you want to overwrite the style thickness, you can enter the
desired thickness for the web side here.
Standard Definitions
Data base entries are saved for certain DIN shapes. If you have selected a
shape having such entries, these will be displayed in this window. You can
influence the selection by means of different selection criteria. Only data records
corresponding to these criteria will be displayed.
Support Load
Hole Dia.
285
Dowels
In addition, you can specify the type of dowel for fixing the base plates.
You can modify the execution of the dowel with the anchor bolt by modifying the
values for diameter, length and key.
Assignments
As it is the case for each dialog creating component parts, here too, it is
possible to make all assignments for each individual shape directly. Select the
component part and then select the settings.
286
Shapes
287
Shape Class,...
Use Flat
The web angle will be made from bent plate steel instead of
angle steel.
Enter the required dimensions in the Thickness, length of
Long Leg, length of Short Leg and Bent Radius input fields.
The program will determine the actual length of the steel plate.
Position
Turn Angles
The long and short side of the web angle are exchanged so
that the long side is situated at the connecting shape.
Gap
Side Offset
Vertical Offset
Here you indicate the distance the web angle is shifted from
the axis of the shape to be connected, upwards or to the right
(depending on the position). A negative entry will cause
shifting in the opposite direction. Selecting one of the following
options permits you to make additional specifications referring
to the dimension.
From Edge
Lower Edge
The vertical offset refers to the lower edge of shape and web
angle instead of to the upper edge.
Up to First Bolt
The vertical offset refers to the centre of the first bolt instead
of to the edges of the web angle.
288
Distances
289
Bolt Settings
Bolt Style
Select the bolt style (e.g. DIN 7990) for the connection in the
list
Dia.
Workloose
Diagonal Offset A shift of the bolt axes between support and connecting bolts.
Gap Spacing
290
Welding
Weld Settings
Weld Style
Weld...
291
Cope
In addition, you can add a cope to the connecting shape. Here, you enter the
specifications of the cope.
Cope
Connect. Shape Here you define how the connecting shape has to be coped.
You can select Upper Side, Lower Side or Both.
Specify the necessary gap distance for the cope in the Gap
field.
Click this button to create or modify the cope template.
Safety...
292
Standard Data
In the selection list, you can see the web angle connections available in the
database. In this list, you can verify the basic parameters of the connection data.
H(kN), Hz(kN)
List
Bolt
Dia
Material
293
294
Form Group
Create Group
With Bolts...
Each Angle
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is
possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the
component part and then select the settings.
295
296
Shear Plates
Shapes
Thickness
Cut Plate
297
Shear Plates
Normal to...
Poly-Plates
Turn Flat
Position
From Edge
Lower Edge
The vertical offset refers to the lower edge of shape and web
plate.
Up to 1st. Bolt
If you have checked the field Up to 1st. Bolt, the vertical offset
doesnt refer to the edges of the web plate but to the center of
the first drill hole.
Gap
Vertical Offset
In the input field Vertical Offset you enter the distance of the
offset for the web plate from the axis of the shape to be
connected towards top or to the right (depending on position).
Negative values effect an opposite offset.
298
Shear Plates
Distances
End Offset
Distance of the last center of a drill hole to the end of the web
plate on the side of the connecting shape.
Connection
Dist. Between.
Edge Distance
Distance of the drill holes to the outer edge of the web plate.
Dist. Between
299
Shear Plates
Connect
Bolt Settings
Bolts
Select the bolt style (e.g. DIN 7990) for the connection in the
list
Dia
Workloose
Weld Settings
Weld Style
Weld...
300
Shear Plates
Cope
In addition, you can notch the connecting shape. Enter the corresponding
specifications in this dialog box.
Notch
Cope Connect Here, you specify how the connecting shape has to be
notched. You can select Upper Side, Lower Side or Both.
Define the necessary gap distance for the notch in the Gap
field.
301
Shear Plates
Standard Data
In the selection list, you can see the shear plate connections available in the
database. In this list, you can verify the basic parameters of the connecting data.
H(kN), Hz(kN)
List
302
Shear Plates
Meaning of the List Entries
Designation
Connection name
Thickness
Material
Dia
Bolt
Shape Direction The number of drill holes along the shape to be connected.
Crosswise
MaH, MaHz
303
Shear Plates
Form Group
Create Group
With Bolts...
The bolts and weld seams are also added to that group.
Each Plate
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is
possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the
component part and then select the settings.
304
Splice Joints
305
Splice Joints
Options
Gap Distance
Bolts
Dia
Specify the desired bolt diameter from the list or enter the
value directly if this option has been activated.
Workloose
Upper Side
Lower Side
Single Side
Upper Inside
Lower Inside
306
Splice Joints
Diagonal
Left
Right
Create Group
With Bolts
Top/Bottom
On the second page, you can enter the settings for the upper and lower splice.
307
Splice Joints
Edges Inside
Dist. Between
Inner Distance
Dist. Between
Thickness
Select the plate thickness from the list. If you have activated
the free selection option, you can enter this value directly.
Vertical
Weld
Length
As
Weld Style
308
Splice Joints
Left/Right
On the third page, you can enter the settings for the left and right splice.
Number Shape.. Indicates the number of bolts in shape direction at each side
Edges Outside
Edges Inside
Dist. Between
Inner Distance
Dist. Between.
Thickness
Select the plate thickness from the list. If you have activated
the free selection option, you can enter this value directly.
Vertical
309
Splice Joints
Weld
Length
As
Weld Style
Data
When you have defined a database for the selected shape, another page will be
displayed. There, you can select the desired entry.
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is
possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the
component part and then select the settings.
310
Purlin Connection
Bolted Connection
Number Transv. Here, you enter the number of drill holes in transversal
direction of the purlin shape.
Distance Transv. Here you can indicate the axis distance at two or more drill
holes.
311
Purlin Connection
Number Length Here, you enter the number of drill holes in shape direction of
the purlin course.
Distance Length Here you can indicate the axis distance at two or more drill
holes.
Bolts
Select the bolt type (e.g. DIN 7990) for the connection in the
list
Dia
Workloose
Offset
List
312
Purlin Connection
Purlin Socket
Drill Holes
Bolts
Select the bolt type (e.g. DIN 7990) for the connection in the
list
Dia
313
Purlin Connection
Dia Side
Workloose
Create Group
With Bolts
Opposite Side
Backer Plates
Offset
List
314
Purlin Connection
Connection Plate
Drill Holes
315
Purlin Connection
Bolts
Select the bolt type (e.g. DIN 7990) for the connection in the
list
Dia
Workloose
With Bolts
Opposite Side
Weld Seam
The plate is welded to the roof girder. In the Af input field, you
can specify the thickness of the weld seam, and in the
selection list you can indicate the type of the weld seam.
Offset
List
316
Purlin Connection
317
Purlin Connection
Thickness
Length
Height
Inner/Outer Chamfer
Here, you enter the horizontal and vertical dimensions
of the inner (1) or outer (2) chamfer.
Weld Seam
318
The plate is welded to the roof girder. In the Af input field, you
can specify the thickness of the weld seam, and in the
selection list you can indicate the type of the weld seam.
Purlin Connection
Connection Shape
Length
Number
Base Drill Holes Specify the distance of the roof girder holes to the outer edge
of the purlin course.
Lateral Drill
Here, you indicate the distance of the drill holes in the purlin
course to the upper edge of the roof girder.
Bolts
Select the bolt type (e.g. DIN 7990) for the connection in the
list
Dia
Dia Side
Workloose
Perpendicular
Turn
Purlin Connection
Create Group
With Bolts
Opposite Side
Backer Plates
Offset
Shape Type
Here, you can select the shape to be used for the connection.
Special shapes can be used as well.
List
320
Gusset Plates
Dia
Workloose
Offset
Here, you specify the value by which the gusset plate has to
extend beyond the shape edges in transversal shape
direction.
321
Gusset Plates
Gusset Pos
Limiting Shape
Weld Bracing
If this field has been checked, the shapes and the plate are
not drilled. It is possible to combine them with each other
using a weld.
Form Group
With Bolts
If the 'With Bolts' field has been checked as well, the bolts of
the shape to be connected are also added to that group.
322
Gusset Plates
Number Shape
1 Edge 1 Hole
Hole Hole
n Hole - Edge
Please note that you can indicate all distances either as absolute values or as
many times the amount of bolt diameter. Enter e.g. *2 for the double value to
obtain many times the amount of bolt diameter.
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog of the component parts, here too it is possible
to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the
component part and then select the settings.
323
Gusset Plates
324
Dynamic Bracing
325
Dynamic Bracing
B.23.1
Common Settings
Generalities
Shape Selection: Here you indicate the utilized shapes for the bracing bars.
Enter the shape catalogue into the first selection box, the
shape type into the second, and the shape size into the third.
Plate Thickness indicates the thickness of the gusset plate.
Edge distance
Here you can specify the distance from the outermost edge of
the bracing bar to the boundary edge of the bracing (this is
most often a shape edge).
Round shapes
Plate width
Position
326
Dynamic Bracing
Form
Opening Angle
Here you can determine the opening angle of the gusset plate
towards the bracing bar at the shape Triangle bent.
Cross Bracing:
Welded Bracing If this switch is checked, the bracing is welded in its entirety.
No borings are added in that case.
Form Group:
Symmetrical:
No Gusset Plates
Dynamic:
327
Dynamic Bracing
328
Dynamic Bracing
Bolts
Group Bolts
Bolts
Dm
Work loose
Group Holes
Here you enter the number of borings and the spacing of the drilled holes to be
observed. You can either specify absolute values or how many times the
amount of the hole diameter. If the entries have to be a multiple of the hole
diameter, put an asterisk (*) in front of the multiplier.
Shape Direction The number of drilled holes in the direction of the bracing bar
(on both ends).
st
Edge-1 hole
the distance from the end of the bracing bar to the first hole
center in the direction of the bar.
Hole-Hole
sets the space between the drilled holes in the direction of the
bar.
n-th Hole-Edge
The distance from the last hole to the outer edge of the gusset
plate in the direction of the bar.
329
Dynamic Bracing
Cross Direction
Distribution
330
Dynamic Bracing
B.23.2
Shape Bracing
If you would like to create a bracing from shapes and gusset plates, select the
Shape distance the distance of the shapes for offset or 4-Times bracings.
Rotation Angle
Dynamic Bracing
Offset
Shorten
Mirror Shapes
Center Hole
Divide All
Distance
Offset
Number
332
Dynamic Bracing
st
Edge-1 hole
The distance from the end of the batten plate to the first hole
center in the direction of the bar.
Hole-Hole
The space between the drilled holes in the direction of the bar
Dia
Work loose
Weld
333
Dynamic Bracing
B.23.3
Rod Bracing
If you would like to create a bracing from tension rods, select the folder Rod
Bracing. You can select a variety of different variations.
Layout
Offset
334
Dynamic Bracing
335
Dynamic Bracing
Tension Rod
A bracing with a tension rod is generated, which has a welded
on connection element.
The Butt Strap field is used to specify the length of the
connection element.
The Butt Strap Width field is used to specify the width of the
connection element.
The Butt Strap Thickness field is used to specify the thickness
of the connection element.
The Bolt Diameter field is used to specify the bolt hole
diameter in the connection element.
The Outer Radius field is used to specify the outer radius of
the connection element.
The Part Description field is used to specify a term for the
tension element to be used with the parts list
Beneath please find an example for the different variants of a tension rod
bracing:
Bracing Catalogues
Databases may be generated for the tension elements of all three types. The
terms and dimensions can be loaded from these databases. An additional folder
Bracing Catalogues will be displayed where you can select a dBASE-file.
After selection of a valid file, you can choose a tension element for the different
versions from a selection list. This element is defined in the database. The
dialog entries will then be filled with the corresponding values.
336
Dynamic Bracing
B.23.4
Pipe Bracing
If you would like to create a bracing from pressure pipes and butt straps, select
the folder Pipe Bracing. You can select a variety of different variations.
337
Dynamic Bracing
Butt Strap Offset Specify the overlap length of the pressure pipe and the strap
Escape Gap
Shapes:
You can select the shapes in the selection lists, if you have
selected 'T-shapes' as butt strap type.
Group Endplates
You can indicate further specifications for the head plate, if you have selected
'Head Plate' as butt strap type.
Width
Thickness
Type
Assignments
The created component parts can receive different assignments such as
material and so on.
338
Static Bracing
339
Static Bracing
B.24.1
Settings
Shape Definition
Shape Type
Resolution
Shape Class
Shape Size
UCS-Position
340
Static Bracing
Rod Position
Rod Insertion
Here you specify the position of the rod with respect to the
insertion line (system line). You can insert the rod in the
middle, on the gravity line or on the root line.
Rotation:
You can insert the rod in its normal position or rotated by +90
degrees or -90 degrees. You can check the selected mode in
the shape window of dialog field.
Mirror:
Bolts
Bolt Style
Dia
Workloose
341
Static Bracing
Number Shape
Number Cross
Distance Cross
Weld Bracing
If this field is checked, the shapes and gusset plates are not
drilled. The dimensions of the gusset plates, however, are
determined as if drill holes existed.
Plate Without..
If this field is checked, the corners of the gusset plates are not
bevelled but a rectangular plate is created.
Create Group
With Bolts
Edge Distance
The third page serves for managing the edge distances depending on the bolt
diameter which have to be respected when the bracing shapes are installed.
List:
342
Static Bracing
st
Edge- 1 Hole
Hole Hole
Hole Edge
Limit Edges
Bracing Rod
343
Static Bracing
B.24.2
To a large extent, you can make the program automatically create the
components of a bracing. However, it is possible as well to generate single
components such as gusset plates, etc. individually.
For this purpose, several individual functions are available which will be
described in the following.
BRACING
Click this button to generate bracing rods and gusset plates in one
operation.
However, this function is not suitable for the connection of several rods
from different systems. In this case, you should use the individual functions
instead. After the action has been finished, you return to the dialog.
SINGLE ROD
Click this button to insert single bracing rods that are directly drilled.
DRILL ROD
Click this button to drill existing shapes on their ends, according to the
definitions in the dialog field. You must select the shapes for this
purpose. You will return to the dialog field afterwards.
PLATE AUTO
Click this button to create a gusset plate automatically.
Select the drilled bracing rods that have to be connected and then click
boundary lines for the plate edges.
The program will try to find a suitable plate dimension by keeping the edge
distances and the boundary lines.
344
Static Bracing
PICK PLATE
Click this button to determine yourself the shape of the gusset plate.
Select the drilled bracing rods that have to be connected and pick a point
on the planned bracing end. Click the approximate position of the gusset
plate. The edge distances will be displayed.
UCS
If you have not yet aligned the UCS before using the command, you can
do this subsequently: the active UCS plane (and consequently the plane
of the bracing) will be determined by clicking 3 points.
You will return to the dialog field afterwards.
345
Static Bracing
Creating a Bracing
Lets start out from the fact that you want to design a simple roof bracing. The
diagonals are to intersect (without the gusset plate in the middle).
Select the command for bracing and select the Plate Middle
for the UCS position.
Determine the position of the shape and the settings for bolts,
plate thickness, etc. Since the two rods are to intersect, select
the Front rod position beforehand. Then click the BRACING
button.
The program will prompt you to enter the system line of the
bracing rod. Click one of the two system lines, e.g., the one leading from down
below on the left to the top on the right.
You must determine the limit edges of the bracing
rod (i.e. the edges from which the outermost rod
edge is to have the distance as defined in Options).
Click the inner web line of the roof girder - as shown
on the left.
Repeat this on the other rod end. If you have clicked
the wrong line, you can cancel this by entering the
letter b (Back).
When you have selected both limit edges, confirm this by pressing the ENTER
key or by using the right mouse button. A dialog field will be displayed, which
shows exactly the calculated rod length. You can round the value in the desired
rod length field.
The rod is now displayed with drill holes. You must now determine the gusset
plates.
Gusset Plates
The program will prompt you to enter the boundary line for the gusset plate. You
can control the shape by selecting these lines - some variants are shown on the
left side depending on selection.
You may need construction lines which
have either been created beforehand or
which can be shown using two points.
You can confirm by pressing the ENTER
key or by clicking the right mouse
button. The next gusset plate can be
created afterwards.
346
Static Bracing
The first bracing rod is complete. The second rod is created in the same manner
with the exception that you select the rod position Rear (to avoid intersecting
rods).
If you want to create a bracing with a gusset plate in the point of intersection, do
not stagger the rods. Open, shorten, and drill the rods manually at the point of
intersection. Create a single gusset plate with the function for the bracing
(button PLATE AUTO or PICK PLATE).
347
Static Bracing
348
Haunches
B.25 Haunches
Upper Chord
Lower Chord
Web
Coped Shape
349
Haunches
Bottom Stiffener If this field is checked, a stiffener is attached to the base point
of the haunch of the support shape. You can select a stiffener
type in the list displayed here. Just select a stiffener template,
which you previously saved using the command Stiffeners.
Top Stiffener
Length,...
In the following figure, you can see the meaning of the inputs
for haunch length, roof pitch, bottom width, head width and
offset.
A modification in the input field roof pitch has only an effect if a
haunch has been created without supporting shape.
In the input field Cone Width you enter a width to which the
haunch tapers if required.
Create Group
If this field is checked, top flange, bottom flange and web plate
are arranged to form a group
Cone
350
Haunches
Fixed Size
If this field is checked, the head width and any existing cone
width are fitted to the shape to be connected. Inputs in these
fields will be ignored in this case.
Turn
351
Haunches
When using the haunch command, the last settings are used to create the
connection. Adjust the dimensions in the open dialog and track any changes
immediately in the model.
If you keep the ALT-key pressed when clicking the supporting shape, the
dimensions of the haunch flanges and of the web plate are fitted to the
dimensions of the supporting shape.
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is
possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the
component part and then select the settings.
352
Connection Editor
353
Connection Editor
Group Display
Length
Diameter
Colour
Group Options
Hide...
Dialog-Commands
DELETE
Click on this button to remove the selected connections completely, i.e.
all component parts and processing actions created by means of these
connections will be deleted as well. To do so, you have to select the
connections by clicking on the symbols.
354
Connection Editor
EDIT
Click on this button to edit the selected connection. After the desired
connection has been clicked via the symbol, the corresponding dialog of
this connection opens and the values can be modified.
CLONE
Click on this button to transfer the settings of a connection to another
one.
It is also possible to change the connection type if this is reasonable
(e.g. you can replace a plate connection by a web angle connection).
First, you have to select the connection the data of which have to be transferred
to another one. All connections not being able to seize these data are hidden.
Then, you have to select all connections having to take these data.
Verify Connections
If the Verify Connections option has been checked, all connections are verified
with regard to collisions and marginal distances before being displayed as
symbol. The status of this verification is displayed by means of the colour of the
symbol. They have the following meaning:
Green
Yellow
Red
355
Connection Editor
356
Group Structure
Various single components, bolts and special parts can be combined to form
groups - i.e. a support with welded endplates and stiffeners.
The groups can be hierarchically structured in subgroups, standard component
part groups and assemblies. Each parent group can itself contain subordinate
groups of a lower type.
The group structure existing in the model is taken into account for the parts lists
and when the model is automatically detailed and transformed into 2D workshop
drawings. Many of the settings can be done separately for assemblies,
component part groups, subgroups and single components.
Certain functions apply to the complete group, even if you only select one part of
the group.
After the command has been selected, the main window opens where the
available functions can be selected. Click on the corresponding button to apply
them. Most of the commands can be directly selected via a separate menu
command.
To permit rapid processing of several groups one after the other, some functions
are self-loading (loop version). If you want to cancel the function, you have to
press the ESC-key or the right mouse button.
In the settings, you can specify for which group commands a loop version is
required and for which not.
357
Group Structure
Structure of Subgroup
Like standard component part groups, ProSteel-subgroups consist of a main
part and the associated accessory parts. In practise, these subgroups mostly
correspond to the purchase or stock parts that in a preassembled condition are
again used in component part groups or in assemblies.
Subgroups and standard component part groups are based on the same logic
and therefore nearly behave identically.
Structure of Assembly
ProSteel-assemblies consist of any component parts without having a
determined main part. This permits to form free groups of parts and structures.
In addition, component part groups and subgroups can be inserted into an
assembly as well. In order to do so, just insert the main part of the subgroup or
of the material group into the assembly.
In practise, assemblies mostly correspond to several material groups,
subgroups and single parts which are combined on the site.
For more detailed useful information about group structure and its application in
practise for drawing generation, please refer to the different chapters of
detailing.
358
Group Structure
B.27.2
Parts can be combined to form groups, and you can detach such groups by
using the functions described here.
All functions described below can be used equally for component part groups,
subgroups and assemblies. This is why the functions are described only once.
In the following, the term Group therefore is supposed to mean a material group,
a subgroup or an assembly.
It is also possible to store groups as block and to take them over into other
drawings the structure will remain unchanged. Please note that special
functions are needed in this case. The AutoCAD standard commands for blocks
cannot be used.
The parts list data of the main part are accepted as group data
for the parts lists (not available for assemblies).
359
Group Structure
Display as 1 Part
You can enter the parts list data of the selected group in the
input fields. The position in the field Posnum has been taken
over from the main part provided the Take Main Part Info
field was selected. In addition, the outer dimensions and the
overall weight of the group will be displayed.
These input fields can also be accessed via the context menu
Change PS Properties, when you select a part that belongs
to the group.
360
Group Structure
Processing of Structure
Subsequent adding of parts to a group or removal from a group is possible as
well.
Click on this button to add new parts to a group.
The complete group will be selected when you click any part
of the group. Further accessory parts can be added by clicking
them.
Click on this button to remove existing parts from a group.
The complete group will be selected when you click any part
of the group. Then, remove the parts from the group by
clicking on them.
Dissolve Blocks
361
Group Structure
Miscellaneous
Click on this button to choose whether the whole group has to
be selected by selecting only one part of the group, or whether
the parts have to be independent of each other. To do so, click
any part of the group. Then, the mode will be switched over
correspondingly and the current status will be displayed in
command line.
AutoCAD group mode is modified here in the group. This
means that you can select the whole group by clicking only
one part when e. g.moving it by means of standard AutoCAD
commands..
You can switch on or off this behaviour using the AutoCADcommand for groups.
All groups existing in the drawing are counted and the number
is displayed in the Number input field.
362
Group Structure
B.27.3
Check Groups
Using the commands available here you can check the created groups, make
the settings and modify the group data for the parts list.
This function checks whether all the groups have a main part.
When a group without a main part is detected, this group is
dissolved.
In addition, when using the command Highlight Orphans you
can make display the parts that dont belong to a group.
Groups without a main part may occur when the main part
was deleted and the group has not been detached.
Click on this button to downgrade a component part group to a
subgroup. However, this material group mustnt contain any
subordinated subgroups.
Click on this button to upgrade a subgroup to a standard
component part group.
363
Group Structure
Mark Orphans
364
Group Structure
365
Group Structure
Display in ProSteel-Properties
When you process the parts of groups via the ProSteel properties and you
change to the tab Group, the complete group will be highlighted in colour for
your information.
You can choose different colours for main part and accessory parts. Use the
global settings of ProSteel to specify what colours to apply.
When it is a matter of nested structures (such as e. g. the component part group
of an assembly), you will normally get the lowest group level at shape selection
e. g. the properties of the own component part group. However, you may
scroll up and down the structure and thus modify the parent group properties.
366
Group Structure
B.27.4
Settings
This page specifies the behaviour of the commands for group function. You can
control the behaviour of each single command.
Part Selection
Execute in Loop
End Dialog
367
Group Structure
368
Positioning
B.28 Positioning
Positioning of the existing parts is one of the last steps before final detailing of
the 3D model for workshop drawings.
ProSteel can do this automatically for you. It searches parts of the same type
and defines their number in the model. Of course, you can also assign position
numbers manually.
In the first step before detailing, only the number of pieces (quantity) and their
position numbers must be defined. This data record is the basis for the parts
lists, which can then be generated and printed at once. Later, when preparing
the 2D parts, the position flags with the user-defined layout are attached to
single parts and groups.
In this version, the position flags as well as the height indicators and weld marks
are related to the style. This means that the pre-setting how the position flag
looks like can be set with a style. This style specifies the geometry and the
display properties of the flag.
369
Positioning
B.28.1
Automatic Positioning
PlugIn
370
Positioning
Type
Filter
Last Single
Here, you see the single part position set last. At the
beginning, you have to enter the value 0 at numerical position
numbers, if you want to start counting at 1.
Last Subgroup
Here, you see the subgroup position set last. At the beginning,
you have to enter the value 0 at numerical position numbers, if
you want to start counting at 1.
Last Group
Here, you see the group position set last. At the beginning,
you have to enter the value 0 at numerical position numbers, if
you want to start counting at 1.
Last Assembly
Here, you see the assembly position set last. At the beginning,
you have to enter the value 0 at numerical position numbers, if
you want to start counting at 1.
Last Connection Here, you see the connection position set last. At the
beginning, you have to enter the value 0 at numerical position
numbers, if you want to start counting at 1.
Next
Increment
Send Number
371
Positioning
Use XRefs
Use PlugIn
Positioning Results
When positioning is finished, a dialog opens where the position number and
further parts list information is displayed for each part.
Now, you can edit the proposed
position numbers by doubleclicking the position number of the
component part. Modifications are
immediately adopted into the
parts.
372
Positioning
373
Positioning
Connections
Only with Names Connections are only positioned, if they have been named
before.
374
Positioning
st
1 Sorting List
nd
Sorting List
Flats like
375
Positioning
Further Options
Overwrite Exist Existing position numbers are overwritten when assigning new
ones.
Equal Part De Single parts are checked for equality. If they are identical, they
are assigned the same position number. Parts are considered
identical when deviations with respect to dimensions and drill
diameter are within the values given as reference tolerances.
Group Detection The groups are checked for equality as well. Groups are
considered identical when identical single parts are arranged
in the same mounting position.
However, single parts are only compared using their position
number because positioning has already been carried out
before.
If parts are identical but have different position numbers, the
groups will also be assigned different position numbers.
Subgroups, assemblies and connections can be compared
with each other in the same way.
376
Positioning
Include Subgroups
Subgroups are completely included in the calculation of
equality. Otherwise, only the main parts of the subgroups are
used.
First Main Part First, all main parts of groups are positioned (and sorted
according to the sorting criteria within the groups), followed by
the accessory parts (also sorted according to the sorting
criteria).
This can be deemed as an additional, even higher ranking
sorting criterion. If this field is checked and you have entered a
position number in the input field Start Accessory Parts at,
positioning of the accessory parts will start at the defined
position number. You may for instance start with 1 for main
parts and with 100 for accessory parts.
Groups
Differentiation:
377
Positioning
25
25.1 The changed group positions are identified by the
index .1 etc. following their position number
(i. e. 100.1 , 100.2 , ...).
25
25A - The changed group positions are identified by the
index A etc. following their position number
(i.e. 100A, 100B, ...).
25
MAX+1 Positioning of the changed group positions is
continued after the highest position currently assigned.
When the last group was position 50, the changed groups now
have the positions from 51 onward.
Main Part
378
Positioning
Prefixes
Here, an explanatory text can be entered before the positions of groups,
subgroups and assemblies. It is possible to differentiate between support
beams, girders and other groups, the differentiation always being related to the
main part of the group.
Columns
Here, you enter the designation for all vertical shapes. In the
attribute field Position Tolerance, you enter an angle within
which the shape is still considered to be vertical.
Beams
Other
Family Prefixes
379
Positioning
> Tolerances
380
Positioning
Volume
Connections
Names
381
Positioning
B.28.2
Manual Insertion
After a position number has been attached to the component parts, no matter
whether it has been attached automatically or manually, you can display this
number and further parts list information at the part using a position flag.
If a position number has not yet been attached to the parts, you can specify new
numbers and enter them into the part.
The dialog tab mostly corresponds to the tab of automatic positioning. Please
refer to this section for a detailed description.
Style
Type
Last Single
Here, you see the single part position set last. At the
beginning, you have to enter the value 0 at numerical position
numbers, if you want to start counting at 1.
Last Group
Here, you see the group position set last. At the beginning,
you have to enter the value 0 at numerical position numbers, if
you want to start counting at 1.
Last Subgroup
Here, you see the subgroup position set last. At the beginning,
you have to enter the value 0 at numerical position numbers, if
you want to start counting at 1.
Last Assembly
Here, you see the assembly position set last. At the beginning,
you have to enter the value 0 at numerical position numbers, if
you want to start counting at 1.
Next
382
Positioning
Increment
Scale
Enter the scale for display scaling of the position texts and
other things. The scale should correspond to the scale of the
detail.
If a global scale has been defined, it will be automatically
taken over here.
Paper Area
Shipping No.
383
Positioning
Enter
384
Positioning
SINGLE PART
Select the part to which a position flag has to be attached. Then, the
position flag is created with the set style for single parts.
GROUP
Select the part to which a group position flag has to be attached. Then,
the
position
flag
is
created
with
the
set
style
for
groups/subgroups/assemblies.
GROUPS-SINGLE PART
Select the part of a group to which a position flag has to be attached.
Depending on the part hierarchy, the position flag is created with the set
style for main part or accessory parts.
BOLT
Select the bolt connection to which a position flag has to be attached.
Then, the position flag is created with the set style for bolts.
SHORT POSITION
Select the part to which a position flag has to be attached in form of a
short position. Then, the position flag is created with the set style for
short position.
MOUNTING POSITION
Select the part to which a position flag has to be attached in form of a
mounting flag. Then, the position flag is created with the set style for
mounting.
385
Positioning
FREE
Select the insertion point to which a position flag has to be attached.
Specify the position flag properties such as style, position number, etc. in
the following dialog.
Attaching the position flag via FREE permits you to create position flags even
without direct reference to a component part. You can make use of this option
e.g. for position flags in 2D drawings the parts of which have been dissolved or
drawn manually.
386
Positioning
B.28.3
Scale
Shipping No.
Paper Area
387
Positioning
388
Positioning
Selection list
Distribution
Dont care about collision
At distribution the position flags are placed on the component
part without verifying the surroundings of the part. This is the
fastest distribution method, however the most inexact method
as well.
Iterations
Insertion Point
Local Centre
Offset Flags
This value indicates the projection of the flag beyond the edge
of the visible geometry.
Free Hold
Flag Angle
In this field, you specify how the position flags have to look
like. The angle is measured between the guideline and the
alignment of the text of the position flag. The angle is always
indicated as angle area, because an exact angle specification
cannot be carried out with distribution algorithm.
389
Positioning
Compare Radius Here you specify the radius to be used for verifying the current
position flag with regard to collisions with existing part
geometry, position flags, elevations, texts or dimension texts.
The bigger the value, the longer is the processing time.
Options
One Part per
Only one position flag is inserted for a part having the same
position or shipping number (depending on the setting).
Place Only Out The position flags are attached outside of the model geometry.
Break Lines At
Animation
Group Flags
Show Count
390
Positioning
Distribution Procedure
The distribution of position flags takes into consideration the geometry of the
component parts, texts and dimensioning objects. At first, distribution searches
for the geometry within the compare radius around the insertion point of the
position flags. Then, the position flag is created and placed on its origin. If the
distributor doesnt find an appropriate position of the position flag (in case of
collision), the flag is moved at shapes along the centerline of the shape and a
new insertion position is searched where no collision with existing geometry
takes place. If there is still no appropriate position for the position flag, the flag
will be created at a greater distance towards the insertion point i. e. the guideline
is extended. If there isnt any appropriate place for the position flag, it will be
placed at the originally destined insertion point (center of the shape).
Working off flag distribution happens according to part size. First, the flags for
the small component parts are created and then the rest of the flags in
ascending order.
Distribution algorithm may be switched off using the option Dont care about
Collision.
Flags for Main Parts and Groups
Different kinds of depiction are possible when a flag has to be attached to the
main part of a group or to the corresponding group. Since the settings are more
complex, we will display the combinations here.
1. A normal group flag is attached to the main part, containing the data of the
corresponding construction group.
2. A group flag is attached to the main part, however containing the single part
data of the main part.
391
Positioning
3. A single part flag is attached to the main part, containing the single part data
of the main part and a group flag, containing the group data is attached to it as
well.
4. A single part flag is attached to the main part, containing the single part data
of the main part and a group flag, containing the data of the main part is
attached to it as well.
The default settings for subgroups and assemblies can be carried out similarly
like the settings for groups.
392
Positioning
B.28.4
Here, you will find different commands for processing the position flags and for
checking or searching for the position numbers.
Use this button to search for the highest group or part number
in the selected component parts. The result is displayed in the
neighbouring input fields.
Click this button to search for component parts in the model.
Enter the position you are looking for in the field Search
Number. Use the options Hide, Check, Zoom Extents to select
how the found result has to be depicted in the model.
Use this command to delete position numbers in component
parts and groups. For this purpose, select the parts the
position numbers of which have to be deleted.
You can specify in which part the number is deleted using the
filters Single Parts and Groups.
This command enters the current position number of the part
as original position number. The original number can only be
modified using this command.
Use this command to add a second part to a common position
flag.
Use this command to remove the arrow to a component part
from a position flag.
393
Positioning
Here, you see two results for comparing the position. In the left figure the parts
are identical. In the right one they are not identical. In the dialog window, you
can see in detail where the parts differ from each other.
394
Positioning
B.28.5
Default Format
Specify the default format with variables so that you can add
additional text.
$(DWGNUM) for the drawing number
$(DWGIDX) for the drawing index
Position
Single Parts
Groups
Shipping No
395
Positioning
B.28.6
You determine the depiction of a position flag by specifying a position flag style
where the geometry, the content and the colours of the position flag are defined.
Style
Use this box to select the style you want to use for the
depiction.
Click this button to save the current settings.
Click this button to load templates via the templates
management and to use them again.
Create Geo...
Block Geometry The depiction of position flags is specified by an AutoCADblock. You can select any block you like.
Block Path
In this field, you define from which path the blocks for
selection of position flag geometry have to be read.
Bitmap
396
Positioning
Geometry
Line Type
Line Block
Here, you can select the AutoCAD block, if you have activated
the option Line with Block.
Bubble Form
397
Positioning
Text Type
Here, you set the type of shape designation
in case of length indication.
U100..160 - The designation is as follows IPE270..7890.
U 100 160 The designation is as follows IPE2707890.
U100x160 - The designation is as follows IPE270x7890.
Format Template The designation is as indicated in the
Format Template input field.
Alignment
Text Style
Specifies the text style for the text of the position flag.
Default Format
Prefix / Postfix
In the input field Prefix or Postfix you can enter a text which is
displayed in front of or after the position or shipping number of
the position flag.
The default can be set independently of each other for both
numbers.
Separator
398
Positioning
Layout
Options
No Line
Dynamic
Length For Group The entire length of the group is output instead of the part
length.
Sizes
Colours
When you click a position flag via the context menu Change PS Properties, you
can subsequently modify the properties of each single position flag. This tab will
not be described here in detail because the possibilities for setting correspond to
the parameters explained above.
399
Positioning
B.28.7
Management of Styles
In this part of the dialog, you maintain your position flag styles. You can create
new styles, load , update or delete styles.
400
Positioning
401
Positioning
402
Drawing Information
Project Name
Here, you select a block using the SELECT button for entering
data in its block attributes via the entry fields, provided you
have assigned such entry fields to the variables of the block
attributes.
When the drawing border for the 2D workshop drawing has
been entered as block using the ProSteel command Drawing
Borders, you can select the block of the drawing borders. The
entries may either be taken over into the title block (export), or
the entries can be taken from the title block into the dialog
(import).
403
Drawing Information
Click on this button to retrieve the data of the entry fields into
the block attributes of the selected block.
Click on this button to retrieve the block attributes of the
selected block into the entry fields.
Click on this button to define the variables assigned to the
block attributes of the different entry fields.
An identical dialog box will be displayed, where the variable
names of the block attributes are entered.
When you have selected the Prepared On, Checked On, or
Released On fields and click this button, the current date will
be entered
404
405
B.30.1
When creating a parts list, you first select the parts to be processed, preferably
parts of a group or, in addition, independent single parts.
You can decide whether or not parts of your selection are to be included in the
list - either collectively via the filter function during creation of the parts lists or
individually for each part. If the Select button has not been clicked in the
corresponding parts properties, the part will not be included in the parts lists,
even though you have selected it.
Since further processing and printing of the parts list is carried out with an extra
function, you can register all required parts lists first and store them under
different names.
Part Selection
Here, you select the parts on the basis of which a parts list is
to be created.
3D-parts you select the parts from the model. 2D-position
flags the parts list will be deducted from the position flags of
a detailed workshop drawing. From modified 2D drawings you
can generate new bills of materials.
Group Options
Verify Position... Only those selected parts will be taken over into the parts lists
that have a valid position number.
406
Only Group Parts Only those selected parts will be taken over into the parts
lists that are assigned to a group.
Subgroups
Assemblies
Only Selected
Only the selected parts are taken over into the parts list.
Create Group Record A group entry is written into the parts list only for
completely seized groups.
Start Part List
Calc. NC-Cut..
Straight End
The parts are rotated that the straight end is situated at the
front.
With Welds
Group Bolts
Bolts without ...
... Extra
Without Weight
Output File
The file for the list of materials is stored in the file displayed in
the Name field in dBASE-format.
By clicking the FILE button you can set the directory in the
same manner as you use to do under Windows.
The instructions below detail how placeholders are to be used
in this input field.
407
408
Export directory
Frame directory
Cross-language Localised folder
Language directory
409
Dialog-Commands
WITH BOLTS
By clicking this button, you start part selection. The selected bolts will be
considered as well.
WITHOUT BOLTS
By clicking this button, you start part selection. Bolts will not be
considered, even though they have been selected.
MOUNTING LIST
By clicking this button, you start part selection. Only the main parts of
groups including bolts will be considered.
410
B.30.2
After you have created one or several parts lists using the command Create
Parts List you can further process the bills by using this command. The files of
the parts list can be loaded, modified, formatted, and printed using this
command.
The substantial form generator makes it possible to freely design the formatting
and layout of any parts list, add company logos, and preview the parts lists. You
do not need any special knowledge about this utility since its normal operation is
smoothly integrated into ProSteel's program environment.
However, if you would like to customize the enclosed parts list forms to your
individual needs, please read the online help of the form generator List & Label
Designer, which will explain the customization of existing and creation of new
forms in easy to understand steps.
The following sections will describe how to generate and output a parts list first
before discussing the individual options of the parts list processing method.
411
In the FILE menu click the menu option OPEN FILE and select the *.dbf-file you
want to process. The directory and the file name should be known to you (have
been previously defined with the command Create Parts List).
The dialog box now fills with the parts list data. Each part (even construction
group descriptions) is listed individually and unsorted; equal positions are not
combined until the time of output.
If there is an error in the parts list file (such as for example components with the
number=0 or different parts with the same position number) the program creates
and opens a file named stkerr.dbf where these errors are displayed. These
parts won't be listed in the standard parts list.
In the SETTINGS menu, click the menu option SET PARTS LIST HEADER and
then enter the data for the parts list header. If you have defined order data
previously (command Drawing Information), these data can be imported into
the parts list header.
Finally, click the OUTPUT menu and select the parts list variation (e.g. parts list
of individual parts), which you would like to print. Depending on the settings, the
program now prompts you for the layout for the parts list formatting and can then
generate a print preview. All or specific pages are printed from within this
preview.
412
Preview
Here, you can see an overview about the most important functions required for
printout and navigation within the preview. As the actual printout is completely
taken over by the additional application List & Label, please refer to the online
help of this program for more detailed information.
Page selection
Zoom
Print page
Print All
Exit
413
The component parts list offers only a draft display of the entries. By doubleclicking an entry, another dialog opens listing all parts lists data for this entry.
You can modify any data at this point, which are saved in the corresponding file
immediately once you exit the window with the OK button. This means you
are not working with just a working temporary buffer copy but with the
actual file!
414
Delete
Close
Sort
By clicking this button, you can sort the current working file
according to two layers of a parts list in an ascending or
descending order.
For this purpose, a further dialog box will be displayed, where
you can select a primary and a secondary layer. The data will
first be sorted according to the contents of the primary layer
and then, in case of equal contents, according to the contents
of the secondary layer.
Data content is modified according to the sorting.
Cancel
Delete
By clicking this button, you can add the data of a second parts
list file to the current working file. You have to select an
additional file.
Please note that the content of the current file is
permanently changed when using this option!
415
Now you will see a list with the existing form layouts in the
form of templates as well as a description and preview of the
form. If you would like to edit a form just double-click the file
name and the utility program List & Label (see intro to this
chapter) opens. A detailed description of the functionality
would extend beyond the scope of this manual. Please see
the online help of this utility program for further details.
If you would like to create a new form, enter a new file name,
which will return an empty form ready for editing.
List Header
By clicking this option, you can edit the header of your parts
list. The program will give you first the opportunity to import
data from the drawing information (see command Drawing
Information) into the parts list header.
Filter
Click this entry to set the filter conditions if you want to output
a parts list with filtered data Only data meeting the filter
condition are output in the parts list.
416
List Names
If the field Switch off Posnum Equal Part Detection has been
checked, their position number only recognizes identical parts.
If this field has not been checked (recommended), the parts
are additionally compared with regard to name, length, etc. If
these values don't match for component parts having the
same position number, an error message is created.
417
Single Parts
Bolt List
Filtered List
Free ...List
418
419
420
This command permits the creation of a parts list and its output in the drawing.
Therefore, it is suitable for drawing-dependent parts lists in plans showing e.g.
only one single group.
Since this parts list is an "intelligent" object, modifications in the model can be
automatically seized and displayed in the parts list. In addition, various
formatting options are available which can be controlled directly.
After having selected the command, select the desired parts first and then
determine the desired insertion point of the list in the drawing by clicking a point.
Then the following dialog appears where you can make the basic settings.
421
Style
Origin
List Type
Insertion Point
Here, you specify the position of the parts list related to the
previously selected insertion point.
Tolerances
Scale
Current Layer
Autom. Update
422
Check Position... If this option is activated only parts having a valid position
number will be evaluated.
Only Groups...
Total Amount...
Washers...
Nuts...
Safety Nuts
Welds
Add...
423
Move to the second tab Display to edit a new created or existing parts list style
and select the style to be edited.
EDIT
Click on this button to edit the selected style.
424
Style Name
Display List
Text Size
Height Scaling
Left Margin
Right Margin
Offset
Rotation
Block Size
Move Up
If this field is checked, the list is running from the bottom to the
top, i. e. the column headers are below.
Divide Groups
Align Numbers
425
Fill up with Noughts All numerical values are filled up with noughts according to
the indicated format length and digits after the decimal point.
Header
Text Style
Sort
Invert
Use Prefix
The display colours can be globally selected for all elements of the parts list. In
addition, individual colours can be assigned to the different columns as well.
Enter the colour directly by indicating the AutoCAD colour number or click on the
desired input field and then on the SELECT button. Then, you can select the
colour in the dialog as usual.
Header
Label
Frame
Hor. Lines
Ver. Lines
426
Field Name
Name1
The name of the column header resp. the first name if an entry
has been indicated in input field Name2 as well. Two rows
are available altogether.
Name2
Length
Here, you enter the desired column width in text signs. The
exact column width depends on the selected text style.
Dec. Point
Text Size
Enter the text size of the column. If you have entered the
value 0, the general text size of the list style is used.
Enter the colour of the column text (colour number). If you
have entered the value -1, the text colour of the list style is
used.
427
Position
Units
428
Footer
Enter the desired foot lines. You can use pre-defined variables
as well. The following variables are available as foot lines:
$(N)
$(F)
$(L)
$(LF)
$(W)
$(WF)
$(P)
$(PF)
Addition
Dec. Point.
Offset
Position
Units
Group Row
In the Prefix input field, you can indicate a prefix for the
position numbers of group lines.
In the Colour input field you can specify the colour of the
group line. If the value -1 has been indicated here, the normal
text colour will be used. These settings can be made
separately for groups, subgroups and assemblies.
429
B.31.3
The management of the existing parts list styles is organized in the third tab
Order.
Click on this button to load the selected style from the hard
drive into the drawing.
Click on this button to create a new list style. To do this you
have to enter a style name (please pay attention that the
name does not exist already).
Then, this style is created with the settings of the style, which
is current at the moment, and it will be used as new current
style. The settings of the style can be individually modified
afterwards.
Click on this button to create a new folder for a clearer
structure of your parts list styles.
Click on this button to delete the selected style.
430
B.31.4
Move to the forth tab Content to look at the content of the parts list and to
modify it manually. To modify an entry, double-click the corresponding field and
you can edit the entry.
431
432
Containment List
After having created groups in a drawing, you can make lists and insert them
into the drawing. These lists can display the belonging of certain parts to
component part groups. You can insert these drawing containment lists in the
DetailCenter Express as well.
First select the desired parts after having selected this command. Then, specify
the desired insertion point of the list in the drawing by clicking a point. The
following dialog appears displaying the basic settings.
Style
Here, you define how the list has to look like on the base of a
style. The list templates are saved as template via the
template management.
Insertion Point
Here, you specify the insertion point of the created list. You
can choose between several insertion points.
Current Layer
433
Containment List
Scale
Specifies the insertion scale of the list. The scale affects text
heights and distances within the list.
Click on this button to add further parts to the component parts
list of the drawing containment list. You have to select the
parts to be added.
Click on this button to remove parts from the component parts
list of the drawing containment list. You have to select the
parts to be removed.
Click on this button, to calculate anew an update the drawing
containment list.
You can force an update of the list if automatic update has not
been activated.
434
Containment List
B.32.2
Move to the second tab Display to edit a new created or existing list style.
Select the style to be edited.
EDIT
Click on this button to edit the selected style.
435
Containment List
Style Name
Display List
Text Size
Height Scaling
Left Margin
Right Margin
Offset
Rotation
To the Top
If this field is checked, the list is running from the bottom to the
top, i.e. the column headers are below.
Text Style
436
Containment List
Invert
Prefix
The display colours can be globally selected for all elements of the drawing
containment list. In addition, individual colours can be assigned to the different
columns as well.
Enter the colour directly by indicating the AutoCAD colour number or click on the
desired input field and then on the SELECT button. Then, you can select the
colour in the dialog as usual.
Header
Label
Frame
Hor. Lines
Ver. Lines
437
Containment List
Field Name
Name1
The name of the column header resp. the first name if an entry
has been indicated in input field Name2 as well. Two rows
are available altogether.
Name2
Length
Here, you enter the desired column width in text signs. The
exact column width depends on the selected text style.
Decimal Pt.
Text Size
Enter the text size of the column. If you have entered the
value 0, the general text size of the list style is used.
Enter the colour of the column text. If you have entered the
value -1, the text colour of the list style is used.
438
Containment List
Position
Units
439
Containment List
Click on this button to load the selected style from the hard
drive into the drawing.
Click on this button to create a new list style. To do this you
have to enter a style name (please pay attention that the
name does not exist already).
Then, this style is created with the settings of the style, which
is current at the moment, and it will be used as new current
style. The settings of the style can be individually modified
afterwards.
Click on this button to create a new folder for a clearer
structure of your list styles.
Click on this button to delete the selected style.
440
Containment List
441
Containment List
442
Detailing
444
DetailCenter
C.1
DetailCenter
Detailing 3D Models
The program generates the usual 2D views of the components for the workshop
plans using the model, which means that the program will disassemble the
model into its components, analyse the geometry of all the individual parts, and
ascertains any existing but invisible edges. Then depending on the
requirements or your selections the shape is displayed in several views and
dimensioned and the position flag is attached.
All of this takes place in a split second and in the background. Once the
program has finished with one component, this component is deposited in a
library in the form of a block clearly organized according to the individual
construction groups and design sections.
After this procedure has concluded you can use the program to help you with
the layout of the parts on your drawing sheets. From here on, you can treat the
parts as if they were the usual drawings generated with a CAD program but
ProSteel offers you a few extra functions, which facilitate your work.
Intervention Options
You do not have to worry that you are going to be at the mercy of the program
and that from now on all your drawings will reflect the wishes of the software
designers.
A vast number of parameters help you to specify the appearance of your
mapped design. These parameters can be saved as data records and reimported depending on the type of drawing (overview, life-size, 1: 10 workshop
details, etc).
This saves you time by being able to detail several parts at once applying one of
these styles that might already be enough to satisfy the requirements of your
assignment. However, you can also detail small groups of components one
after the other or even a single part in different styles. You always have
access to the smallest detail.
445
DetailCenter
446
DetailCenter
When you open the DetailCenter for the first time, a clear dialog box will be
displayed with only a few settings. There is nothing more required after the
adaptations to your personal requirements were made. As you know, you only
want to get your shop drawings from the model. However, if need be, you can at
any time penetrate deeply inside the drawing derivation. You can make a great
number of settings, ask for information, and check drawings.
The philosophy behind this development is that you can get the same result in
various ways, that you can make a lot of modifications but you do not have to!
447
DetailCenter
448
DetailCenter
DetailCenter Surface
The following page will give you an overview over the work area of the
DetailCenter. This chapter includes an introduction and explains some of the
basic detailing terms. The individual function areas are described later in special
chapters.
449
DetailCenter
In general, the DetailCenter is divided into three main work levels. Usually, your
building part or component will pass through all three levels until it is visible on
the workshop plan in the form of a detail. However, your work in the different
levels is limited to only a few mouse clicks, if all the basic settings of detailing
are adapted to your requirements.
Even if these works seem to be too awkward and involved for you, because you
do not need the flexibility of the DetailCenter, you can use the DetailCenter
Express. This part of the program once again combines the remaining steps
until a workshop plan is created. Detailing is worked through according to a predetermined pattern. Detailing by one single mouse click became a reality.
Level 1: Component Overview (Prepare)
Here you will obtain an overview of the parts of the model and their functional
associations and relationships. You can view construction groups, single parts
or whole areas of the model all clearly structured in tree format. This is the
place where you can manage and change detail styles and link your
components with these styles as well as manage the modification mechanism.
In addition, DetailCenter Express! Is started here.
Level 2: Display Views Overview (Detailing)
The second work level offers you an overview of the component or model views
created by the program. You can add or remove views, display a preview and
fine-tune the detail style.
In this overview you decide what exactly is to be processed as a detail block and
start the actual detailing process.
Level 3: Detail Block Overview (Import)
The third and last level features the detailed parts, which are located on your
hard drive in the form of detail blocks. You receive an overview of the detail
blocks of the current model (or other models) and decide which parts to import
or integrate into which drawing.
Placing the parts on a drawing sheet finishes the workshop plan, unless you
would like to carry out a few adjustments manually. You can create automatic
multiple sheets according to your own rules by means of DetailCenter
Composer! which can be started here.
450
DetailCenter
Work Tools
Each of the three levels offers access to a window with work tools using the
function button bar. These tools are assigned to the corresponding area. In
order to keep the display area of the construction parts lists as large as possible,
many of the infrequently used functions and settings have been delegated to
these subordinate dialogs.
Information Window
In addition, the context menu offers access to another dockable information
window. All three-work levels are subordinate to this information window, which
shows the current status of the selected entry. Depending on the list, this
window displays the name and type of the part, data of detailing, insertion
location, current status, and much more.
Context Menu
A supplement to every level is a level-specific context menu accessible through
the right mouse button, which lists only those functions that are significant to the
respective list. You will probably use the context menus quite often because
they represent the fastest way to access a command.
451
DetailCenter
Templates
As you already know from the other ProSteel functions, the basic settings of the
DetailCenter can be saved as template for each level. The settings of work tools
and of construction parts list are stored.
These templates (as reference) may again be stored in a parent template
together with the global settings for the DetailCenter. This allows individual
configuration of the complete DetailCenter. Later, you only have to load the
suitable configuration for the current working process.
Favourites
After defining some of the templates as favourites for the complete DetailCenter,
this allows fast selection from the favourite list. This is the most comfortable way
if you have to change the setting frequently during one session.
Detail Styles
The detail styles are the cornerstone of the entire detailing process. They
describe how a part is to look as a workshop detail or how the model is to
appear as an overview. The content of the styles is described in detail in the
chapter 'Detailing Styles'. The management and modification of a style is
described in detail in the chapter 'Component Overview'.
Just a preliminary note: A component without detail style cannot be processed
and is ignored by the program when it comes to detailing!
Preview
The detailing of a selected part can be previewed from within the views overview
or directly from within the model. This will create a small AutoCAD drawing
displaying the exact result of the detail style settings applied to this part. The
small drawing shows how the part will be detailed. This window and its drawing
can be zoomed or queried for information because it is an independent
AutoCAD drawing.
Since you can now open this part's detail style, you can track the effects of
different style settings in real time. We call this fine-tuning of the detail style. If
you open the preview for another part, you do not have to close this window
first. The content is updated automatically. After viewing the detail, the window
must be closed manually.
452
DetailCenter
While the preview is open, most of the functions of the DetailCenter are
inaccessible. Please remember: The preview might be hidden behind some
other drawing because so many windows can be open simultaneously. Also
consider the speed of your computer when viewing a great many details such as
construction groups or entire overviews. Do not become impatient if your
computer seems to be busy calculating for what seems like a long time. Even
fast computers need a little computation time, but some of the latest computers
will surprise you with the speed of the update.
453
DetailCenter
The major advantage in this approach lies in the improved response times and
the reduced number of objects displayed. This is not, however, a form of display
filter; it is a genuine reduction in the quantity of data. The only objects that now
need to be analysed and displayed are those that are actually needed for the
mode selected.
DetailCenter modes
DetailCenter Standard
The component overview contains all objects and model views, so the
(PS_DETCENTER_STANDARD)) full range of possibilities for detailing remains open. This is the default
status, as in the previous program version.
DetailCenter Layout
(PS_DETCENTER_LAYOUT)
The component overview contains only the individual parts or groups for
the 3d model, and no model views for layout plans.
DetailCenter Express
(PS_DETCENTER_EXPRESS)
If you use the same mode of DetailCenter on a regular basis, you can also
launch it using direct commands from AutoCAD.
454
DetailCenter
Scales
The first method allows for a simple and unscaled processing of the drawing
and does not generate the scale until the time of plotting. Components can also
be inserted (unlabeled!) into other plans easily and comfortably. The
disadvantage of this method is that this involves some thinking, to keep different
scales and the same text sizes within one drawing and still have to copy parts
from other drawings.
This is where the second method is more practical: You always plot using the
scale 1:1, always use the same text size, and scale the parts to fit the plotting
scales just as you would do when drawing by hand. This allows you easy
management of different scales within one drawing.
ProSteel permits both methods when detailing, but you have to stick to one or
the other method within one drawing. This is because the dimensioning styles
are the problem.
Dimensioning Styles
You define certain AutoCAD dimensioning styles in your model, which you can
use within the detail styles for dimensioning. When detailing, the program
creates a copy of the style, and from your settings determines the required text
and length scaling. This style is assigned a new name indicating the length
scaling and is used in the detail block.
Although the program does set the dimension text into the dimension
permanently, e.g. to evaluate contractions, you do want to receive an AutoCAD
associate dimensioning after the detailing has been concluded; thus the copy.
This also keeps your original style intact and you do not need to create separate
styles for each individual scale.
455
DetailCenter
If you want to work with the first method using a scale of 1:10, you will obtain a
style with a text scaling=10 and with a length scaling=1. The name could be,
e.g., PS_STD_1_10. Process another detail with different settings of the
AutoCAD dimensioning style and you will obtain the same name for the style.
No problems occurred up to now. Now insert both details into a drawing and the
first one will win out because the name is identical. However, this is typical for
AutoCAD and ProSteel has no intention of changing that.
If you have problems with the dimensioning styles, you can be assured
that this is due to not being consequent in this case.
This is the reason you should make sure that your prototype file, into which you
want to import the details, does not contain any dimensioning styles (if possible),
and that the basic styles with the same name are also identical in different
models if you want to mix together the details of different models. Do not change
the size by only changing the scale (e.g., when manually dimensioning), but
rather define a new style with a new name.
This is the way it should be when using AutoCAD pure because there is a
good reason for it: If you rescale the parts manually, you are simply exchanging
the dimensioning style and all is well again.
456
DetailCenter
Single Parts
These are all parts that correspond to a real 3D-component part in the model
and normally are the smallest unit of detailing. The DetailCenter itself, however,
cannot differentiate between production parts and parts of additional purchase
or on stock.
A single part drawing can be generated of every ProSteel volume solid. In this
drawing, the part edges, angles of intersection and drill holes are dimensioned.
Normally the coordinate system of the component part defines the alignment of
standard views, such as front view, plan view, etc.
Weld shapes are an exception. They consist of several single components, but
in most cases they are considered and treated as one component part.
Views
This is a three-dimensional arrangement of component parts in the model as
they can be seen from a defined view direction and with a previously defined
view depth, which is not to be confused with the component part views.
An overview drawing is created in which the position of the component parts to
each other and to existing reference axes (constructional axes) is dimensioned.
Views are derived from the existing model views which were either created
automatically by the workframe (PS_WORKFRAME), or which were added by
you later.
457
DetailCenter
Isometric Views
These views show the model in a three-dimensional depiction and are often
desired without the hidden edges. View direction is determined by the five global
3D-model views of the configuration.
It is possible as well to add isometric views to individual details (e.g. groups). In
this case, these are depicted as component part view together with the other
partial views.
Anchorage Plan
This view refers to the plan view plane and shows the plan view including
dimensions together with the depiction of the base plates and supports.
As special feature, it is possible to use different scales for plan view and base
plate details. The dimensioning of the holes can be referred to the plan view
grid.
458
DetailCenter
Manual Details
In principle, these are also views of the model, but you can freely determine the
involved component parts and the view direction during detailing.
Manual details allow you to generate unusual views or special detail sections.
As the name implies, you have to attach the dimensioning yourself and you
dont have any possibility to have the view automatically checked with regard to
modifications.
Manual details dont appear in the component part list nor do they have their
own detailing style. Scale and display of the component parts are, however
controlled by a temporarily assigned detailing style during generation.
It is true that after generation manual details can be inserted into the drawing in
the same way like standard views.
Multi-Shapes
These are single parts consisting of several components that are normally
treated and dimensioned like a single coherent component part (e.g. weld
shapes).
Depending on the situation it may be that these component parts are not
ordered but individually produced. Therefore, in the DetailCenter you can
consider a multi-shape as components. That means that it appears as an
individual subpart in a component part group, but on the other hand you can still
create single part drawings of the components.
Therefore, it is necessary to activate the option Treat Parts as Single Parts in
the 3D-component parts properties for the parts in question.
459
DetailCenter
Gusset Details
These are views on the model showing the involved component parts of a
connection (2) or of a group of connections (1) as detailed section.
In most cases, the connecting elements such as plates, bolts, etc. can be
completely seen whereas the connected shapes are only partially displayed.
The connections are recognized via the existing logical links if at least one of
these links is named with an identification code.
A gusset detail appears as separate component part in the component part list
of the DetailCenter and a detailing style can be assigned to it. Afterwards, you
treat it in a similar way like a component part group.
460
DetailCenter
461
DetailCenter
462
DetailCenter
Use of Group Structure
In principle, there are nearly no limits for you how to group the component parts
because the examples for application only represent few of the great number of
possibilities. It is up to you whether you want to apply grouping according to
construction for the order and the parts list or whether you only carry out a
logical grouping for later 2D-drawings.
Within the DetailCenter, you find a hierarchic tree structure of grouping and you
can filter and sort the display according to the different planes. Each structure
and subordinate structure can be detailed as separate detail and inserted in the
2D-drawing.
The following example shows the practical use of group structure at detailing:
A column of a storage rack builds an assembly (1) of two component part
groups (1a) which are bolted with each other. The lower of the two groups
contains two welded base points which here however are assigned to the group
as subgroups (1b).
The detail drawing of the assembly (2) is showing the column of the storage
rack standing and only with the main dimensions as a kind of total overview of
the construction.
463
DetailCenter
The detaill of the component part group (3) now displays the position of the addon parts in the component part group. The two base points are not dimensioned
in a more detailed way, but they appear only as complete part.
The base points can be inserted into the drawing as separate detail of the
subgroup (4) with detailed mounting dimensions. In case of stock items this
could of course be omitted.
When the base point is manufactured together with the remaining group, you
require perhaps single parts details (5) of the base plates which again can have
a completely different detailing style.
464
DetailCenter
Advantages of Assemblies
The use of assemblies may also be useful in situations where normally you
would use only groups. As groups always determine the alignment of the views
as well as the direction of dimensioning according to their main part, you often
get a very unfavourable combination for certain oblique constructions.
465
DetailCenter
Intelligent Details
The result of the detailing process is a detail, as you would draw it with standard
AutoCAD. You can see centrelines, visible and hidden edges, holes, etc. and
the part is still not a true flat line graphic. Intelligent details are still displayed as
three-dimensional details when viewing the page containing individual parts or
construction groups at a slant. However, when you print the part it appears
completely two-dimensional
The advantage is that you can subsequently add cuts or dimensions while
taking any possible shape shortening into account.
If you want to change the geometry subsequently, that is in the detailed part,
you have to import the changes with the ProSteel functions if you still require the
intelligent features.
However, if you want to dissolve the detail in its entirety, you have to explode
the component like a block. This gives you a group, which can be ungrouped to
reach the lines.
Of course, the consequence is that all of the intelligence is lost. Thus, omit this if
at all possible. Overviews and manual details are an exception those are
already non-intelligent line depictions.
Shape Shortening
During the detailing you can select whether you want to shorten any parts that
are especially long. Contracted sections are then attached to those sections of a
component that do not show any manipulations in a longer stretch and are
actually of no interest. This gives you the opportunity to display the sections that
are important for the detailing in an optimal size (because you can select larger
scales) or show more components on a given page.
The picture below clearly illustrates the difference. Both shapes are detailed with
the same scale and scaled to the same length.
466
DetailCenter
Pick Helpers
The intelligent components of groups have the disadvantage that the individual
parts of a detailed construction group are inaccessible if e.g. you want to move
them subsequently. It would also not help to activate or deactivate the group
using the AutoCAD-groups.
This is why ProSteel features the "Pick Helpers, which you might view as a grip
variation. If you do not have any part selected in the drawing and you access the
context menu using the right mouse button, you will see the option ProSteel
SETTINGS and the entry Pick Helpers.
Use this entry to toggle the pick helpers on and off. Small little triangles now
appear on the components, which you can now use to select and e.g. move the
parts of a group.
When working with the pick helpers, don't forget the following special feature: If
a building component of a construction group is moved, a new drawing of the
group is only created when you keep the ALT-key pressed during the
movement. Otherwise, the drawing has to be regenerated to obtain the modified
display.
467
DetailCenter
468
DetailCenter
Available Display Fields Select the desired property field of a part, which has to be
added to the tree structure.
Selected Data Fields The currently selected property fields of the structure. The
order corresponds to the hierarchy level in the tree display
(sorting order).
The property field corresponds to the type of this property. It
depends on the data of the parts to be represented which
entries will actually be displayed.
If you have e.g. selected the length as property, an entry will
be created on this hierarchy level for each existing shape
length and all components having the same length will be
subordinate to this property.
Group Display Filter
Standard Filter
Only those parts will be displayed that meet the specified filter
condition. In the selection list, some pre-defined filter
conditions are offered for selection, which however cannot be
modified by you.
User-defined Filter
Only those parts will be displayed that meet the specified filter
condition. The filter condition here is completely user-defined.
The selected properties for the structure and those for the filter
dont have to be identical. It is for example possible to display
a sorting only according to the length but filter out the
component type rib completely with it.
User-defined Additional Filter An additional second filter; this filter is logically linked
with the user-defined filter by AND, thus, a component part
has to meet both conditions (and if need be the conditions of
the standard filter).
469
DetailCenter
Selection List
EDIT
Group Options
Sort Order
Show Entries 1x
470
DetailCenter
Group Display
With Pre-sort
No empty Folder
Display Filter
The display filter allows a very detailed filtering of component parts according to
their properties. You can describe any logically nested filter condition on the
basis of the existing properties (there are no limits with regard to the complexity
of the query).
A standard filter and two filters of equal value (user-defined filter and additional
filter) are available which are linked with each other by the logical AND. You
may store these filter conditions as templates which can be easily selected. This
allows you to prepare frequent filter conditions that are perfectly adapted to your
application.
Although each filter is logically nested by any condition such as 'All shapes
longer than 5000, but no IPE270 or IPE240', it sometimes is easier to work with
the additional filter, too.
If e.g. no sheet metal plates are required for a task, you can exclude them
permanently already via the additional filter. The user-defined filter then serves
for your daily work and you can modify this filter without having to add the
condition 'No sheet metal plates' each time.
471
DetailCenter
Here, you see all property fields of the parts that may be used
for the filter criteria. Each field can be used as often as you
like.
Select the desired field by clicking on it in the list. Then, the
field name will appear in the display on the right.
Display Fields
> Center
472
DetailCenter
When all of the three components of a comparative condition have been preset,
you can add them to the complete filter condition by clicking on the INSERT
button. Depending on the existing conditions and on the selected logical link, the
appropriate brackets will be set.
Group Filter Condition
Display Field
Dialog Commands
OPERATOR AND
By clicking on this button, you select the logical operator AND as logical
link for the next comparative condition.
OPERATOR OR
By clicking on this button, you select the logical operator OR as logical link
for the next comparative condition.
BRACKETS
Clicking on this button forces the program to manually add brackets to
the filter conditions existing up to that moment.
Brackets are always necessary if you want to link the complete result of a
(partial) condition with another one, because the combination of (A AND B) OR
C is different to A AND (B OR C).
INSERT
By clicking on this button you add the current comparative condition to the
complete filter condition.
473
DetailCenter
DELETE
By clicking on this button you delete the comparative condition that was
added last.
DELETE ALL
By clicking on this button you delete the complete filter condition.
474
DetailCenter
This is the function bar of the component overview. Buttons no. 1-3 are available
in each work level with the same function.
475
DetailCenter
Dialog Commands
RECURSION (1)
By clicking on this button, recursive processing is alternatively switched on
or off.
If it is switched on, any processing applied to a parent entry in the
component parts list (e.g. assign style) is also applied to all subordinate entries.
Otherwise, only the selected entry is processed or all entries on the same level,
if this option is activated in the model.
STRUCTURE (2)
Click on this button to open the dialog for display sorting of component
parts list. Here, you can select the standard display or an individual
structure and set user-defined filters.
SETTINGS (3)
Click on this button to open the dialog for the work tools where you can
specify additional settings only for this work level.
Depending on the work level, the global settings are valid, too, which can
be defined separately.
UPDATE (4)
Click on this button to search the selected drawing once more.
This is required if you activated a different drawing in the MDI environment
or if changes were made to the current drawing (e.g. new position).
EXPRESS (5)
Click on this button to start the DetailCenter Express, to carry out a
complete detailing according to a specified pattern.
476
DetailCenter
PREPARE (6)
Click on this special action button to import all parts selected in the parts list into
the view list and determine the views pre-selected in the detail style.
Component views can be generated only for parts linked with a detail style.
WORK LEVELS (7)
Switch on a different work level by clicking on the corresponding tab. Any open
dialog is updated accordingly.
Here, you can switch over to the page for the global settings of the DetailCenter
where you can specify the settings, which are valid for the whole DetailCenter or
for several work levels.
TITLE BAR (8)
If you double-click on this area, the dialog switches from docked to free moving.
Alternatively, you can also grab the dialog and pull it out while keeping the left
mouse button depressed.
SEPARATOR (9)
Use this separator to enlarge the docked dialog. The drawing next to it will
decrease in size accordingly.
In addition, there is a scrolling bar between the two display lists (if two lists are
available), which you can use for modifying the scale of the two lists.
CLOSE (10)
Click on this button to close the DetailCenter.
REVISIONCENTER (11)
Clicking on this button launches the RevisionCenter. From here you can
manage all drawings and modifications generated, plus additional
documents, from the model.
The RevisionCenter can also be run without the DetailCenter as an independent
module.
477
DetailCenter
478
DetailCenter
menu option Load Detail Style. Now, you can select a style file by the file
selection dialog.
If you directly want to load all existing style files from the standard folder, then
you select the entry Load all Detail Styles instead.
Before the styles are loaded into the drawing, you can select whether the styles
are to retain their original (saved) theme, or whether they are to be assigned to
the currently selected theme.
This additional loading of styles is reasonable if you require a great number of
different styles in your company all in all, but only a part of them has to be used
per order. If you load a detail style existing in the model, the existing style will be
overwritten.
Kindly also take care of the hints concerning the modified file format at the end
of this chapter.
479
DetailCenter
480
DetailCenter
Blue
Yellow
Green
Red
Checkmark
Asterisk (*)
481
DetailCenter
Information about the Component Parts
The meaning of the different entries can be easily differentiated by means of the
symbols, because single parts, sheet metal plates, groups, views, etc. have their
own typical symbol.
In addition to this, you can open a
dockable information window via the
entry Display Information in the
context menu. This window informs
you in detail about all properties of the
part selected at that moment.
This call can be found in the other
work levels too. The content of this
window is always automatically
adapted to your current selection.
Multiple Selection and Drag&Drop
Use the SHIFT and CTRL keys to select multiple entries. This is a Windowsspecific function, which will not be explained here.
Many operations can also be carried out using drag&drop. For example, by
dragging a component list entry on a detail style, you can link the two.
Selection of ProSteel Properties
Via the DetailCenter, the properties of component parts can be directly modified
in the model. Select the entry PS3D Properties in the context menu after having
selected the desired list entries. For more detailed information about parts
properties, please refer to the corresponding chapters of this manual.
In principle, selection is as if you select the part(s) in the model and then load
the properties. In combination with the sorting possibilities of the component
parts list, however, it is possible here to modify e.g. only the material of head
plates. If you are working with a big model, using the traditional way would be
much more complicated.
Dont forget to update the DetailCenter after a modification was made because
the program doesnt carry out an automatic update deliberately.
482
DetailCenter
Pos AA
Pos BC
Pos 1-1
Pos 1-2
Pos TR 1-2
Pos 2-2
Pos ST2-3
Pos TR2-3
Pos 2-4
with Filter:
Pos AA
Pos BC
Pos 1-1
Pos 1-2
(lapses)
Pos 2-2
Pos ST2-3
(lapses)
Pos 2-4
483
DetailCenter
484
DetailCenter
If you assign style "A" to the model and 'Recursive' is activated, every entry is
linked with this style. If 'Recursive' is deactivated, only the entries Outline,
Complete Plan View, BG 100 and BG 101 are linked with this style, because
they are located hierarchically immediately underneath the model. Since the
model itself is only a sorting entry, it passes the association along to its
subordinate entries.
If you assign style "B" to the BG 101 and 'Recursive' is activated, every single
part of this group is linked with this style as well. If 'Recursive' is deactivated,
only this construction group is assigned style "B".
Separate Detail Styles
Select the parts in the list and then use drag&drop to pull them towards the top
and away from the DetailCenter and you are finished! You can also select the
parts and use the context menu to select the option Separate from Detail Style.
Remember that parts without a detail style cannot be processed unless the parts
belong to a group and you want to detail only the group views.
Write-Protection
Use the Set Write-Protection command in the context menu to write-protect
certain entries. The entries are highlighted and cannot be overwritten with a new
style or separated from a style. You have to remove the write-protection before
change or delete the style of such an entry.
The combination of recursive processing and write-protection facilitates
assigning different styles to groups and single parts: Deactivate recursive and
active write-protection and drag the "model entry on the group style. Only the
groups are assigned a style (due to the recursive setting) and are then saved.
Activate recursive and drag the "model entry on the single part style. The style
association is passed on to all parts but the groups themselves are writeprotected.
Hide Parts
You can temporarily remove undesired parts from the component parts list to
get a better survey. To do this, select the corresponding parts and then activate
the menu point Hide Entry in the context menu.
485
DetailCenter
Visibility only refers to the component parts list. Dont mix up this function with
the visibility classes in the 3D-model, which really hide the parts visually and
thus switch to permanently invisible parts.
When the DetailCenter is started anew or when you use the command
UPDATE, all hidden entries will be visible again.
486
DetailCenter
Special Settings
You have access to the hereafter described settings via the button SETTINGS.
Hide
Take over
487
DetailCenter
488
DetailCenter
C.1.10
Views Overview
If you have imported all of the parts for detailing, the generated views are
displayed in this work level, the views list.
Since most of the important points have already been discussed under
Component Overview, here are just a few special commands of this work level.
Dialog-Commands
ADDITIONAL VIEW
Click on this button to add further views to the selected component part or
to create manual details. Then, another dialog opens (see also: Additional
Views).
After an entry has been checked in the views list, the corresponding parts for the
manual detail are automatically selected. On the other hand, when you select
the first entry of the list, you can select any part by clicking on it in the model.
DETAILING
Click on this special action button to detail all of the parts selected in the views
list, including the mentioned partial views, and to store them on the hard drive as
detail blocks.
The created detail blocks then can be inserted in your 2D-drawings.
489
DetailCenter
Views List
Here, you will see all views of the imported parts in the form of entries, which
can be checked for their current status. The display and sorting of the list
depends on the settings of the display templates.
Status Display
The significance of these pictures matches the component part overview; please
refer to that section for further details. If the view has already been detailed it is
marked with a checkmark.
Preview
Before detailing you can display a preview of the detail or of a single view.
Detailing will take place as it is displayed there.
If you choose only one view you will see exactly that view in the preview.
However, if you select the entire component or group, you will see all existing
views of the part in an order determined by the program.
To activate the preview, just select the corresponding entry and then select
Preview via the context menu. After some computing time displayed by the
status indicator, a drawing window opens containing the possible detailing as a
preview.
If the detail style dialog and the preview are open, you can now change the
different detail style settings and check the effects of the modifications. If the
detail style is not yet open, you can open the dialog via the context menu Edit
with Detail Style. The correct detail style belonging to this view is then already
selected.
Add and Remove New Views
Should you notice that the views displayed are too few or show an unfavourable
line of vision on the part, you can add or remove any view.
Just drag the view to be removed towards the top and away from the
DetailCenter using drag&drop. If you select an entire component, the entire
component will be removed; if you select the Detail Views entry, all generated
views are removed.
To add a view to a component just select the corresponding part and call the
entry Additional Views via the context menu (see also: Additional Views).
490
DetailCenter
Detailing
To start the detailing just drag the desired parts onto the action button using
drag&drop. The button will then temporarily turn red so that you know it is active.
Let go off the mouse button and the parts are transferred. You can also highlight
the parts and click on the action button with the mouse or select the entry
Create 2D via the context menu.
During detailing, the information line of views overview informs you about the
estimated remaining time required for detailing the selected parts. This
estimated time is based on the average value of the parts detailed in the current
process and is an approximate value.
.A detail block with the date and time of the detailing is created and saved on
your hard drive every time the detailing process is activated. Every variation of
the same type is thus still accessible later during the insertion process.
You must save the model after the detailing has finished, since the modification
management requires information that has to be written to the drawing. If you do
not save the model, this information is lost.
Special Settings
You have access to the hereafter described settings via the button SETTINGS.
The part is hidden in the model after detailing. You can e.g. at
a detailing via direct part selection see directly from the model
which parts still have to be detailed.
491
DetailCenter
492
DetailCenter
You obtain the result that the position is always independent of the insertion
direction of the part (base plates are always at the bottom), but the front view
once can show the web and once the flange depending on the rotation of the
shape in the view. Tough, parts that are situated further back in construction are
displayed as seen from inside.
Select the entry Set Global Reference View in the context menu of the
component parts list to specify the global front views. Then, you have to click
into the model to get the cross hairs for selection. After that, you select the
desired view direction of the front view and then the alternative view direction.
When you press the ESC-key instead of selection the views are reset to the
default values (0,-1,0) and (1,0,0). The current values are displayed in the
information window.
Front View based on the Outside of the Model (C)
This variant is similar to the global front view. The difference is that instead of
specified reference views you always choose the part coordinate axis, which
show most clearly from the center of construction to the outside. This means
that the front view is always what you would see from the outside if you looked
towards the center of the whole construction.
This method largely corresponds to human imagination, but depending on the
rotation of the shape, once the web and once the flange can be displayed.
The following example shows the effects of the selected main view on the 2Ddisplay of a shape:
493
DetailCenter
Positions 1-4 have been inserted at a rectangular, the Y-axis of the part is
showing to the top and the Z-axis is showing in shape direction. The views A
and B are the specified global front views.
Depending on selection, you will get the front view displayed on the right.
Specify Individual Front View (D)
The last variant is that you can specify for each individual part separately which
part coordinate axis has to serve as front view. In general, you can decide to
use variant (B) or (C) and align unfavourable parts individually and
independently.
Select the entry Set Individual Reference View in the context menu of the
component part list to specify an individual front view. Then, you have to select
the desired part to get the cross-hairs for selection. After that, you choose the
desired view direction of the front view.
When you press the ESC-key instead of selection the individual front view of the
part is deleted. The current value is displayed in the information window. Select
the entry Reset All Reference Views in the context menu of the component parts
list to delete the specifications for all component parts simultaneously.
494
DetailCenter
Other Views
You have the option to add additional views to a part or to create manual details
from entire model areas. Since the manual details are actually free views, they
too are controlled via this dialog.
You have access to this function via the button DDITIONAL VIEW or via the
entry Additional Views in the context menu. The following dialog window is also
a non-modal dialog which means that you can change your part selection in the
views list of the DetailCenter at any time.
The detail style that has to be used for a manual detail. When
you select the option 'From 3D-Component Part', the style
assigned in the component part list will be used.
If the component part doesnt have a detail style, or if it is a
view with freely selectable parts from the model, the default
style will be used instead. It this style has not been defined, a
manual detail cannot be created.
By clicking on the small button on the right side of this field,
you can edit the selected detail style.
Please note that only those detail styles are displayed which
have been classified for use in manual details.
495
DetailCenter
List
Group Selection
Input Field
Here, you see the currently selected detail style, which is used
for a manual detail.
PICK VIEW
Click on this button to define the view level for free views by
picking in the model.
ADD
MANUAL DETAIL
Pick on Plane
Add View
If you want to add one of the six basic views, just select the corresponding view
from the list and click on the ADD button.
To add a free view, just select one of the free views 'View A to View F' from the
list. The input field above can be used to change the name to get a more
suitable one.
Then, click on the PICK VIEW button to specify the UCS (origin, X- and Y-axis)
to pick any view or use the ESC key to import the current view on screen.
Finally, click on the ADD button.
The added views are treated during detailing just like directly created views and
automatically further processed.
496
DetailCenter
497
DetailCenter
C.1.11
If you have detailed all of the parts you can then insert the generated detail
blocks into the workshop plans. You will see the saved detail blocks in this last
work level, the insert list.
Since most of the important points have already been discussed under
Component Overview, here are just a few special commands of this work level.
Dialog Commands
UPDATE
Click on this button to search the current output directory of the
DetailCenter once more.
This is required if you detailed a new model drawing or if a manual copy of
a complete detail folder was entered into the output directory.
EXPRESS
Click on this button to start the DetailCenter Composer for automatic
insertion of detail blocks into the workshop plans as collective tabs
according to a specified pattern.
498
DetailCenter
EXCHANGE
Click on this button to exchange a detail block inserted into the 2Ddrawing for its detailed version with another detail style.
Thus it is possible to exchange unfavourable detail styles of detailed
component parts for more suitable ones without explicit assignment, detailing
and insertion.
499
DetailCenter
List of Details
Here you will see all of the generated detail blocks as their own separate entries
with date and time when they were created and you can check their current
status. The display and sorting of the list depends on the settings of the work
tools.
Status Display
The significance of these pictures matches the component part overview; please
refer to that section for further details. If the detail block has already been
inserted, the entry is marked with a checkmark.
Preview
Before inserting the detail block, you can display a preview. To activate the
preview, just select the corresponding entry and then select the entry Preview
via the context menu.
A new drawing window opens displaying the result of the detailing in the form of
a preview. This detail block can be processed as well.
In case of modification, you mustnt change the name of the drawing on any
account. Otherwise the detail block cannot be identified any more.
Delete Detail Blocks
Click on the corresponding list entry and select the entry Delete...Entry via the
context menu to delete a detail block. Then, the selected detail block will be
deleted in the detail library and will not be available any more.
500
DetailCenter
501
DetailCenter
US-Mark Numbering
During insertion, you can issue component part numbers according to a US
drawing standard. These marks (mostly consisting of sheet number, component
part code and a continuous index) serve for identification of the workshop
drawings of the parts within the model and within the parts lists.
As in practice, each of these marks has an individual structure; they are based
on a definition file describing the structure and value range of the marks. In the
settings, you can select the current definition file to be used under 'US-Mark
Numbering.
At first insertion, a small dialog opens if the 'US-MarkNumbering' option has been activated. This dialog can
be docked beside the DetailCenter. The active fields
depend on the default settings in the definition file.
For each new inserted detail a component part index is
counted up according to definition file. However, this
index can be changed at any time.
The resulting number (e.g. a1) will now be entered in
the model into the field Shipping Number of shape
characteristics and in the 2D drawing into the field
Shipping Number of Position Flag. The position flag
display is changed to Shipping Number.
Click on the button NEW DRAWING to count up the index for the drawing
number and the component part index will be reset to its start value. You can
continue insertion in another drawing sheet.
Drawing Synchronization
When you are inserting the detail blocks, the insert information is saved to
special files of the detail library. After all, it could be that you did not open the
model when inserting blocks and opening the drawing in the background can be
quite frustrating because very large models especially require a long computing
time for this operation.
502
DetailCenter
Every time you open the model, the model drawing is compared and
synchronized with these data. You should never delete these files until the
synchronization process is finished and you have saved the model. The
modification mechanism cannot function reliably if the program lacks the
information telling it which part has been inserted into which drawing.
Your work is better protected, if you do not delete the blocks and folders until
after the assignment is completed.
503
DetailCenter
Special Settings
You have access to the hereafter described settings via the button SETTINGS.
You can issue mark numbers as they are usually used in the
USA at insertion.
Display Fields
Here, you see the definition file used for mark numbers
including a short description. This file includes the format
description of the numbers.
If the program or project path is an element of the information,
the part will only be displayed there as <prg> or <prj>.
504
DetailCenter
C.1.12
Global Settings
In addition to the settings of the different work levels, you can use this page to
make the fundamental settings of the DetailCenter. However, you will also find
special default settings, which are valid for several work levels at the same time
and which are set centrally.
505
DetailCenter
Recompute
Bolts
Workframes
>Blanks too
Standard Views
Connection Gusset When the model structure is analysed, the gusset points of the
construction (e.g. several connections) are also displayed as
entries in the component part list.
Group Behaviour during Selection
Show Part
506
DetailCenter
Synchronize Detail Style The program selects exactly the detail style the currently
checked entry has in the component part resp. views list.
When the dialog window for processing of detail style
parameters is open, the corresponding settings are also
directly displayed there.
> List of Detail Styles dependent The detail styles displayed in the component part
list depend on which type of part is checked. If you have
checked for example a single part, only the styles classified for
single parts will be displayed.
Style classification is effected in detail style dialog. The result
is that only the styles appropriate for the component part or
function will be displayed later.
> Parameter dependent The displayed parameter pages in the detail style dialog
depend on the type of the checked component part. If you
have e.g. checked a single part, the pages for groups will not
be displayed.
Synchronize Part List The DetailCenter is always updated to match with the
active model drawing, if several drawings are open. Since this
process may require some time, you can switch off this option
in the case of big models. Update can be selected manually
via the UPDATE button in the component parts list.
In addition, you often dont want to update the lists while you
are only looking up something in another drawing.
Group Others
Update Preview
Use PlugIn's
Search Joints
507
DetailCenter
Modeller-Tolerance Here, you set the tolerance for contour calculation of the
modeller.
In some rare cases it may be that the contour cannot be
determined correctly at 2D-derivation. This especially occurs
when component parts having very small angles are rotated
towards view direction.
If you detect an incorrect behaviour or if the error message
"Can't calculate Extents" is displayed in the command line of
AutoCAD, you can set here a smaller tolerance value.
Ground Zero
Here, you enter the height level which correspond to the X-Yplane in the model with the height Z=0 (world coordinates).
For detailing of groups and overviews it is thus possible to
display correct height dimensions.
Thus, you can start with a model at z=0 which should however
correspond to the height level -700 of a building plan for the
coordinate dimensioning.
Connection
Multiple
508
DetailCenter
Pos. No.
View Depth
Here, you enter the distances for the plan view plane and for
the anchorage plan of the sectional area.
Here, you set the desired template for sorting and filter of the
component parts list.
In the display field, the currently selected template is
displayed. Click on the small button (...) on the right side of the
display to select another template. Click on the small button
(x) to reset the display to standard display.
Only the templates you created before via display sorting of
component parts list will be offered for selection. If, in the
mean time one of these templates has been changed, the
modified display will be shown, too.
Views
Here, you set the desired template for sorting and filter of the
views list. Selection is analogously to the one for component
parts list.
Insert
Here, you set the desired template for sorting and filter of the
insertion list. Selection is analogously to the one for
component parts list.
509
DetailCenter
Here, you can see on which path the details will be stored
later. A subordinate directory with the model name is created
there. You can modify the path by double-clicking on the field.
It is however recommended to avoid modification of the path
unless it is absolutely necessary!
Program Path
Project Path
Here, you see the complete path of your current project in the
case that project management is used. If other displayed
paths are further subordinate directories of this project path,
the corresponding part is only displayed there as <prj>.
Translation File
Here, you see the desired translation file for drawing labelling.
In the display field, the currently selected file is displayed.
Click on the small button (...) on the right side of the display to
select another file. Click on the small button (x) to reset the
display to standard default.
If the program or project path is an element of the information,
the part will only be displayed there as <prg> or <prj>.
US-Mark-Number
Here, you see the definition file used for US-mark numbers.
This file includes the format description of the numbers.
Selection is analogous to translation file.
510
DetailCenter
Dialog-Commands
TEMPLATE
Click on this button to save your settings of the DetailCenter in a template
or to select one of these templates.
In this template, the individual settings of all work levels as well as the
global settings are saved. Display sorting and filters can only be processed by
indicating the corresponding templates in the global settings of the DetailCenter.
When you have defined one of the templates as favourite, this allows fast
selection from the neighbouring selection list.
511
DetailCenter
C.1.13
Automatic Translation
List
Here, you can see the terms of the database, which have to
be translated. If you click on one of these terms, it will be
displayed in the Original Text field and you can add or revise
the translation.
Please note that only those terms are displayed, which exist in
the database at the very moment. Therefore you have to
update the database after having modified the model.
Language
Original Text
Here, the current entry from the list will be displayed the
translation which you can edit.
512
DetailCenter
Translation
All Entries
Unknown Entries
If this field has been checked, only those entries are displayed
in the list of which a translation into the selected language is
not yet available.
File Path
513
DetailCenter
Update Database
After having modified the model, you should search the model for new terms for
the translation database. These terms are taken from the object properties so
that own comments or component part names for the position flags etc., which
were inserted there, can be translated.
The program tries to synchronize the entries with those of the shape database
of ProSteel so that not modified shape names are not displayed in the
translation.
Please select the context menu in the component parts list of the DetailCenter to
search in the model. Click on the entry Enlarge Translation from Model. The
model is searched for new terms and these are imported.
514
DetailCenter
C.1.14
This function permits you to transfer the drawing numbers saved in the drawing
database or the file paths of the workshop drawings to the component parts
properties of the model drawing.
It is possible to display the drawing numbers of the processed details in the
position flags of an overview. In addition, it would also be possible to export the
parts data via ProSteel standard interface and to have them evaluated by
foreign programs.
Start Transfer
Please select the context menu in the component parts list of the DetailCenter to
click on the entry Take over file Paths. Then, you still have the possibility to
verify the drawing database of the model, if in the meantime you moved some
details or modified the drawing numbers.
After the drawing verification was finished (or if you dont want this option) the
following dialog opens:
515
DetailCenter
Postfix
Group Target
Target
Here you specify into which property fields of the parts the
data have to be transferred.
Note 1 The data are transferred into the note field 1 of the
parts properties.
Note 2 - The data are transferred into the note field 2 of the
parts properties.
Group Links
Equal Positions
Remove before
Now, click on the OK button to transfer the current entries of the drawing
database in the component parts properties.
516
DetailCenter
Drawing Verification
Each time when you insert some details in a drawing, a dependence of the
component part on the workshop drawing and vice versa will be saved in the
drawing database of the model drawing. These saved dependences later permit
an automatic update of the workshop drawing or the transfer of drawing
numbers to the component parts properties of the model.
These links are the reason for your having to enter a valid drawing name of the
destination drawings before insertion of details. It is also the reason for your
having to save the model after insertion.
Nevertheless it may be that you have to modify the physical position of the 2Ddrawings after the complete detailing was finished. This is the case if you have
to save them in an assembly folder of the order in the network. In addition, it
may be that you want to move some details from one drawing to the other in
order to add some completions or just because there is not enough place in the
drawing any more.
However, if the model has saved the wrong dependences, and the DetailCenter
thus cannot function completely as it should, you can correct this subsequently.
This correction partly is carried out automatically, partly by means of your
manual support. It is divided into the two areas Drawing Path Verification and
Detail Verification.
Start of Verification
Please select the context menu in the component parts list of the DetailCenter
and click on the entry Check Dependences. After the note that this function may
require some time and that if need be you can cancel the function the
verification starts.
At first, it is verified whether all paths of workshop drawings saved in the
drawing database still exist. Then, the drawings, which were not found, are
displayed in the dialog. Now, you have the possibility to set the paths or drawing
names anew.
517
DetailCenter
518
DetailCenter
All the details, which were not found, are now displayed in the list. You have
thus the possibility to link any moved details anew or to remove deleted details.
519
DetailCenter
End of Verification
After the verification has been finished, the assignment is structured anew and
the drawing database is updated. You still have the possibility now to remove
the ignored or invalid detail hints from the drawing database. If you refrain from
doing this, the original entries of these details will be kept and you can repeat
the verification at a later moment.
Including Ignored
Delete Ignored
Delete Invalid
If this field has been checked, the data base entries of any
details, which were not found, will be completely removed.
Otherwise, only the hints of 2D-drawings of these details will
be removed.
When you click on CANCEL in this dialog, the data base will not be modified.
520
DetailCenter
You can repeat the verification process at any time you like by means of
correction.
Thus you can first look at the result of drawing verification in a text file (model
name_LogFile.txt) which are situated in the subdirectory ..\detail of
your ProSteel installation. There, you will find a list of all workshop drawings
linked with the model as well as the status of the details expected to be there.
; ProSteel for AutoCAD Drawing Verification
; ------------------------------------------[HEADER]
Verification file=h:\testmodel.dwg
[drawing file: h:\testmodel_views.dwg]
Status=moved or deleted
view hall_FRONT=can not be found
[drawing file: h:\testmodel_details.dwg]
Pos 2 (HE 140 B)=valid
Pos 47 (PLATE 10x137...191)=not found
BG 3 (HE 200 B)=valid
BG 9.1 (HE 200 B)=valid
521
DetailCenter
C.1.15
Direct Detailing
The ProSteel DetailCenter can also be used to detail parts directly from within
the model or display a preview of the detail. This means dimensions of
construction groups can be checked, or only a few selected parts within a
complex building, which are urgently needed, can be detailed.
Perhaps area classes have not been used, but it is now desired to detail a
special truss. Large models pose the problem of being able to identify this part
directly.
The DetailCenter offers a few helpful tools, but the following method is even
easier:
To detail a component part directly from within the model, select a default detail
style first, so that parts without a detail style can be detailed.
Now highlight the parts to be detailed within the model and then select the
context menu via the right mouse button. Depending on the parts selected, a
preview can be created from a single part or a group or these parts or groups
can be detailed directly. Select the desired function from the context menu.
522
DetailCenter
523
DetailCenter
C.1.16
Modification Management
Green
Modified Details
Yellow
Red
524
DetailCenter
Update Drawings
Any parts highlighted in red can be updated automatically. Select a specific
component or a parent and only the parts contained in these are updated. If you
select the "Model" entry, all parts are updated.
Selecting the context menu after having selected the part, use the entry Update
only modified 2D-drawing to activate the modification mechanism. However, if
you want to force also an update of non-modified (green) parts to replace e.g.
the detailing by another detail style you have to select the entry Update 2Ddrawing in the context menu.
One by one, all of the affected drawings are opened in the background, the
parts are newly detailed and inserted directly into the original drawing position,
replacing the old ones. Should you have one of these drawings open at the time,
you can watch this replacement happen live right in front of you.
Subsequent Modifications
Depending on the settings in the work tools of component overview,
modifications of the details, which you carried out later, will be adopted again.
This is of course only possible to a limited extent.
At the very moment, moving of position flags, weld marks, height indicators and
of dimension texts in all 2D-drawings as well as modifications of sketch display
at overviews are adopted. If a dynamic drawing parts list possibly exists, it will
also be updated in the case the component parts have changed.
Please note, however, that only the position of the dimension text can be
restored (in the case that you sorted out unfavourably placed texts), but not the
dimension itself or modifications of the dimension text. To avoid a reset of such
modifications, you can protect them against update.
This procedure might take some time to complete; then all plans are once again
current and the latest detail blocks are ready for insertion. Use the Display only
Latest Blocks option for the insertion to place the details.
You should remember, however, that the modification mechanism functions
optimally only if the tips and notes from the previous chapters are observed and
if you proceed correspondingly at 3D-modelling and positioning as well. You
should, therefore, work through those chapters very diligently.
525
DetailCenter
Anchorage Point
In the 3D-model, it is possible to use the command Set Anchorage Point to
create an anchorage point which can serve as a reference point for the inserted
overviews. The result will be that the modified detail blocks are inserted
congruently relating their anchorage points.
If you place e.g. a horizontal projection, a longitudinal section and a crosssection aligned with each other and you dont make use of an anchorage point,
the views will probably be displaced towards each other when up-dated.
Normally, they are inserted in a centered way and the center point of course
moves when the size of a single view is modified.
Use the Anchorage Point option for the insertion position in the detail style at
detailing to make use of the anchorage point. For overviews, this should always
be done beginning with the first detailing when the deternination of views is
required. If need be, it may also be modified.
Here you see a 3D-model and three detailed views which have been favourably
placed towards each other after insertion. Now, the drawing is up-dated after a
modification, first with and then without anchorage point.
The anchorage point (A) has been inserted at the highlighted spot into the 3Dmodel. In the views, the position has also been highlighted to make things clear.
Afterwards, the construction is modified so that the overall dimensions (and thus
the sizes of the views) change.
526
DetailCenter
After the update without anchorage point the position is clearly shifted from
the highlighted reference line (manual completions would of course remain at
the former position). Due to the additional dimensioning chains, the longitudinal
view and the gable view shift towards each other in the base plane.
On the other hand, when the update is carried out with anchorage point, the
position of the elements towards each other is kept as it was in the original
drawing. The base planes remain aligned to each other and manual completions
at unchanged parts remain still suitable.
527
DetailCenter
528
DetailCenter
Group Selection-Filter
Selection-Filter
Here, you can enter the filter for automatic object selection.
Only those objects will be taken into consideration, which
meet the filter condition.
Select Objects You specify manually by your selection,
which objects have to be protected or released. No filter will
be applied in this case.
All Objects All objects in the drawing are automatically
selected without applying a filter. Processing of course only
refers to dimensions, position flags, weld marks and height
indicators.
Dimension Only dimensioning objects are automatically
selected in the drawing.
Each Flag All position flags, weld marks and height
indicators are automatically selected in the drawing.
Only Position Flags All position flags are selected in the
drawing.
Only Weld Marks All weld marks are selected in the drawing.
Only Height Indicators All height indicators are selected in
the drawing.
Click on this button to activate the protection against update
for the selected objects unless it already exists. If you have
checked the entry Select Objects as selection filter, the
desired objects have to be selected first.
Click on this button to remove the protection against update
for the selected objects if they have one. If you have checked
the entry Select Objects as selection filter, the desired
objects have to be selected first.
Of course, this function has to be applied in the 2D-workshop drawings and not
in the 3D-model. Please also remember that you cannot compare the protection
against update with a blocked layer.
If the dimension to be protected was only on a blocked layer, it would be kept
there, but the newly created (synonymous) dimension would not be deleted.
529
DetailCenter
Reset Modifications
Before the first detailing takes place, the drawing should be initialized, i.e. it
should be set to zero. This will ensure that the modification mechanism
functions optimally. This can of course always be done if you want to continue
your work on a neutral state.
As the component parts in the model remember their modification even during
modelling, it may be that the corresponding markings have already been set.
This could cause some irritations.
Select the entry Reset Modification Code via the context menu of component
parts view to reset any existing information about model modification. The
entries, which details are situated on which drawings, are kept as well as the
already detailed detail blocks.
Please select the entry Initialize All Anew from the context menu to reset the
model completely. Initialize Component Part selectively resets the currently
selected component part.
Please note, however, that now any information will be deleted (unless the
assigned detail styles)! It will then no longer be possible to ask the model where
the different component parts were inserted or to insert component parts already
detailed but not yet inserted.
This complete initialization is reasonable if you made some detailing beforehand
as a test or for a meeting and you now want to create the final workshop plans.
530
DetailCenter
Drawing List
At any time, ProSteel can create a drawing list giving you a survey on the
inserted details and their status of modification. This drawing list is based on the
current entries in the drawing database and on the status of the so-called
modification flags of the component parts.
Therefore, it is recommended to verify the drawing first. The program
automatically offers this drawing verification after the function has been
selected. It is of course also possible that hints which were recognized as invalid
shall nevertheless remain valid because the drawings have only been moved
temporarily.
Creation of File
Select the context menu of the component parts list and click on the entry
Output of Drawing List. A text file (Modelname_DrawingList.txt), will be
created in the subdirectory.. \detail of your ProSteel-installation containing
first a survey on all 2D-drawings and the number of inserted details.
If one of these details has been checked as modified in the DetailCenter, this
drawing is reported as being modified. Therefore, this statement doesnt mean
that the drawing has actually already been modified. It means that it still has to
be modified. In addition, you will find a detailed list per drawing, which details
(position numbers) are contained and which of them has already been modified
in the model.
On the following page, you will find an example of a drawing list. Since an
external program via code words might evaluate the content of this list, the
output of these key words is always in English.
As you can see in the example, there are 6 single parts (2 of them modified) and
2 groups in the drawing with drawing number ABC_PL03. Therefore, the
drawing is checked as being modified.
531
DetailCenter
; ProSteel Drawing List
; ----------------------------------------------------[HEADER]
Created=02-04-2003 * 11:34 AM
ModelFile=h:\testmodell.dwg
FileContent=Drawing list and object reference
Drawings=3
DrawingNumber|Changed |Parts |Groups |Views |DrawingFile
=============|========|========|========|========|========================
ABC_AN01
|no
|
|
|2
|h:\testmodel_view.dwg
ABC_BG02
|yes
|
|5(3)
|
|h:\testmodel_bg.dwg
ABC_PL03
|yes
|6(2)
|2
|
|h:\testmodel_plates.dwg
[h:\testmodel_views.dwg]
DrawingNumber=ABC_AN01
Changed=no
Parts=
ChangedParts=
Groups=
ChangedGroups=
Views=Hall_SEI_R,Hall_X_1
ChangedViews=
[h:\testmodel_bg.dwg]
DrawingNumber=ABC_BG02
Changed=yes
Parts=
ChangedParts=
Groups=3,7,10,31,49
ChangedGroups=3,7,31
Views=
ChangedViews=
[h:\testmodel_plates.dwg]
DrawingNumber=ABC_PL03
Changed=yes
Parts=35,38,40,43,45,46
ChangedParts=40,46
Groups=50,55
ChangedGroups=
Views=
ChangedViews=
532
DetailCenter
C.1.17
This function allows new detailing of detail blocks directly in the workshop
drawing by simple selection. This permits you for example to assign a better
detail style to some unfavourable details still during insertion.
Settings
Display Field
Here, you see the currently selected detail style used for
replacing.
List
533
DetailCenter
534
Detail Style
C.2
Detailing Style
Saving Styles
Normally, the detailing styles are saved together with the 3D-model of the
drawing. This means that you always have to save your model if the
modifications of detailing styles are to be kept permanently.
In addition, there is the possibility to write a detailing style as file on the hard
drive and to re-import it. It is also possible to replace only partial sections of a
style.
This permits you to exchange, update or transfer the detailing styles of different
models. Furthermore, you can create a collection of detailing styles and use in
the model only a selection of those styles, which are required for that moment.
As the volume of a detail style considerably increased compared with earlier
versions, since version 17.2 the file will only be saved as binary file with the file
ending *.stx due to long loading times. All commands for loading a detail style
wait for the style files in this format.
535
Detail Style
To allow a clear view, some of the tabs have subordinate tabs themselves which
are accessible via a button or via a context menu (right mouse key) and which
are used for further settings. in most cases, these are settings which depend on
the selection on the corresponding dialog tab.
The commands of the dialog frame are the ones all dialog tabs have in common.
Only the new specific commands will be described here. The other commands
are found in the general description of ProSteel-dialogs.
536
Detail Style
Standard templates
If no detail style has yet been applied to a drawing, a detail style is automatically
created with standard values and simplified dimensioning rules when the
DetailCenter is opened. Advanced rules can also be added to the dimensioning
pages to load standard templates.
If you want to reset an existing detail style wholly or partially to this standard,
you can do this using the standard templates for individual pages.
Select the desired page from the selection tree and right-click to open the
Context menu. You can now replace the parameters of the currently selected
page with the internal standard parameters (including for broader dimensioning).
Alternatively, you can reset all the pages subordinate to that page or the
complete detail style to standard values.
537
Detail Style
Dialog-Commands
SAVE
When you click on this button, the complete detailing style is saved in a
file on the hard drive. This file has the name of the style and the file
ending *.stx.
It is possible to load this file later into this or into another model or to transfer it
to thirds.
SAVE AS
Click on this button to save the detailing style under another name on the
hard drive. Your detailing style copy automatically gets the name of the
style pre-set here as file name. It is possible to load this file later into this
or into another model or to transfer it to thirds.
UPDATE PREVIEW
When you click on this button, preview detailing of a detail is calculated
anew and updated if the window is open.
Within the DetailCenter you can look in a preview on the effects of a
detailing style for detailing of a detail. Normally, this preview is automatically
updated at each modification of the detailing style.
However, if you have e.g. a very complex overview which requires a lot of time
or if you want to modify a lot of parameters, you can switch off the automatic
update and release it manually.
538
Detail Style
Tab Common
Group Display
Scale
The parts keep their original size and only the text is scaled for
output on a printer /plotter.
True 2D Lines
ACIS if Plates
Dimensioning
539
Detail Style
Position Flags
Weld Flags
Labels
Group Alignment
Projection Method
Alignment
Front View
Here, you indicate how the front view of a component part has
to be specified. The other views then derivate from this front
view.
From Component The element coordinate system of the
component part is used for the determination of the front view.
From Global Views The global views are used for the
determination of the front view.
Outside Model The view from the outside into the model is
used for the determination of the front view.
Individually per Part The individually fixed front view of a part
is used for the determination of the parts front view. If it has
not been defined, the element coordinate system will be used
instead.
Like Group
540
Detail Style
Group Add
Description
Insertion position
541
Detail Style
A cut is made in this view frame for any model views you like.
Position, cut depth and displayed parts are determined by
means of this frame.
Default
> Selection
542
Detail Style
Group Miscellaneous
Distance Views
Distance Isometries Here, you specify the distance of the isometric views towards
the basic views and towards each other.
Distance Unfolding Here, you specify the distance of the unfolding of a bent plate
towards the basic views.
Detail Style Isometry If need be, you specify another detailing style here with which
an isometric view has to be depicted. If you indicate This
Style, no separate detailing style will be used.
Isometry Position
Here, you specify the position where the isometric views have
to be depicted with reference to the basic views. They can be
positioned above, below, on the left or on the right side of the
basic views.
Unfolding Position
543
Detail Style
544
Detail Style
2D-Display
These dialog tabs offer the opportunity to specify the display type of the
component parts (centerlines, drill holes, hidden edges, etc.), which line types
have to be used and which special default settings have to be valid for the
different detailing types.
Tab Common
Group Add
Visible Edges
Invisible Edges
2D-Bolts
The bolts are depicted as real view with nut and bolt head.
2D-Weldmint
2D-Elevation symbols The height indicators imported to the model are depicted.
Special Parts
Special parts inserted into the model are depicted. These may
be any parts (such as e.g. blocks) containing ProSteel
component part caracteristics.
Real Cross-Sections The shape cross-sections are depicted with their exact radii
otherwise, the simplified depiction in the form of straight lines
is selected.
545
Detail Style
> At Dimensioning
Bearing Bar Direction A symbol for the bearing bar direction is attached (which
corresponds to the lengthwise direction of the grid) if it is a
matter of plates having a grid.
> Symbol Size
Here, you enter the size of the symbol, which is used for the
direction of the plate grid.
Symbol-Distance
Min. Shortening
Max. Number
Distance Edge
Shortening Symbol Here, you select the symbol, which has to be inserted into the
shape at shortening position.
Single Line The symbol is a simple straight line.
ZigZag Single The symbol is a serrated, wave-like line.
Double Line The symbol is a double straight line with the
gap set in the 'Symbol-Distance' input field.
ZigZag Double - The symbol is a serrated, wave-like double
line with the gap set in the 'Symbol-Distance' input field.
Only Gap There is no symbol depicted, but only a gap with
the distance set in the 'Symbol-Distance' input field.
Break Symbol
546
Detail Style
Group Others
2D Display
Here you can select the processes used to create plans from
ProSteel and ProConcrete elements during overviews. The
opposing elements will then usually be displayed in a less
true-to-life manner.
Automatic The process with the largest number of objects
will be used.
ProSteel The ProSteel method will always be used.
ProConcrete The ProConcrete method will always be used.
Hatch pattern
Hatch size
547
Detail Style
Here, you specify the excess length of the axis beyond the
outside edges of the shape.
At a plan view on the drill hole the two axes (horizontal and
vertical) are depicted.
In the selection list, you can specify whether all holes, only the
visible holes or the invisible holes have to be displayed or
whether there has to be no display at all.
Here, you specify the excess length of the axis beyond the drill
hole depiction.
> Rotated by 45
548
Detail Style
> Filled
According to Style Template The drill holes are displayed with a depiction which
can be defined freely. Thus it is possible to get your own
depictions (e.g. true to no scale or symbolic), too, depending
on the current hole diameter for the application of different
standards and special cases.
> Symbol Size
549
Detail Style
Used to select the source from which the definition of the line
type representation is taken for the three object line types
Visible, Hidden and Center line. This determines which line
type and line colour are used for an object in 2D mode.
From detail style The definition is taken from the settings on
this page.
From configuration The definitions are taken from the
ProSteel configuration file.
From description file The definitions are taken from a
separate instruction file. This file contains descriptions of parts
that can also be used for dimensioning and representations in
overviews.
From part family The definitions are taken from the part
family under which the relevant part is classified.
Colour
Line type
On part layer
The lines are shown on the same layer name as the original
part in the 3D model. Otherwise they are shown on the layers
for visible or invisible lines.
550
Detail Style
Dialog-Commands
SELECT COLOUR
Click on this button to open the AutoCAD-standard dialog for colour
selection and you can select the colour number in the diagram.
551
Detail Style
Group General:
With Center Lines
Offset
Here, you specify the excess length of the center line beyond
the two ends of the shapes.
Roof/Wall Panels
Combi Shapes
Welded Shapes
Group Others
Shape List
When displaying overview plans, you can use freely definable object groups in
combination with standard settings to control how center lines are displayed. For
further information please see the definition of 2D display in overviews in this
manual.
552
Detail Style
Tab SingleParts
Special Shapes
Roof-Wall Shapes
Combi Shapes
Weld Shapes
At End Plates
Position Section
553
Detail Style
Group Others
Direction Symbol
Display Origin
554
Detail Style
Tab Groups
Group Cuts
Display Sections
Only manual
Show Identical 1x
Arrange Below
The cuts are not depicted on the left and/or on the right of the
main view (mostly the front view), but beneath the last views,
one beside the other.
Symbol Outside
Symbol Template
555
Detail Style
Labeling
Here, you indicate the cut designation (without the code letter
for cut) that has to be used for labeling the cut views
Cut Code
Here, you enter the code letter (or number) that has to be
used to describe the first cut of a group. All other cuts of this
group will be counted accordingly in increasing order.
With Position Flags The position flags of the neighboring parts are also inserted in
the view.
Detailing Style
Search Area
With Component Group Style The end plates are depicted with the detailing style
used for the component group. Otherwise, they are always
displayed with their own detailing style.
View Direction
Here, you specify the view direction of the end plate detail
related to the group.
Inside The shape to be connected is depicted as cut.
Outside The shape to be connected is depicted as hidden.
Above The shape to be connected is depicted as cut
together with base plates and as hidden together with end
plates.
Min. Distance
The distance of the end plate details towards the other views
of the group.
556
Detail Style
Group Others
Display Origin
Here, you can enter the size of the reference point. The RD
symbol characteristics at American dimensioning option are
specified in dimensioning parameters.
Show Northern Direction A mark is displayed at the group showing the alignment
with regard to a global northern direction.
In the global settings, the American dimensioning style has to
be activated.
With Part Number
Indicate Mounting Position In the case of stiffeners and web angles, it is specified
whether these are situated on the front or back side of the web
or on both sides of the web (in case of identical parts).
To recognize identical parts, the parts have already to be
equipped with a position number. Only a simple comparison is
made here by means of position number and position of the
parts center.
557
Detail Style
Enter the size of the selection box in the input fields X, Y and
Z. The distances refer to the component part coordinate
system of the main shape and are measured from the center
of the main connection.
Cut at Box
Enter the size of the cut box in the input fields X, Y and Z. The
distances refer to the component part coordinate system of
the main shape and are measured from the center of the main
connection.
558
Detail Style
Group Others
System Point
For more detailed information about how to create a gusset detail, please refer
to the chapter DetailCenter/Gusset Details of this manual.
559
Detail Style
Tab Views
Anchor Plan
> Details Sc 1:
Here, you enter the scale of base plate details in the anchor
plan.
However, an anchor plan can only be generated if you have
linked the view Anchor Plan in the component parts list with
this style setting.
> Columns As Object The columns in the anchor plan are displayed as intelligent
2D-Objects.
> Offset Edge
Rel. Length
560
Detail Style
Only Within
Use XRef
The parts added to the model via XREFs are displayed and
dimensioned as well. The above mentioned display filters are
also valid for these component parts. Please refer to your
AutoCAD documentation where you will find a description how
to work with XREFs.
At original Position
The generated view is not put into x/y plane (z=0), but it is
aligned and placed in the same way like in the model.
This permits the insertion as overlapping in an already existing
3D-model (e.g. for facilities construction). The option is not
available when the view output is scaled.
The view depths assigned to the work frames are used for
views.
Dialog Default
The view depths specified in this dialog are used for views.
> Front/Back
Enter the view depths Front and Back, which have to be used
for the views.
> Front/Back
Max. Distance
Displacement
Enter a displacement the plane used for the view has to have
from the actual work frame (in view direction).
If the view plane doesnt have to be exactly in the work frame
plane, this will save you an additional view.
561
Detail Style
Extension
Length/Spacing The line length for symbols for bracings. Negative values
determine the spacing between two symbol lines. (C)
Horizontal offset The inward horizontal offset when bracings are displayed as
symbols. (D)
Vertical offset
The dimensions given for bracings always pertain to the insertion lines of the
structural element (at bracing level), so bracings located off-centre are displaced
accordingly in the display.
562
Detail Style
View depth
The view depth for a view, i.e. which parts can be displayed, is defined based on
the intersecting distances in the working area or the settings of the detail style. If
an object lies outside the zone parallel to the plane of projection, it cannot be
displayed. A distinction is drawn here between normal view depth and extended
view depth, e.g. for bracings.
563
Detail Style
The following illustration shows the relationships between the current plane of
projection, the direction of projection and the view depths:
The parts of the bracing B1 and B2 can be included in the view from above in
their entirety under the settings for the view, since their structural elements
(crosses) lie within the extended view depth. This enables all parts of a bracing
to be displayed or faded out regardless of whether only individual parts lie
within the normal view depth.
At least one part of the bracing must however lie within the normal view depth,
since this depth takes first priority.
564
Detail Style
The detail point overview shows the construction 5 in the selected views (here
front view and view from the right), the cutting depth results from the
rd
corresponding 3 dimension of the cube.
565
Detail Style
The result of detailing process for the different kinds of overviews is displayed in
the following figure. The display of dimensions, position flags, etc. depends on
the selected detailing style. Example (A) shows the standard view, example (B)
the cranked view and example (C) a detail point overview consisting here of
three partial views.
566
Detail Style
Settings
Here you select which components will be represented in the overview plans
and how they are to be represented.
To this end, you define corresponding rules and attribute these rules to the part
types that you wish to include. Note: Since the procedure at this point is in
principle very similar to the definition of customized dimensioning rules (and is
documented in detail there), much information and many functions are to be
found in the description of "Dimensioning." The procedure is consequently
explained very briefly below and only the differences are described in detail.
567
Detail Style
The following example shows a view in mixed representation. Only the most
important profiles are fully represented and labeled in detail here. Secondary
profiles, on the other hand, are reduced to single lines and adjacent buildings
are represented with their own type of line and without labels.
568
Detail Style
Display settings
You can determine settings within a display group independently for the primary
and secondary view of a single component (based on the current detail view
like, for example, the outline).
In the tree structure select the display group whose settings you wish to change.
You can subsequently change the values of this group on the right side.
Primary/secondary view
Here you select whether you wish to process the settings for the primary or
secondary view. You always process the settings represented by the symbol
currently displayed.
Selection symbol for primary / secondary
Settings
Display (I)
Display (II)
Center line
Line reference
Here you select the starting and end point for the display of
the centre / single line.
Line display
Here you select the combination of line type and color (see
also 2D-Display/General/Line display). The selection normally
refers to the visible lines.
Component name(I) The position of the additional label text on the component.
Component name (II) Selection of the information that is to be displayed in the label
text.
The following two pages contain a table listing the options to be found in the
selection lists.
569
Detail Style
Display (I)
No display
System line
US Stick
US Sketch
Outline
Standard
Display (II)
No additional option
No holes
No hidden lines
All lines are displayed in the color and with the line type of the visible lines.
Stick Symbols A
Stick Symbols B
Center line
Like standard specification
The center line is displayed in line with the standard specifications for the
center line of the detailing style.
Do not display
Always display
Line reference
Center line
The center line displayed corresponds to the center line of the component.
Reference line
The center line displayed corresponds to the reference line of insertion line
of the component.
Reference points
The center line displayed corresponds to the line between both reference
points of the component (if available).
570
Detail Style
Line display
Like standard specification
All lines are represented according to the standard specifications for the
line display of the detail style.
The visible lines (depending on the setting, however, the hidden and
center lines too) are represented with the line representation selected.
Component start
Component middle
Component end
The text is represented above the component at the end of the component.
Beside component
Below component
Rotated on component
Position number
Shipping number
The component name and the relative position of the component to the
view plane are given. See also "Relative height reference."
The text is given according to the format specification of the detail style
(see description of "labeling"). This specification may contain placeholders
for the current component data.
Individual or global
format specification
571
Detail Style
Name
Position number
Dispatch number
Material description
Distance to plane
Note 1
Note 2
Special treatment of empty texts (see further below)
Text alignment
Depending on the scope of the construction, you may need different text
positions and alignments to retain a clear drawing image.
The adjacent image shows
examples of the different text
positions,
alignment
and
insertion points.
572
Detail Style
Special treatment of empty texts
A special formatting input enables a special treatment of text replacements with
empty texts. For the output of the relative height reference with a value of "0"
there is no explicit text output and even the note fields do not always have
content.
To exclude unnecessary additional texts like "O.K.=" or Spaces, for example,
you can control this with the formatting input $(X,) independent of the
replacement value. The text after the comma including a replacement value is
only outputted if this replacement value for the component is not empty.
Please note that you can only use one placeholder in every $(X,) allocation.
Nesting is not possible. However, you can use several allocations with different
respective placeholders.
Below you can see examples of components with the names HEA 100 with and
without the content-controlled formatting specification respectively.
Format specification
Output
P$(N) [OK=$(E)]
P$(N) [OK=$(E)]
P$(N) $(X,[OK=$(E)])
P$(N) $(X,[OK=$(E)])
P$(N) $(X,[OK=$(E)] )***
P$(N) $(X,[OK=$(E)] )***
+50
+50
+50
573
Detail Style
Symbolic display
If the display version "US Stick" is selected, you can also obtain a symbolic
display for bracings and moment connections in addition to display as a single
line. This is often used in the U.S. for the top view of vertical bracings and strut
layouts.
The advantage of this representation is that the key information is contained in
the symbols, but the drawing is simplified.
Assignment of components
The assignment of components to a display group is possible via a joint
selection of the components concerned. In the component selection select
Bracing connection elements to select a complete bracing element and Moment
connection elements to select a complete moment connection element.
To enable correct recognition of the components, the latter must be modeled
with the corresponding functions ("Structure object bracing connection element"
for the bracing elements and/or "Moment connection element" for the moment
connections).
Symbols for bracing elements
Bracing elements are represented by different symbols according to their
construction. You have the choice between type A (slanting) and type B
(straight), whereby a fixed line length should be used for type B, should the
direction be represented for individual rods.
If the bracing element lies above the view level the symbol is always
represented above and/or left of the vertical bracing level. The beginning of the
rod as a symbol is always the nearest point to the view level. The length of the
lines and distances can be defined in the general specifications for views (see
"symbol dimensions").
574
Detail Style
575
Detail Style
C.2.4 Dimensioning
Here, you can indicate all of the settings for the dimensioning of the
components. Since this is a rather complex area, the settings are distributed
among several subordinate dialogs within this main group.
In addition, you will find completing dialog boxes and commands which can be
opened directly from the different pages or via the context menu of the right
mouse key.
Dimensioning settings occupy an important place in the detailing style and
contribute a great deal to the quality of workshop drawings. Therefore it is
important that you have a closer look to their way of working.
The following chapters first will give you a survey on the functioning and on the
terms before the different options will be described in detail. Common or similar
things will only be described once due to a better clarity.
Extended Conception
It is for the first time that a new conception for automatic dimensioning was
introduced with version 17.1. The distribution of ProSteel all over the world led
to considerably increasing demands on a flexibly adaptable dimensioning.
The idea of previous versions was to cover a wide range of variants with a few
fixed default settings by intelligent automatic mechanisms. An increasing
number of exception-buttons, however, meant increasing confusion. This is the
reason why the new conception now permits precise default settings for the
different sections so that you can better adapt your detailing style to the
construction and to necessary drawing standards.
With version 18.0, this new conception has once again been modified to
facilitate the proceeding of settings, quality remaining unchanged. On the other
hand, this had the result that many times the amount of new dimensioning
possibilities has been created. At the same time, the program has been adapted
to the extended group structure of ProSteel.
At first glance, the great number of parameters and possibilities will perhaps
frighten you. However, when you take a closer look, you will fast find out that the
default settings for dimensioning follow a standardized logic and that therefore
things are logically repeated.
The example on the following page shows dimensioning of a complexe
component part group as it now is possible with the new detailed setting
structure automatically and without further follow-up treatment.
576
Detail Style
577
Detail Style
Dimensioning Structure
ProSteel dimensioning is divided into several main groups for single parts,
component part groups, model-views, etc. which can be set independently of
each other. Within each main group, there are still other subordinate groups the
parameters of which are also independent of each other.
Trans-sectoral settings facilitate the common use and reduce the number of
necessary parameters e. g. dimensioning of the main parts of component part
groups are controlled via single parts setting.
578
Detail Style
However, this structuring is only the major selection of parameters. Each
subordinate group itself again consists of an inner structure with independent
default settings for the different detailing processes (of single parts) or for the
different component parts (of component part groups or model-views).
Each single component part or detailing type permits individual default settings
for different dimensioning directions and component part views. However, a
considerable repetition degree is reached here.
Inner Structure
Here, you see the inner structure of a subordinate group as it exists for
dimensioning of add-on pieces in component part groups.This is the structure
with the most variants as the dimensioning of a component part group has to
take into consideration a lot of different conditions.
In the following, we will therefore describe the essential matters with the help of
the settings for dimensioning of a component part group.
As you can see it is possible to preset a different dimensioning point for shapes
in bent component part groups (radial) compared with the standard component
part groups (linear). For stiffeners things may again be different.
579
Detail Style
Dimensioning Groups
You can generate any dimensioning groups with identical settings you like by
using the component parts of the inner structures. The advantage is that
identical settings for different component parts can fast be made or modified.
The number of parameters still allows a clear view.
At the same time, an essential limit of previous versions is superseded:
synonymous component parts which were differently modelled in the 3D-model
can be dimensioned together by means of one setting. Let us take stiffeners in a
shape here as an example which have once be manually created as polyplates
and once by using the stiffener function.
Nesting
Complex group structures such as e.g. an assembly can consist of several
component part groups and subgroups.
Nesting in dimensioning (individual dimensioning) permits complete
dimensioning even of subordinate groups within a parent group. Additional detail
drawings can thus be omitted.
As there is only one set of parameters per hierarchy type available for
subordinate structures, individual structures can be excluded or limited in
dimensioning via filter.
Typical applications of nested dimensioning are for example the dimensioning of
the detailings of add-on parts in groups or the dimensioning of the position of
component part add-on parts in assemblies.
580
Detail Style
Dimensioning Groups
All essential parameter settings are made per partial sector via freely definable
dimensioning groups with any assignment of component part types, i.e. you can
define if need be how complex the structure of dimensioning has to be.
Compared with previous versions, this proceeding is considerably more
practise-oriented because first you decide (a) how you want to dimension and
then (b) which component parts have to be dimensioned in this way.
In the easiest case of component part group dimensioning only the settings for
the overall dimension and the settings of a common dimensioning group for all
add-on parts independent of their type is available. However, if a more
complex dimensioning is required, you can add further dimensioning groups or
special dimensions as you like and thus specialise the default settings even
further.
Define Guidelines for Dimensioning
In principle, a dimensioning group complies with a clear guideline for the
component parts to be dimensioned.
By means of the parameter set of the group you define how the component
parts have to be dimensioned. This parameter set is divided into different rules
for straight and bent dimensioning directions, favourable and unfavourable
views, etc. By means of the assigned component parts you define which
component parts have to be dimensioned with these rules. This can either be a
very general selection (e.g. all shapes) or a very special selection (e.g. sheet
metal plates bigger than 200x200 mm).
Dimensioning is worked off according to the principle of exception: All
component parts or detailings for which no own rule has been defined, are
treated together with the settings of the so-called standard group. This group
exists in any partial sector of dimensioning and permits a fast selection at
identical rules.
If certain component parts dont have to be dimensioned, they have to be
assigned to a group as well, because No dimensioning is a kind of rule, too.
For example, you could define the different rules for all component parts having
to be dimensioned and then set the standard group to No dimensioning.
Special Component Part Groups, Detailings and Special Dimensions
Each component part can be assigned to a standard dimensioning group.
However, apart from their common properties shapes and sheet metal plates
also have features which dont mean anything to the other of both types.This is
the reason why in a standard group only the common properties of dimensioning
are available.
581
Detail Style
If you want to make use of the extended properties, you can e.g. insert a shape
dimensioning group to which exclusively shapes can be assigned. However, this
group offers many more setting possibilities especially just for shapes.
The detailings of single parts (drill holes etc.) as well as certain other
dimensions are dimensioning rules to which nothing else can be assigned.
However, here it logically is a matter of dimensioning groups as well which can
be added if need be.
These very often are very special groups and can only exist once per
dimensioning area. The overall dimension of a detail is also a special dimension.
As it is often required, it is a kind of standard dimension which always exists.
User-defined dimensions constitute a special case. As many dimension points
can be dimensioned on as many reference points as desired, although these
points need to be defined individually on the 3D model.
Multiple Dimensioning
Normally, a component part is dimensioned only once, e.g. drill hole
dimensioning. This option is already known from previous versions.
The flexible structure now also permits multiple dimensioning of component
parts. Thus it is possible to (a) dimension all shapes via the drill holes as you did
up to now and (b) to dimension certain shapes additionally via the center axes
by using completely independent default settings.
Multiple dimensioning of a
straight shape.
The
outside
girders
are
equipped with an additional
dimensioning chain via the
center axes..
582
Detail Style
The following example of an assignment shows the structure of a more complex
dimensioning. Three additional dimensioning groups with independent rules are
defined and an additional special dimension is fixed.
default setting for all shape types
(standard group, added as an option)
Additional dimensioning for U- and C-shapes for
completion, i.e. multiple dimensioning
(special shape group, added as an option)
As the standard group has to process all other component part types, this in
principle is a standard dimensioning group.
Copy Settings
Most of the dimensioning groups can be copied within a partial sector. At first,
no component parts are assigned to this copy, even if there are already some
assignments in the original group.
Copies have always the same type, i.e. if the original group is a shape group,
the copy again is a shape group, too. Then, you can rename the copy and
assign the desired component parts to it.
Special dimensions and single part detailings can exist only once and therefore
cannot be copied.
583
Detail Style
Standard Default Settings
When a new dimensioning group is created, it is equipped with standard default
settings which in most cases produce proper results. You can always reset a
group into this standard state if it appears to be hopelessly altered.
In addition, it is also possible to create a complete standard default setting for
each partial sector of dimensioning (e.g. dimensioning of add-on parts in
groups). Apart from the settings, this standard default setting also contains an
assignment of component parts. The standard default setting has been
optimized for typical support/girder constructions and is a good starting-point for
user-defined adaptations.
The standard default settings were defined by the manufacturer and cannot be
modified in order to find a uniform starting position at each user and at any time.
Kindly make use of the standard loading functions of the detailing style to define
your own standards.
Conversion of Former Drawings
Models which were created with version 17.1 or 17.2 had a fixed default setting
of independent parameter records. When you open these models with version
18.0, a separate dimensioning group will be created for each of these parameter
records so that the behaviour will be analogous to the previous version in case
of parameter modifications.
You can of course remove groups which are not required or modify the
assignment of component parts afterwards. If desired, you can thus sum up
identical default settings to a common group.
584
Detail Style
Dimensioning Areas
ProSteel differentiates different dimensioning areas which you can imagine as
independent local areas.
The respective alignment is determined by the involved component parts and
influences the indications of place and direction in the dialogs. As an option,
there is also a forced horizontal or vertical alignment independent of the position
for each part dimensioning in a dimensioning area.
585
Detail Style
Local Area (2a and Connection Area (2b)
These are all dimensioning chains which are situated inside the component part
group and which describe the position of the subparts with regard to their direct
reference part.
In case of dimensioning of subparts with local reference (2a), the horizontal
alignment is determined by the corresponding reference part and the smallest
extent corresponds to a rectangular around this reference part.
In case of aligned dimensioning of subparts (2b), the horizontal alignment is
determined by the corresponding add-on piece and the smallest extent
corresponds to a rectangular around this add-on piece. .
Here, you see a comparison
of the three possible variants
by which the butt strap can be
dimensioned as an add-on
piece of a component part
group.
The dimensions according to
variant (1) and (2a) are
alternatively possible; the
dimensions
according
to
variant (2b) can be attached in
addition.
Individual Dimensioning (3)
These are all dimensioning chains which are situated inside the component part
group and which describe the production dimensions of individual subparts. The
horizontal alignment is determined by the corresponding subpart and the
smallest extent corresponds to a rectangular around this subpart.
Additional Views (4)
These are all dimensioning chains which are situated outside the component
part group in possible additional views so that here it is strictly speaking a matter
of another global area. These additional views are for example the turned down
endplates (here production dimensions) or cuts and details (here dimensioning
of position).
The horizontal alignment is determined by the alignment of the view and the
smallest extent corresponds to a rectangular which you could draw around all
component parts in this view direction.
The notion inside here refers to a typical setting of dimensioning distances. At
corresponding default settings, these inside dimensioning chains can actually
be situated outside of the group as well.
If the main part of a component part group or the local reference parts are bent
shapes, the dimensioning direction or the surrounding rectangular will follow this
bend.
586
Detail Style
Individual Areas in Complex Group Structures
When the corresponding detail is a complex group structure (such as e.g. an
assembly), individual dimensioning is not exclusively limited to production
dimensions of single parts. Within an assembly, the contained component part
groups can be dimensioned individually as well as it is the case with standard
component part groups (see Nested Dimensioning).
In this case, several independent types of individual areas exist which can be
managed separately. Each of these areas would correspond to the global area
of the corresponding substructure if you displayed them as separate detail.
Assignment
It depends on the kind of 3D-modelling whether a component part can be
reliably assigned to a local area.
Most of the ProSteel functions create logical links between the involved
component parts. By means of these links it is possible to determine which
component part has been connected to another component part and by means
of which connecting component parts this connection was realized (e.g. web
angle). Thus, the assignment connected part and reference part is clearly
defined.
When you cut however for example two shapes by means of a cutting line so
that they match with each other, no logical link will be created there. In this case,
you can force a relation of the component parts by the manual link
(PS_MANUAL_LINK).
The manual link should also be used when the automatically created link of a
connection can - for whatever reasons - not be evaluated for determining the
relations.
When the assignment cannot be determined and you selected a local reference
of the component part, the component parts in question will be assigned to the
global area.
587
Detail Style
Local Areas in Overviews
Different local dimensioning areas can be determined for overviews, too. They
are however not realized via component part relations but via a geometrical
analysis of shape dimensions.
The shapes are classified according to length and position and then possible
segments are built after an evaluation. Finally, these segments are brought
together to local areas within certain tolerance ranges.
You can preset the parameters for area analysis in detail; we have, however, to
admit that this requires a high degree of experience.
588
Detail Style
589
Detail Style
590
Detail Style
The example on the previous page shows a component part group with the main
part (1) and several add-on shapes (2) and (3), which for their part are
containing stiffeners (4).
A local dimensioning reference with Component Part Start as refererence point
was selected for dimensioning the stiffeners.
As you can see, dimensioning is done along the component parts containing the
stiffeners and each dimensioning chain starts near the reference part. In this
example, the component part (2) is situated above the main part (1) and the
component part (3) is situated below component part (2).
Position of Dimensioning Chains
You can either by force preset the position of the dimensioning chains within an
area or you make select them automatically.
Component parts can be dimensioned on the side on which with regard to
their reference part they are situated. In addition, a favourable side is defined,
depending on the position, as it is displayed in the following figure:
591
Detail Style
592
Detail Style
593
Detail Style
Linear
Radial
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
depending on type
depending
on type
Yes
Yes
depending on type
depending
on type
594
Detail Style
Edge Group
Reference Point
Connecting Shape
The example on the following page shows some important reference points of
dimensioning chains. Web angle dimensioning could be made on the starting
point of the group (1) or on the starting point of the main part (2).
Dimensioning on the edge of the reference part would dimension the two web
angles on the left on point (2) and the web angles on the right on point (3) in
case of edge group, this would be the points (1) and (4).
595
Detail Style
In the present example, however, the variant connecting shape was selected
and thus you obtain the two dimensioning chains (A) as result. Dimensioning
chain (B) results from the fact that, in addition, the reference points are
dimensioned, too.
Here, too the center of the reference part in question is the dividing line for the
options inner edge and outer edge.
596
Detail Style
Additional Dimensions
You can add different additional dimensions to each dimensioning chain. These
are added later to obtain closed dimensioning chains.
The additional dimensions permit uniform dimensioning running; on the other
hand the dimensioning reference can be made clearer, you can eliminate
insignificant remaining dimensions and thus reduce the number, when you dont
use them.
597
Detail Style
American Dimensioning
When you selected American Style as general default setting for dimensioning,
you obtain additional labels and dimensions as they are common in the USA.
At the moment, only a limited configuration of these additions is possible. They
depend on the importance of the component parts in the model. Together with
the generally available settings, you have thus the possibility to create drawings
according to these standards, too.
598
Detail Style
599
Detail Style
On the following pages, you will find a detailed description of the different part
areas, their settings and additional functions.
600
Detail Style
Structure of Part Areas
The following survey shows all independent part areas of dimensioning in
standard dialog display. When you selected the intelligent arrangement of
parameters, some of these areas are hidden or they are situated on another
position of the tree structure. However, it is always exactly the same data
record.
General default settings which are valid for all
areas (e.g. distance of one dimensioning chain
to the other, dimensioning styles, dimensioning
of drill holes etc.)
601
Detail Style
The arrangement corresponds to the hierarchic structure of the part area. By
selecting an entry, you directly reach the parent or subordinate dialog tabs of the
corresponding part area.
As e.g. the entry Cut is situated below the entry Reference Points in the part
area Group, the dimensioning chains for intersections in groups are set here.
602
Detail Style
Group Name
603
Detail Style
Group Labelling
Type Labelling
Selection Direction
Labelling Text
For more detailed information about labelling, please refer to the section
Labelling of Dimensioning Chains in this chapter.
You can add or copy any number of component part groups and assign
component parts to them. If need be, it is thus possible to build very complex
dimensioning structures.
Detail Style
Assign Component Parts
Depending on the type, certain component parts can be assigned to any
standard dimensioning group or to the special component part groups. Select
the desired group and then click the entry Add Component Parts in the context
menu. The following dialog opens:
The content of the selection lists depends on the type of dimensioning group, on
the settings and on the component parts already assigned to.
Group Selection Lists
Upper List
Here you select the principle component part type (main type)
such as shapes, plates, etc. you want to add.
If you do not want any particular restriction here, select the All
types entry.
Subtypes
Here you select a subtype with which you can limit the
selection of the upper list. However, subtypes are not
available for all component part types.
Thus you can limit an assignment e.g. only to all U-shapes.
Select the entry All Shape Types if you dont want to limit the
assignment.
605
Detail Style
Enter an area with which you limit the selection in the fields
From and To. If you enter the value 0 in both fields, this size
will not be taken into consideration.
Relative position
Enter the area class of the part (or a section of the area class
with placeholders) used to limit the selection.
Family
Enter the part family (or a section of the part family with
placeholders) used to limit the selection.
Display
Enter the visibility class (or a section of the visibility class with
placeholders) used to limit the selection.
Description
<<
Name
Please note that, for the input fields for the various classes or part descriptions,
leaving the field empty is the same as Any, i.e. the value will not be taken into
consideration.
If on the other hand it is necessary to filter out parts that have not been allocated
to any family, the value None may be entered.
606
Detail Style
Group Others
Only New Parts
Multiple Assignments If this field has been checked, component parts or areas of
component parts can be added several times unless it is a
matter of the same dimensioning group.
For more detailed information about multiple assignments and wildcards, please
refer to section Automatic Assignment Check in this chapter.
Click on this button to add your defaults as new assignment or
to modify the selected assignment accordingly.
607
Detail Style
Automatic Assignment Check
When component parts are assigned, the program automatically checks
whether the type, name or size areas overlap and therefore the result would be
an indefinite assignment. If this is the case, the new assignment will not be
accepted and an error message will be displayed.
The check is made at each insertion or modification of assignments and
depends on the option Multiple Assignments. If this option has been activated,
the check is only made in the current dimensioning group the assignment can
be repeated in another group of the part area. If multiple assignments option has
been deactivated, the program checks the complete part area by means of all
groups that a component part will be registered only once.
The following diagram shows some examples of desired assignments:
Existing Assignment
Shapes
Shapes
not possible
Shapes
not possible
OK
not possible
not possible
Shapes, Name=HEA*
Shapes, Name=HEB*
OK
Shapes, Name=HE*
Shapes, Name=HEB*
not possible
The symbol ? can be used as wildcard for any single character in the name or
in the component part description. The symbol * can be used for any
sequence of characters.
It is true that you can use the symbols as you like, but a correct check with
regard to overlapping only takes place for the symbol * at the beginning and/or
end.
608
Detail Style
Labelling of Dimensioning Chains
Many dimensioning chains can be equipped with a labelling text indicating which
component parts, detailings or situations are dimensioned. This text may be
controled individually per group via dimensioning groups if a labelling is
generally provided there by the program and it has been switched on globally
(see dialog tab General Info).
In the global area of the usual dimensioning of add-on parts or detailing most of
the dimensioning chains can be equipped with a labelling text. At nested
individual dimensioning, it often has been internally deactivated.
The mentioned labelling consists of additional functional info texts. The possible
indication of hole diameters at separated dimensioning chains is not affected by
this.
You can directly enter individual data with regard to the labelling text when
inserting the dimensioning group. If you want to modify the data later, you have
to select the dimensioning group and then call the command labelling of
dimensioning chains in the context menu. Then, a dialog opens, identical to the
dialog for generating a dimensioning group.
Labelling Types
None
Automatic
Group/Assignment
User-def. Default
Select Direction
Both Directions
Only Horizontal
Only Vertical
609
Detail Style
Examples for Dimensioning Structures
Beneath please find some examples for different dimensioning groups and
assignments:
1) Here a general default Outside Edges for Each Component Part is created
simply and fast via standard group.
610
Detail Style
User-defined dimension points and dimension references
If the objects are very complex or if there are special requirements with regard
to dimensions, the existing methods that come as standard are not always
sufficient for the desired results.
Instead of having to dimension objects manually after they are produced, it is
possible to add individual dimension points and dimension references (in
addition to the two main reference points) to each object in the 3D model.
The functions for adding and modifying separate dimension references are
located in the 3D object properties for profiles and panels.
Dimension point
Reference point
Reference area
611
Detail Style
612
Detail Style
Selection Range
Selection Tree (1)
Click on a list entry to select the dimensioning group or the component part
assignment you want to work on.
When it is a matter of add-on dimensions in groups, the possible assignments of
component part types and sizes, which can be dimensioned separately, are
displayed in the list. When it is a matter of production dimensions at single parts,
all selected detailings are displayed which can be dimensioned.
Dimensioning Area (2)
Here, you select the dimensioning area and the reference direction where the
component parts in question have to be dimensioned.
Area Selection
Global
Local
Global+Local
Global+Ignore
Ignore+Global
Ignore+Local
Alignment
According to Ref.
Horizontal
613
Detail Style
Sum Up Dimensions (8)
Here you select whether the component parts summed up in a common
dimensioning group have to be dimensioned together, too or whether a separate
dimensioning chain has to be created for each part.
Decrease Order of Precedence (3)
Click on this button to move the selected entry one place down. If a
dimensioning group has been selected here, the complete group will be
moved. Otherwise, the component part will be moved within the
dimensioning group.
If there are several dimensioning chains per page, the list order corresponds to
the order of the dimensioning chains in the drawing. Special dimensions will
always be added to the part at the end, even if they are placed at another
position.
Increase Order of Precedence (4)
Click on this button to move the selected entry one place up. If a
dimensioning group has been selected here, the complete group will be
moved. Otherwise, the component part will be moved within the
dimensioning group.
If there are several dimensioning chains per page, the list order corresponds to
the order of the dimensioning chains in the drawing. Special dimensions will
always be added to the part at the end, even if they are placed at another
position.
Linear/Radial Dimensioning Direction (5)
Here, you select whether you want to work on the settings for linear or radial
(bent) dimensioning chain. You work on the settings the symbol of which is
currently displayed.
Selection symbol for Linear / Radial
614
Detail Style
Normal/Aligned Dimensioning (7, single parts and groups)
Here, you select whether you want to work on the settings for normal or aligned
subpart dimensioning. Normal dimensioning is assigned to the global or to the
local area, depending on selection, and the aligned dimensioning is independent
of this. You work on the settings the symbol of which is currently displayed.
Selection symbol for Normal / Aligned
615
Detail Style
Adjustment Range
Longitudinal Direction (A)
Here, you determine the default settings for the position of the dimensioning
chain and the used reference points in horizontal dimensioning direction. The
values of the currently selected dimensioning chain are displayed.
Transversal Direction (B)
Here, you determine the default settings for the position of the dimensioning
chain and the used reference points in vertical dimensioning direction. The
values of the currently selected dimensioning chain are displayed.
The meaning of Horizontal and Vertical refers to the direction of the used
dimensioning area any may locally differ from main direction.
The offered possibilities of the different selection lists depend very much on the
part area and on the selected dimensioning group.
Settings
Reference Part (I)
If need be, you can give further information about the selected
part reference.
Pos. Dim. Chain (I) Position of the dimensioning chain with regard to the
component part or to the reference part
Pos. Dim. Chain (II) Here you can limit the display of the dimensioning chains to
certain main views of the component part (front view, plan
view, etc.) or to a certain position.
616
Detail Style
Coordinate Dims.
On the following two pages, you will find a table with the most frequent options
which are available in the selection lists. In addition, there is a short explanation
of the meaning.
The selected example refers to inputs for subpart dimensioning of shapes, you
can, however, transfer the information to the other component parts or
detailings. For an explanation of other special options, please refer to the
description of the corresponding dialog tabs.
617
Detail Style
Outer edges
Geometrical center
Drill holes
Each hole
All holes
First hole
Last hole
Reference point
Reference points
Front edge
Rear edge
Inner edge
Outer edge
Contact edge
Outer edge
Both edges
Inner + slope
Outer + slope
Arc center
Reference Connection
Standard
Reference point
Border Group
Beginning group
618
Detail Style
Connecting shape
Additional Dimensions
None
Group
Reference points
Outer edges of the group and reference points of the reference part
Reference points of the reference part and outer edges ref. part + group
Style Variants
No style variants
Side on which the component part is lying towards the reference part
Opposite side on which the component part is lying towards the reference
part
Always below
Always above
Regular
Favorable side
Unfavorable side
Front edge
Rear edge
Inner edge
Near edge in area direction seen from the center of the reference part
Outer edge
Far edge in area direction seen from the center of the reference part
Center
Like front edge, but alternatively in the outer area too if border position
Like rear edge, but alternatively in the outer area too if border position
Like inner edge, but alternatively in the outer area too if border position
Like outer edge, but alternatively in the outer area too if border position
Center + border
Like center, but alternatively in the outer area too if border position
619
Detail Style
Position of Dimensioning Chain (II)
In each view
Only if orthogonal
Only if diagonal
Only if perpendicular
Only if parallel
620
Detail Style
Adopt Primary Default Settings
When you want to use the same default settings as selection for primary and
secondary view, you can select in the secondary settings the option like
primary as component part reference. Any modifications in the primary settings
then will be valid for the secondary view, too.
Copy and Reset Functions
Since you can define up to 6 different dimensioning variants for a single list
entry, some auxiliary functions are available which can facilitate the setting task.
You have access to these functions by calling the context menu of the right
mouse key in the selection list of the selection range.
Copy Selection of Primary
The settings of the primary area for the currently selected group are copied into
the secondary area as far as longitudinal and transversal direction are
concerned. However, this is only valid for the currently selected dimensioning
area.
This function is reasonable when you want to modify only one value in the
secondary view compared with the primary view.
Deactivate Selected Group
The component part reference of the currently selected group is set to No
dimensioning for longitudinal and transversal direction for all views and all
dimensioning areas. For secondary views it is set to the option Like Primary.
Thus, you can easily deactivate dimensioning of component parts without
having to remove the whole group.
Deactivate All Groups
The component part reference of all existing groups is set to No dimensioning
for longitudinal and transversal direction for all views and all dimensioning
areas. For secondary views it is set to the option Like Primary. Thus, you can
easily deactivate complete parts of dimensioning without having to remove the
whole group.
The use of the deactivate functions in practice facilitates the optimization of
existing settings, because you can rapidly deactivate the entries without having
to look for them by means of the different selection possibilities.
621
Detail Style
Selected Group Standard Values
All settings of the currently selected group are reset to the internally specified
standard settings for longitudinal and transversal direction for all views and all
dimensioning areas. These correspond to the initial values at creation of the
corresponding dimensioning group.
All Groups Standard Values
All settings of all existing groups are reset to the internally specified standard
settings for longitudinal and transversal direction for all views and all
dimensioning areas. These correspond to the initial values at creation of the
corresponding dimensioning groups.
Create Complete Standard Default Setting
A complete, internally specified standard setting is created for the selected part
area of dimensioning. This setting contains the creation of dimensioning groups
to be selected including the component part assignments (as far as possible) as
well as the setting with standard default settings.
Please note that all existing dimensioning groups, component part assignments
and settings will be lost when this function is used!
The use of the standard settings functions in practice facilitates the building of
user-defined dimensioning structures, because it is always possible to return to
a clearly defined initial position in case of unsuccessful setting attempts.
622
Detail Style
Style Variants
The allocation of style variants permits you to design a more clearly structured
dimensioning. Outer dimensions can be emphasized with larger texts or different
dimension ranges can be colored. You could also use dimension chains with
tolerance specifications for hole dimensions or, in case you anticipate many
tight dimensions, you could also work with smaller text. There are many ways
to use this option to your advantage.
Definition and Assignment of Style Variants
One of the existing style variants can be assigned to each dimension chain,
independently for relative dimensioning and coordinate dimensioning. However,
it is selected as a combination for both types simultaneously via selection list.
A dimensioning style is assigned to a style variant in the general settings for
dimensioning so that you can read the proceedings on the corresponding dialog
tab. Compared with a direct selection of dimensioning style, the advantage of
the proceeding via style variant is that you can modify the dimensioning style for
several dimension chains together (e.g. after import of detailing style
parameters).
If you only want to modify the text sizes, you can also make use of the "auto"
setting, because here a style with smaller and bigger sizes (factor 0.7 or 1.4) will
be automatically created from the selected dimensioning style for standard size.
However, if you also want to modify the colors or select other text sizes, you
have to select a separate AutoCAD dimensioning style.
Combinations (Selection)
No Style Variant:
Always Variant 1:
STD / COO-1:
LIN-1 / STD:
LIN-1 / COO-2:
623
Detail Style
Individual Filter
The dialog tab consists of two essential areas:
On the left side you select the desired dimensioning group the settings of which
have to be modified. The dimensioning groups can also be managed via a
context menu.
On the right side you can specify the filter settings for the parameter record of
individual dimensioning.
624
Detail Style
Selection Area
Selection Tree (1)
Here you select the dimensioning group or component part assignment you
want to work on by clicking an entry.
The assignments of component part types and sizes forming an individual
independent filter group will be displayed.
Dimensioning Area (2)
Here you select the reference direction to which a limitation of alignment (e.g.
only perpendicular) refers.
Setting Area
Component Part and Parameter Filter (A)
Here you determine the default settings for component part and parameter filter.
The values of the currently selected dimensioning group will be displayed. You
can only exclude properties, i.e. if the function has not been generally activated
in the parameter record, the default setting doesnt have any effect here.
Settings
Part Reference (I)
Overall Length
Overall Width
Hole Labelling
Pos. Dim. Chain (I) Here you can limit the individual dimensioning to certain views
of the component part to be dimensioned.
Pos. Dim. Chain (II) Here you can limit the individual dimensioning to certain views
of the actual detail (front view, plan view, etc.) or to alignments
with regard to the reference part.
Filter
On the following page, you will find a table with the most frequent options which
are available in the selection lists. In addition, there is a short explanation of the
meaning.
625
Detail Style
No Detailings
No Dimension
Hole Labelling
Default Labelling
The drill holes are labelled according to the defaults settings for labelling.
No Labelling
Only Secondary
Primary+Secondary
Filter
No Filter
Each Part 1x
Parts having the same position number are only dimensioned 1x.
626
Detail Style
Tab Common
627
Detail Style
Kind of Dimensioning
Associative Dim.
With Optimization
Diameter on Line
> Hole Assignment If this field has been checked, a text is added to inform about
the assignment to position (top/bottom) for dimension chains
of drill holes which are divided according to depth position (Zdirection).
Gradient Reference Angle dimensions can be indicated as gradient instead of as
angle. Here you enter the reference value for calculating the
gradient.
Group Standard Dimensioning Style and Coordinate Style
628
Detail Style
Upper Selection List Here you can select the dimensioning style (AutoCAD) to be
used for the dimensioning in question. This style is going to
control all properties such as text colour, text size, etc. For
radii and angles the corresponding subordinate style of an
AutoCAD dimensioning style can additionally be used.
Variant 1 / 2 / 3
Coordinates
Coordinates Extra
629
Detail Style
> Distance
> Angles
Here you can enter the angle between the insertion point of
diameter labeling and the hole. The value 0 corresponds to
the main dimensioning direction. You can indicate positive
(rotating to the left) and negative values.
Common axis lines are displayed within the hole groups if the
Divide Hole Groups setting has been checked.
630
Detail Style
Divide Top/Bottom
The drill holes of upper and bottom side of the component part
are dimensioned in an individual dimension chain. The
assignment refers to the relative position towards view plane
(Z=0).
Oblong Holes
Here you can select how to dimension and label oblong holes.
You may choose between different combinations of hole axes
and hole lengths to dimension according to production.
For more detailed intormation please refer to the general
explanations with regard to oblong holes
New Dimensions to Here, you enter the distance from one hole group resp. drill
hole dimensioning to the other at which a new (redundant)
dimensioning has to be carried out. This permits a clearer
dimensioning of far away positioned identical hole screen
dimensions as the dimension chains resp. the indications of
diameters are repeated.
Group Holes in View
As Back Pitch
Here, you enter the text size for back pitch labeling.
> Distance
Here, you can indicate the distance of back pitch labeling from
the edge of the component part. Positive values signify a
labeling outside the component part, negative values signify a
labeling inside the component part.
Oblong Holes
Here you can select how to dimension and label oblong holes.
You may choose between different combinations of hole axes
and hole lengths to dimension according to production.
For more detailed intormation please refer to the general
explanations with regard to oblong holes
New Dimensions to Here, you enter the distance from one back pitch to the other
at which a new (redundant) dimensioning has to be carried
out. This permits a clearer dimensioning of far away
positioned identical back pitches as the indications are
repeated.
Oblong Holes
631
Detail Style
The horizontal dimensioning and labelling of oblong holes depends on the kind
of production. Four independent variants are available here beside the option
No Dimensioning (for manual dimensioning) and the option According to Hole
Type (not yet supported at the very moment):
Hole Axes
The hole axes are dimensioned and the hole
distance is indicated at labeling.
Hole Length
The outer edges are dimensioned and the hole
length is indicated at labeling.
632
Detail Style
Group Distances
Most data can be indicated here independently for horizontal,
vertical and inner dimensioning direction. The fields on the left
correspond to horizontal direction (main direction), the fields in
the middle correspond to vertical direction (transversal
direction), the fields on the right correspond to inner direction
(independent direction).
To 1st. Dim. Chain
Here, you enter the distances from the outer limit of the
st
component up to the 1 dimension line.
Between Dim. Chains Here, you enter the distance between the individual
dimension lines of an area succeeding the first line.
633
Detail Style
Construction Line to Component Here you enter the distance from the start of
construction lines up to the outer limit of the component or of
the dimensioning area in question.
Entering the value 0 will not cut the construction lines at the
edges but they are extended to the corresponding points to be
dimensioned.
If you selected Fixed Construction Line Length option, the
meaning of the fields changes, and you enter the length of the
dimension construction lines.
Construction Line to Dim. Chain Here you enter the distance of the construction
lines of a successive chain up to the previous dimension
chain.
Entering the value 0 will not cut the construction lines at the
previous dimension chains but they are extended to the outer
limit of the component or of the corresponding area to be
dimensioned.
Fixed Line Length
Edge Horizontal
Columns
634
Detail Style
General Miscellaneous
635
Detail Style
Hole group reference Selects how holes are dimensioned in main parts or sub
parts (only in the longitudinal direction) if the Hole group
reference option is selected there as well.
None The hole group reference is completely deactivated.
Connection profile The hole groups are assigned to the
intersection with the center axis or reference line (depending
on settings) of the appropriate connection profile.
First hole The hole groups are assigned to the first hole of
the hole group in the dimensioning direction.
Last hole The hole groups are assigned to the last hole of
the hole group in the dimensioning direction.
For further information see the general comments on hole
group reference.
Search area
Extends the system axis shown beyond the gusset plate edge.
With bevels
636
Detail Style
Hole Group Reference
Hole group in component parts, here mainly in component part groups, get
further reference dimensions in addition to the standard add-on dimensions of
subparts. In this example, a connecting butt strap is dimensioned with reference
to the holes.
Add-on Dimension in Component Part
Group (1)
The butt strap is dimensioned with
reference to the connecting shape, here
to its insertion reference point.
Hole Group Reference (2)
The connecting shape is selected for
hole group reference as well.
Alternative Possibility (3) (4)
Alternatively, the hole group reference
can also be made to the first hole (3) or
to the last hole (4).
The drill holes are always dimensioned with relative dimensions at hole group
reference, selection of coordinate dimensions, however, influences the
dimension of hole group reference (2).
Gusset-Plate Dimensioning
Drill holes in gusset-plates of component part groups can be dimensioned as
displayed in the example. In most cases, this dimensioning serves for drawing
control, if single part drawings are generated.
Longitudinal Direction (1)
Here, the reference point of dimensioning
is the edge of the plate. In addition, the
dimensioning chain is completed to the
system point (3).
Transversal Direction (2)
Here, the reference point of dimensioning
is the system point (3); however, a
reference to the edges of the plate is
possible as well.
The defaults are displayed as additional entry in the selection list for component
part types of group dimensioning and therefore can be attached in addition to
standard dimensioning of poly-plates.
637
Detail Style
Elevation Prefix
Distance RD
RD Symbol Size
No Inch Signs
End Condition
Diameter
Gage Dimension
638
Here, you enter the AutoCAD-colour number with which the text
of the gage dimension has to be displayed
Detail Style
Description
Mounting
639
Detail Style
Group Distances
Smallest Distance
Max.Snap Area
Group Diagonals
Angle Min./Max.
Here you enter the minimum and maximum angle the shape
must resp. is allowed to have towards main dimensioning
direction to be recognized as diagonal.
This option permits you to prevent that e.g. a roof girder is
dimensioned as diagonal.
Min. Length
Here, you enter the minimum length the shape must have to
be recognized as diagonal.
640
Detail Style
Only Above
The text is moved only above the neighboring text so that they
overlap horizontally, but not vertically.
The text is moved above and below the dimension line so that
they overlap horizontally, but not vertically.
Above Dim.Help Lines The text is moved across the construction help lines if it
does not fit in between above the dimension line (even if
otherwise not colliding with any other neighboring dimension).
No text between...
Move Outer Dimensions Outside The two outer dimensions are moved beside the
dimension line in horizontal direction.
Move Inner Dimension Horizontal The inner dimension texts are moved horizontally
across the construction help lines into a neighboring
dimension if there is enough place.
Adapt Text Size
Detail Style
> Postfix
The picture below shows the different optimization settings for texts in
dimension chains:
642
Detail Style
Group Distances
Min. Text Distance
In the field on the left you enter a value indicating how close
together dimension texts within a dimension chain may be
without triggering the collision alarm.
In the field on the right you enter a value indicating how close
together dimension texts may be at a neighboring dimension
when moved into this.
Thus, a movement can be avoided if there might be any
possibility of confusion of dimensions due to the small
distance.
Min. Dist. Between... Here, you enter a value indicating how close together
dimension texts of different dimension chains may be without
triggering the collision alarm.
Sum up
643
Detail Style
Tab SingleParts
Group General
Radius
Reference Point
644
Detail Style
Settings
Here, you select the treatments for which you want to attach single part
dimensions in the detail and determine the dimension points as well as the
position of dimension chains.
For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general
descriptions of defaults for dimensioning chains.
List of Dimensioning Groups
The following dimensioning groups can be added:
Modifications
Outer Contour
Inner Contour
Angle of intersection
Radius center
Special Dimensions
Reference Points
US-Cope
Part Groups
Fittings
645
Detail Style
Individual outside
Individual inside
Min / Max
Drill Holes
Common
Reference to Edge
The holes are dimensioned to the next edge of the component part
Hole Groups
Common + Edges
Angle of Intersection
Angle towards Vertical Line
The angle towards the imaginary vertical reference line (opening angle)
Bevel Symbol
The following examples show you the results of the different extended forms of
dimensioning for single parts:
Reference to Edge (1) and Individual Edges (2)
The holes are related perpendicularly to the following edge of the plate; the
edges of a plate are dimensioned individually.
646
Detail Style
Min/Max (1)
At a hollow shape, the maximum extension of the
interior wall (A) is dimensioned with the dimension
chain (C) and the minimum extension is
dimensioned with the dimension chains B. Possible
cut-outs havent any influence.
Min/Max (2)
At a standard shape the longest exterior area on
the upper and lower side is dimensioned with a
single measure at a time despite the cut-outs.
647
Detail Style
Group General
Equal Cope 1x
Remarks
Create Remarks
> Up/Below
> Start/End
> Type
Prefix
Postfix
648
Detail Style
Prefix
Postfix
Dimensioning of cut-outs according to this scheme is often used in the USA and
replaces a detailed dimensioning of outer contour for standard-shapes with
copes at the end.
649
Detail Style
Tab Groups
Group General
Main Part
Subparts
> Include Main part The position of the main part in a structural group is also
dimensioned as a sub part.
This option can be useful when dimensioning interlaced
structural groups (structural group with subgroups).
Section
650
Detail Style
Endplate
Reference Point
For Subgroups
651
Detail Style
Here, on the other hand, individual dimensioning for sub parts is selected for
sub parts (2) and the main part (1) is dimensioned close to the part. The
standard sub part dimensioning, which refers to the main part in the group, is
completely deactivated..
652
Detail Style
Settings
Here, you select the component parts for which you want to attach add-on
dimensions in the main views of the detail (front viw, plan view, etc.) and
determine the dimension points as well as the position of dimension chains.
For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general
description of defaults for dimensioning chains.
System Dimensions
Diagonal Dimensions
653
Detail Style
Special Forms of Dimensioning
Some additional dimensionings for diagonal shapes as well as system
dimensions may be added via special dimensions. System points here are the
points of intersection of the center axes of connected shape and reference
shape.
Diagonal Dimensions
Length
System distance
Distance of the end points to the system point which is situated next
System length
System Dimensions
On system position
The position of the dimension chains depends on the position towards the
axis of the main part
System dimensions of secondary position always get their own dim. chain
Reference to the system point of reference part and hole field direction
Plate edge
System Dimensions
Here you see the system
dimensions of connecting shapes
which are in primary (1) and
secondary (2) position to the main
part.
Separated dimesion chains have
been selected.
654
Detail Style
Settings
Here, you select the treatments for which you want to attach single part
dimensions in the tilt endplates of the detail and determine the dimension points
as well as the position of dimension chains.
For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general
description of defaults for dimensioning chains and to the default settings for
single part reference points.
655
Detail Style
Settings
Here, you select the component parts for which you want to attach add-on
dimensions in the section views of the detail and determine the dimension points
as well as the position of dimension chains.
For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general
description of defaults for dimensioning chains and to the default settings for
group reference points.
656
Detail Style
Settings
Here, you select the component parts for which you want to attach individual
single parts dimensions in the main views of the detail. You also determine
which fundamental dimensions have to appear in which views.
The fundamental settings with regard to dimensioning (position etc.) are globally
valid for all individual dimensionings together; however, you can individually
exclude certain component parts and dimension chains here.
For some settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general description of
the default settings for individual dimensioning.
657
Detail Style
Settings
Here, you select the treatments for which you want to attach individual single
part dimensions in the main views of the detail and determine the dimension
points as well as the position of dimension chains.
For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general
description of defaults for dimensioning chains and to the default settings for
single parts reference points.
658
Detail Style
Settings
Here, you select the subgroups for which you want to attach individual add-on
dimensions in the main views of the detail and determine which fundamental
dimensions have to appear in which views. Filtering is made via the main part of
the subgroup.
The fundamental settings with regard to dimensioning (position etc.) are globally
valid for all individual dimensionings together; however, you can individually
exclude certain component parts and dimension chains here.
For some settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general description of
the default settings for individual dimensioning.
659
Detail Style
Settings
Here, you select the add-on parts for which you want to attach individual add-on
dimensions in the main views of the detail (front view, plan view, etc.) and
determine the dimension points as well as the position of dimension chains.
For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general
description of defaults for dimensioning chains and to the default settings for
groups reference points.
660
Detail Style
Tab Assemblies
For Groups
661
Detail Style
Components of Structural Dimensioning
Assemblies are the most complex structure within ProSteel. Dimensioning
accordingly is rather extensive if you make use of all possibilities offered by
individual dimensioning.
All directly subordinate structures within the assembly are treated like one single
component part, i.e. a complete group is dimensioned on its maximum
dimensions. If you want to dimension the inner structure of such a group, use
individual dimensioning instead.
Since group dimensioning including possible subgroups requires a great number
of parameters, no separate independent parameter record will be available any
more in the part area assemblies. In this case, the program falls back on the
settings for groups.
The following picture shows the reduction to subordinate structures. You see the
complete assembly (1), the group (2) contained in the assembly and the
subgroup (3) which again is contained in the group.
662
Detail Style
If you now look on the different sharets of dimensioning, you will recognize very
well that the different areas are independent of each other. Since you can
globally deactivate complete areas, even complex structures can be clearly set
without losing track.
Basic Dimensioning
The group here is considered
as a whole and globally
dimensioned using the default
settings Reference Points.
Each individual dimensioning
of the assembly has been
deactivated.
Group Dimensioning
Here, the basic dimensioning
has been deactivated and the
individual dimensioning for
groups in assemblies has
been selected.
For groups the dimensioning
of subgroups contained in
these groups has been
deactivated.
Subgroup Dimensioning
Here, the basic dimensioning
has been deactivated and the
individual dimensioning for
groups in assemblies has
been selected.
There, however, all add-on
parts have been deactivated
and only the individual
dimensioning of subgroups
has been selected.
663
Detail Style
Settings
Here, you select the component parts or main and subgroups for which you
want to attach individual add-on dimensions in the main views of the detail (front
view, plan view, etc.) and determine the dimension points as well as the position
of dimension chains.
A complete group is dimensioned over its outer dimensions like a single
component part.
For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general
description of defaults for dimensioning chains and to the default settings for
groups reference points.
664
Detail Style
Settings
Here, you select the groups for which you want to attach individual add-on
dimensions in the main views of the detail and determine which fundamental
dimensions have to appear in which views. Filtering is made via the main part of
the group.
The groups can either be standard component part groups (these are groups
which themselves can contain subgroups) or they are explicitely named
subgroups on the same hierarchy level as the standard component part groups.
The fundamental settings with regard to dimensioning (position etc.) are globally
valid for all individual dimensionings together; however, you can individually
exclude certain component parts and dimension chains here.
For some settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general description of
defaults for individual dimensioning.
No separate independent parameter record is available for the individual
dimensioning in assemblies. In this case, the program falls back on the
parameters for groups or subgroups in component part groups.
If it is an individual dimensioning of single parts, the corresponding parameter
record for groups will be used as well.
Apart from a reduction of parameters a constant drawing view of component
part groups between (a) complete assemblies with individual dimensioning or (b)
individually displayed component part groups of this assembly will be
guaranteed by this assuming that both groups are using the same detailing
style.
665
Detail Style
Tab ConnectionNode
Settings
Here, you select the component parts for which you want to attach individual
single part dimensions in the main views of the detail and determine which
fundamental dimensions have to appear in which views.
The fundamental settings with regard to dimensioning (position etc.) are globally
valid for all individual dimensionings together; however, you can individually
exclude certain component parts and dimension chains here.
For some settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general description of
defaults for individual dimensioning.
The details of connection nodes mainly show the connection elements such as
endplates, webangles etc. of the connections. The involved main shapes are
only displayed as section.
Therefore, dimensioning is limited to an individual dimensioning of the involved
connection elements and of the final detailings of shapes.
666
Detail Style
Settings
Here, you select the treatments for which you want to attach individual single
part dimensions in the main views of the detail and determine the dimension
points and the position of dimension chains.
For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general
description of defaults for dimension chains as well as to the default settings for
single parts reference points.
667
Detail Style
Tab Views
Group General
Connect Dimensions Similar inner dimension chains which are situated close
together are connected to one common dimension chain each.
System Axis
Display Areas
668
Detail Style
Endplates vertical
End and base plates in vertical direction (height) are not taken
into consideration.
Poly-plates horizontal Poly-plates and stiffeners in horizontal direction are not taken
into consideration.
Poly-plates vertical Poly-plates and stiffeners in vertical direction are not taken
into consideration.
Counter Type horizontal
The shape type opposite to the view (i.e. at views the shapes
in cross-section display and at plan view the shapes in view
display) in horizontal direction is not taken into consideration.
Counter Type vertical
The shape type opposite to the view (i.e. at views the shapes
in cross-section display and at plan view the shapes in view
display) in vertical direction is not taken into consideration.
Group Dimensioning Areas
Dimensioning Area Here, you determine the principle method for component part
dimensioning in views.
Standard All shapes are dimensioned outside the view.
Only Outside Shapes which are situated in the defined
outside area are dimensioned outside the view. All other
shapes are not dimensioned.
Outside and Inside Shapes which are situated in the defined
outside area are dimensioned outside the view. Shapes which
are situated in the remaining inside area of the view are locally
dimensioned.
Outside and Area Analysis Local inside areas of the view
are automatically determined according to your defaults.
Shapes which are situated in the defined outside area are
dimensioned outside the view. Shapes which are situated in
the determined inside areas are locally dimensioned.
You can give additional information on a separate page of this
parameter group.
For more detailed information about inside and outside areas
of a view, please refer to the general explanations of local
areas in overviews.
Area Sizes
Here you enter the distances of left, right, lower and upper
side individually.
669
Detail Style
Here, you enter the size of the sections into which a local
inner area is additionally subdivided. Each section can contain
its own local dimension chains.
The size is an approximate value and can be bigger or smaller
in reality. If you enter the value 0, the areas are not subdivided
any more.
For more detailed information about inner and outer areas of a
view, please refer to the general explanations concerning local
areas in overviews.
670
Detail Style
Settings
Here, you select the component parts for which you want to attach overview
dimensions in the view and determine the dimension points as well as the
position of dimension chains.
For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general
description of defaults for dimensioning chains.
List of Dimensioning Groups
The following special dimensions may be added apart from the different
component part groups for shapes and poly-plates, as well as a general group
already described in the introduction:
Special Dimensions
Construction Axes
Diagonal Dimensions
671
Detail Style
Special Forms of Dimensioning
Dimensioning of overviews differs a bit from dimensioning of groups with regard
to possible reference points and position of dimension chains, especially if local
areas are used.
For the dimension points (target points), however, nearly the same possibilities
are available as at shapes in construction groups.
Reference Connection
Start View
Start Area
Edge View
Edge Area
Component Part
Extreme left resp. lower dimension point which is used (self reference)
Additional Dimensions
View
Construction Axes
Area
A little bit above resp. left of the geometrical center of the area
A little bit below resp. right of the geometrical center of the area
Top / Left
Bottom / Right
To Inside
Near area edge seen from the center of the overall view
To Outside
Far away area edge seen from the center of the overall view
Only if horizontal
Only if vertical
Only if orthogonal
Only if diagonal
672
Detail Style
In the following figure, you see a simple example for dimensioning a view
including construction axes display.
The first dimension chain from above
shows the dimensioning of the
shapes related to the construction
axes, the second dimension chain
shows the dimensioning of the
construction axes and the third
dimension
chain
shows
the
dimensioning of outer edge steel
(2600). The overall dimension (3000)
is measured over the outer axes.
Construction axes 1 and 3 could be
hidden in the settings for overviews.
In this case, they wouldnt be
dimensioned.
673
Detail Style
Settings
Here, you select the treatments for which you want to attach individual single
part dimensions in the anchor details and determine the dimension points as
well as the position of dimension chains.
For the essential settings on this dialog tab, please refer to the general
description of defaults for dimensioning chain and of defaults settings for single
part reference points.
Coordinate Dimensions
The coordinate dimensions refer to the absolute position
in the plan view (origin of axes dimensioning).
674
Detail Style
Here, you determine how to define the final local areas from
the analysis.
Main Direction Only the analysed main direction of
dimensioning is used to build an area.
Transversal Direction Only the analysed transversal
direction of dimensioning is used to build an area.
Overlay Single New areas are built by overlaying the areas
of the analysed main and transversal direction.
Overlay Groups New areas are built by overlaying the areas
of the analysed main and transversal direction. Then,
bordering areas are new combined.
Min. Count
Threshold (%)
Min. Length
Max. Distance
Max. Offset
675
Detail Style
Method of Analysis
The analysis of the local areas is made by cutting the whole view in thought in
several disks. These are limited by those shapes which visually appear as
continuous shapes.
The resulting imaginary shape lengths are classified according to their length
and starting with the longest class the number of direction-determining
shapes is compared until a clear majority is found. This determines the cutting
direction and thus (perpendicular to it) the main direction of dimensioning.
676
Detail Style
Now the possible sections are collected in analysis direction via pre-defined
minimum widths. The final area size is limited by the shapes which are running
transversally to the cutting direction. Finally, possibly existing bordering edges
are brought into line.
An overlaying permits to build new areas out of the intersection of main and
transversal direction. Here, too a collection and bringing into line can be made
(however only in cutting direction). Thus, empty areas (e.g. notches) are better
taken into consideration.
Unfortunately, there is no generally applicable solution with fixed parameters
which can be used for all kinds of constructions. Therefore, it is inevitable to
make some experiments with the parameters, especially in case of complexe
constructions, until a favourable division is reached.
677
Detail Style
Tab PositionFlags
Group General
Pos. Flags First
In Sections
No Cross-Sections
Plates in Views
Alignment
Here, you select the aligment of the position flags in the detail
drawing.
Horizontal all position flags are aligned horizontally.
Vertical all position flags are aligned vertically.
According to style all position flags are aligned as indicated
in the distribution style.
678
Detail Style
For loose Single Parts A position flag is attached to the component parts not
belonging to a group.
For Bolts
Pos.Flag Template Here, you select the template for automatic distribution of
position flags. The template controls what has to be displayed
in the individual position flags, how the flag is structured and
according to which criteria the distribution in the detail or in the
view is effected.
You create a distribution template in the positioning command
and only load it here.
Click on this button to move directly to the dialog tab for
setting the distribution templates. You can modify the
selected template or create new ones.
Please note that you have to save a modified template first
before the modifications become valid.
679
Detail Style
Tab WeldingSymbols
Group General
At End Plates
At Groups
Folded Plate
680
Detail Style
Group Sorting
You will find the meaning of the different settings in the description of distributing
position flags in the chapter about positioning.
Group Options
Group Flags
> Always Guideline For each flag for which a guideline is created; otherwise only
one guideline will be created altogether for the combined
flags.
Layer
681
Detail Style
Tab AdditionalText
Scale
> Prefix
Number
> Postfix
Here, you specify which text is still added to the number (if you
enter e.g. x, you will get 5x).
If you want to have an independant text for number 1, you
indicate the complete output separated by comma in front of
the postfix (e.g.SINGLE,x).
Shape Description
Shape Length
Material
682
Detail Style
Change Note
Position No.
> Prefix
Shipping No.
Remarks
Group Language
Standard
One Language
Two Languages
Text Scale
Here, you enter the text sizes for the position number, view
and scale text.
Text at Shape
Here, you enter the text size for the text label at shapes in
overviews.
Text Style
683
Detail Style
Only those axes are displayed which are situated within the
determined overall dimensions of the view including a snap
range.
Length (%)
Here, you enter the relative length of the axis line (in %)
related to the overall dimensions.
Normally, the axis line is running towards the outer edges of
the display (= 100%). If you enter a value bigger than 100, the
line will be extended over these edges. If you enter a value
between 1 and 100, the line will only partly be displayed from
the bottom resp. from the left, e.g. to hint only at it in views.
Text Distance
Here, you enter the distance of axes label towards the last
outer dimension chain.
Axis Display
684
Detail Style
Text specification
685
Detail Style
686
Detail Style
687
Detail Style
688
C.3
The detailing style assistant helps you to create new detailing styles by
requesting the key parameters in a step by step process. On the basis of an
internal default standard, the new detailing style is "mixed together" from various
rules and the individual style parameters are set according to these rules.
You benefit because you only have to make decisions regarding a small number
of parameters and a complex, ready-to-use detailing style is nevertheless
created. You are supported in this process by many help texts and illustrations,
which make the assistant extremely useful, especially for ProSteel beginners.
689
A restricted style has the advantage that you can only seldom change
parameters that have no impact on the detailing. Moreover, an assignment filter
is directly integrated, so that only suitable components can be assigned this
style.
Should you assign a group of profiles, stiffeners and 3D solids a detailing style
restricted to profiles, for example, only the profiles will be attributed this style.
Disadvantages
Restricted styles can no longer be assigned any other detailing type at a later
date (a group style cannot be assigned to a single part, for example) - which
tends to be an advantage in most cases.
You can transform a restricted style into a universal style retrospectively. You
must consider, however, that the parameters required for the other type were
not requested on creation of the style and therefore must be adapted manually.
690
Context-related content
Depending on the default settings on creation, some parameter pages can also
be deactivated after the creation of the style. If you have inputted in the
assistant that you do not want any dimensioning for the style, for instance, you
will find no pages with dimensioning parameters in the style.
However, since the style (whether restricted or not) would in theory support
dimensioning, in this case dimensioning is only deactivated. Should you
subsequently activate this function, the pages will be available once again.
This is where it differs from a restricted detailing style for manual detailing, for
example, where you can never activate dimensioning in the detailing style since
2D detailing does not support any dimensioning in this instance.
691
Procedure list
692
Here you can see which input page you are on and how many
pages are to follow.
On the first and last input page you have the option of loading and/or saving
your inputs as a ProSteel template. This gives you access to certain creation
standards at any time.
After completely going through steps you can transfer between pages at any
time, make corrections and then jump to the end again. Should the change
impact the procedure as of the modified page, you must go through all
subsequent steps again until the end of the process.
693
694
Hole dimensions
These are the holes in their top view (and in the side
view too, if necessary) for parts.
Additional dimensions
Total dimensions
Mounting dimensions
Connection dimensions
Elevation dimensions
Section dimensions
695
Straight
Secondary view
The pages below contain a list of the most important format types for the
dimension points in the various selection sets and components and/or model
views.
696
Edges individually
Edges merged
697
Hole groups
Edge reference
For the anchor details there are various selection options for the cluster
dimensions, each with different reference points.
Cluster dimensions
Object reference
Cluster dimensions
Column reference
Cluster dimensions
Grid axis
698
Total dimensions
Radian dimensions
699
Subgroups
700
Additional dimensions
Reference
Diagonals
Total dimensions
Radian dimensions
701
Connection dimensions
These dimensions are not available here.
Additional dimensions
Manual dim. points
Diagonals
Total dimensions
The dimensions are self-explanatory.
702
Assemblies
Reference axis
703
Additional dimensions
Axes
Levels
Overall dimension
The dimensions are self-explanatory.
704
Broken
Fixed length
705
706
DetailCenter Composer
C.4
DetailCenter Express
707
DetailCenter ComposerExpress
708
DetailCenter Composer
Starting Page
This page is always displayed first. Here, you will set which tasks have to be
done for you by the DetailCenter Express!
Prepare
Single Parts
Here, you can connect loose single parts and group parts with
detail styles.
Groups
Assemblies
Views
Here, you can connect views of work fields as well as plan and
top views and anchor plans with detail styles.
709
DetailCenter ComposerExpress
Detailing
Single Sheet
Here, you can insert detailed detail blocks into workshop plans
or activate the single sheet drawing output of details.
If single sheet drawing has been selected, the parts will be
detailed in any case. Detailing therefore has not to be
activated extra.
Clean Up
Here, you can set which corrections still have to be made after
end of detailing.
To give you an example: If you want to put out all stiffeners and plates as well
as the groups as DIN A-4 single sheet drawings, independent of already existing
style assignments, select the following entries on the starting page: Prepare
Detailing (to delete former assignments), Connect Single Parts with Detail Style,
Connect Groups with Detail Style and Insert Detail Blocks/Single Sheet
Drawings. There you will make the further settings.
Please note that the DetailCenter Express! always works off the complete
component parts list. The list is worked on as if you had transferred the
complete model for detailing.
Prepare Detailing
On this page, you will set which tasks have to be done before starting all further
steps.
710
DetailCenter Composer
Cancel Write Protection Any existing markings are cancelled. Thus you can be
sure that all component parts will be seized by the following
actions, if desired.
Delete
All detail styles, which have already been assigned before, will
be separated from the parts. Thus you can be sure that a
detail style will be assigned only to the component parts
selected in the DetailCenter Express!.
Reset
All modify flags set by the program will be reset to initialize the
model.
Delete links
Delete Blocks
If all fields on this page have been checked, your model drawing will be
completely initialized. It is the same as if a detailing never took place before.
Depending on the time of application of the DetailCenter Express! it is, however,
also reasonable to exclude some points.
711
DetailCenter ComposerExpress
Upper List
Left List
Here, you select the component part type you want to assign a
detail style to.
Right List
At style selection, you can differentiate between the detail styles currently
existing in the model drawing and the detail styles saved on the hard drive. If
you select a detail style from the hard drive (marked with a [HD:] put first, e.g.
[HD:] plates), it will be automatically loaded and it will replace the style possibly
existing in the drawing.
712
DetailCenter Composer
Upper List
As the assignment of detail styles corresponds to that for single parts, please
refer to Detail Style for Single Parts for more detailed information.
713
DetailCenter ComposerExpress
Upper List
As the assignment of detail styles corresponds to that for single parts, please
refer to Detail Style for Single Parts for more detailed information.
714
DetailCenter Composer
Upper List
As the assignment of detail styles corresponds to that for single parts, please
refer to Detail Style for Single Parts for more detailed information.
715
DetailCenter ComposerExpress
Part Family Single Part At the connection of single parts, the program first
uses the style of a part family assigned to this part. If there
isnt any part family assigned, or if this part family hasnt a
detail style of its own, the standard assignment will be used.
Part Family Group At the connection of groups and subgroups, the program first
uses the style of a part family assigned to this group. If there
isnt any part family assigned, or if this part family hasnt a
detail style of its own, the standard assignment will be used.
Assignment
716
DetailCenter Composer
Detailing
On this page, you make the default settings, how the component parts have to
be detailed. If you choose the automatic single sheet output, you dont have to
make any additional settings here.
Position once
Overwrite
Detail blocks of the same part existing in the detail library are
overwritten.
Left List
717
DetailCenter ComposerExpress
Component Parts Selection
The following details or components of a detail can be individually selected or
dropped:
Overviews
Assemblies
...main groups
...subgroups
...single parts
Groups
...main parts
...build. components
...subgroups
Other single parts
Connecting gusset
718
DetailCenter Composer
Insert Details
On this page, you make the default settings, how the worked out detail blocks
have to be inserted into the drawing.
In addition to the actual insertion task, the DetailCenter Express! also permits to
fill in the frame field of the drawing frame as well as to create a parts list. You
can select the drawing frame etc. on the following pages.
Single Sheet
> Scale
Arrange
Title Block
Belonging to
Parts List
719
DetailCenter ComposerExpress
720
DetailCenter Composer
Left List
For more detailed information about the drawing frames and how to prepare
them for the output of title block and parts lists, please refer to the chapter
Automatic Single Sheet Output further on in this manual.
721
DetailCenter ComposerExpress
In Assemblies
In Groups
Ascending
Separated
722
DetailCenter Composer
Arrangement
Failed Insertion
Increment X
Increment Y
Distance
723
DetailCenter ComposerExpress
No Scale
Different Frames
Alternative Frames
Scale File
Here you see the file on which the valid drawing scales are
based if you have selected the option Optimized Scale at
single sheet output. .
Here you see the file on which the valid drawing frame
definitions are based.
Here you see the file on which the valid definitions for US
mark numbering are based if you have selected the option
Use US Mark Numbering.
Output Path
You may modify the files and paths of the templates by clicking on the small
button on the right beside the corresponding display.
724
DetailCenter Composer
Selection Lists
Here, you choose the desired frame type for the output. Only
the borders defined in the sheet pattern file will be displayed.
It is always the set standard frame which will be used under
Drawing Frame unless there is an exception for the
corresponding detail at single sheet output.
At multi sheet output, you principally can only specify one
drawing frame.
725
DetailCenter ComposerExpress
Model Data
The order data for the frame field are transferred from the
drawing information table of the models. Otherwise, another
page will be displayed where you can specify the most
important order data.
Store Drawing Number The file name of the workshop drawing is identical with
the drawing number in the frame field. Otherwise, the current
position number is used at single sheet output or a describing
name at compilations.
Drawing Count
Here, you enter the page number for the drawing which has to
be created next.
User Variable
Here, you can enter any text you like which will be entered into
your drawing number, depending on whether you make use of
the corresponding variable or not.
Drawing Number Here, you can indicate another definition of the number if you
temporarily want to modify the default of your sheet pattern
file.
726
DetailCenter Composer
Drawing Name
Template
Sheet Number
The variables at drawing number and drawing name permit you a mixed
structure of fixed and current values.
Please refer to the chapter 'Automatic Single Sheet Output' for a description of
the templates for drawing number and drawing name and the used variables.
727
DetailCenter ComposerExpress
Input Fields
728
Here, you can enter the desired data. Then, they are inserted
into the frame field.
DetailCenter Composer
Clean Up Detailing
On this page, you make the default settings, which tasks have to be done after
end of detailing or style assignment.
Remove
All detail styles, which are not connected with a detail, will be
removed from the model drawing. Copies on the hard drive
are saved.
Delete views
Detail Blocks
Save
729
DetailCenter ComposerExpress
Scale File
If you selected the Optimized Scale option, the scale selection of the program is
based on the entries in the scale file.
You can thus create specific files for different customers and be sure that no
other scales will be used at the output. In the DetailCenter Express! you can
create specific defaults with different files for your customers.
The file is a text file having the extension .scl, which can also contain some
comments marked with a semicolon at the beginning of the line. The default file
is in the subordinate folder of your ProSteel installation.
730
DetailCenter Composer
You neednt fill in entries, which are not required, or the complete entry can be
omitted.
731
DetailCenter ComposerExpress
1) Header Area, Group Name [HEADER]
You enter a short name under the keyword Name (for later program options)
and a short file description under the keyword Description. The description will
then be displayed in the selection page of the DetailCenter Express!
2) Frame Field Attributes, Group Name [TITLEBLOCK]
Here, you specify which current program data will be transferred into which
block attribute of the frame field at running time. You can thus even specify your
own defined frame fields with your own attributes. For more detailed information
about how to assign block attributes to blocks, please refer to your AutoCADdocumentation.
You can assign block attributes to the following keywords. Depending on the
settings in the DetailCenter Express! these are filled with the current values
(Express) or with the drawing information of the model drawing. In addition, you
can connect some of the properties of the corresponding detail with block
attributes. This allows you e.g. to refrain from a position flag or detail labelling at
single parts and thus to obtain more space for display.
FileName
Customer
ProjectName
ProjectNumber
JobName
JobNumber
DrawingName
DrawingNumber
DrawingPage
DrawingIndex
DrawingScale
DoneBy
Date
CheckedBy
CheckedDate
ClearedBy
ClearedDate
Specification 1-4
Note 14
DetailPosNumber
DetailShipNumber
DetailName
DetailMaterial
DetailLength
DetailWeight
DetailCount
DetailNote
DetailFamilyClass
732
DetailCenter Composer
3) Drawing Number Definition, Group Name [DRAWINGNUMBER]
Here, you define according to which pattern the drawing number and the file
name of the drawing have to be structured. You can mix fixed and variable parts
and build the designations of variables as you like, (in order to avoid e.g.
identical names with used terms).
In the first two entries Drawing Number Template and Filename Template you
indicate the definition, consisting of fixed values and the variable symbols which
are mentioned in the following. You may use your own template for the file name
if your drawing number has to contain signs, which mustnt be used in a
Windows-file name. If you dont fill in the field 'Filename Template', the specified
drawing number will be used instead as file name.
Drawing Name Template
DrawingNumberTemplate
FileNameTemplate
ProjectNumberSymbol
JobNumberSymbol
DrawingNumberSymbol
DrawingPageSymbol
DrawingIndexSymbol
DwgNumberCodeSymbol
PositionNumberSymbol
GroupPositionNumberSymbol
ObjectNameSymbol
ObjectTypeSymbol
YearSymbol
MonthSymbol
DaySymbol
DrawingTypeSymbol
UserVarSymbol
DefaultObjectType
ColumnObjectType
BeamObjectType
StiffenerObjectType
WebAngleObjectType
StandardPlateObjectType
ConnectionPlateObjectType
BasePlateObjectType
MainPartDrawingType
SubPartDrawingType
GroupDrawingType
SinglePartDrawingType
OverviewDrawingType
733
DetailCenter ComposerExpress
If you want e.g. to obtain a drawing number containing your companys name
"ABC", the year, the drawing type "BG" for groups or "ET" for single parts as
well as the position number (each one separated by points, such as e.g.
ABC.2002.BG1000), you have to define the following fields. All other fields
dont have to be filled in.
DrawingNumberTemplate=ABC.#J#.#DWG##POS#
FileNameTemplate=ABC.#J#-#DWG##POS#
PositionNumberSymbol=#POS#
YearSymbol=#J#
DrawingTypeSymbol=#DWG#
MainPartDrawingType=ET
SubPartDrawingType=ET
GroupDrawingType=BG
SinglePartDrawingType=ET
As already mentioned before, you can define the designations of the variables,
as you like. Of course it is recommended to use special symbols there, too for
better identification or in order to avoid a wrong replacing of text. (#POS# instead
of only POS).
4) Frame Definitions, Group Name [NAME1], [NAME2] etc.
Here, you enter which drawing frames are used and specify the insertion areas
of details and parts lists. Each available frame obtains an own group. The group
names then will be displayed in the selection lists of the DetailCenter Express! .
Please note: The keywords Path, SizeX, SizeY, Area1 and Area2 have to be
assigned with current values; otherwise the frame will not be accepted for
selection.
Path
734
DetailCenter Composer
the name of parts list definition for the drawing parts list
scale of the drawing parts list
insertion point for the drawing parts list as 2D-point;
enter this point in the format (x, y).
ListHorizontalStart
description of the position of the parts lists insertion point in horizontal direction;
Enter left for left or right for right.
ListVerticalStart
description of the position of the parts lists insertion point in vertical direction;
Enter top for top or down for down.
The two entries describe the position of the point related to the list (on the left at
the top, etc.). The list is extended according to this default.
ListType
type of drawing parts list (allowed values: group, single, released)
ListGroupCount
the number of groups is used in the parts list
ListGroupMultiplayCount the number of pieces is multiplied with the number of groups
If you define your own frames, please note that the lower left point of the
drawing frame has the world coordinates (0, 0) and that you store the
drawing in top view on the frame. The positive X-axis is showing to the right,
the positive Y-axis to the top.
Enter the frame field as a block with the name of the drawing file (i.e. as block
'dina4', if the drawing frame has to be saved as 'dina4.dwg'.
735
DetailCenter ComposerExpress
The parameters used for multi sheet output are described in chapter
DetailCenter Composer.
736
DetailCenter Composer
Drawing List
At single sheet output, a drawing list is automatically created as text file (*.txt)
and as DBASE-file (*.dbf). The file is saved in the ProSteel detail folder under
the drawing name of the model.
You can see the position of the corresponding part and the file name of the
created drawing in this file. The drawing number, scale (and whether it is
suitable) and drawing frame are displayed as well. The data depend on the
selected type of single sheet output.
DetailCenter Express! drawing list
---------------------------------Output date: 13.09.2007
Output path: d:\ps18.0\detail
Output mode: Best scale
Job number:
Model drawing: e:\dwg\halle.dwg
1.) created group drawings
Pos |Scale |Max |Dwg-Number
|Dwg-File
====|======|====|=============|==========
100 |1:50 |Max |DWG-A3-Bl.7 |BG100.dwg
101 |1:50 |Max |DWG-A3-Bl.23 |BG101.dwg
103 |1:15 |
|DWG-A3-Bl.20 |BG103.dwg
104 |1:10 |
|DWG-A3-Bl.4 |BG104.dwg
105 |1:15 |
|DWG-A3-Bl.18 |BG105.dwg
2.) created single part drawings
Pos |Scale |Max |Dwg-Number
|Dwg-File
====|======|====|=============|==========
1
|1:50 |Max |DWG-A4-Bl.6 |Pos1.dwg
2
|1:50 |Max |DWG-A4-Bl.22 |Pos2.dwg
5
|1:10 |
|DWG-A4-Bl.3 |Pos5.dwg
6
|1:50 |Max |DWG-A4-Bl.17 |Pos6.dwg
7
|1:5
|
|DWG-A4-Bl.16 |Pos7.dwg
8
|1:10 |
|DWG-A4-Bl.14 |Pos8.dwg
12 |1:10 |
|DWG-A4-Bl.8 |Pos12.dwg
14 |1:5
|
|DWG-A4-Bl.1 |Pos14.dwg
15 |1:2.5 |
|DWG-A4-Bl.21 |Pos15.dwg
16 |1:2.5 |
|DWG-A4-Bl.2 |Pos16.dwg
737
DetailCenter ComposerExpress
738
DetailCenter Composer
C.5
DetailCenter Composer
739
DetailCenter ComposerComposer
740
DetailCenter Composer
On this starting page, you select in the selection list whether you want to use
DetailCenter Composer in manual or batch insertion mode.
In Manual Insertion Mode, you can define a specific insertion process that will
then be carried out. You can save the settings of this manual insertion as
template and use it again later in manual or batch insertion mode.
In Batch Insertion Mode, you can select one or more templates that will then be
carried out one after the other in DetailCenter Composer. You will find a more
detailed description of the different operation modes in the following chapters.
Below, you can see a typical batch page with several automatically inserted
details:
741
DetailCenter ComposerComposer
Save Templates
You can save all settings for insertion like in most ProSteel functions under a
file name in the templates management of DetailCenter Composer so that you
can use them again later.
742
DetailCenter Composer
Library
All detail blocks saved under the selected library are inserted.
Selection
Browser
Filter
In the following field, you can define a list of search filters that
are used for searching in the selected detail library. The found
detail blocks are inserted later.
Note: To be able to use the option Takeover Selection from Browser, you have
to select the detail blocks to be inserted before starting the DetailCenter
Composer. You should pay attention to the status of the Recursive button on
the insertion page in the DetailCenter.
743
DetailCenter ComposerComposer
Right Arrow
Click on this button to transfer the selected entry in the left list
to the right filter list.
Left Arrow
Click Twice
744
DetailCenter Composer
Define Filter
You can define the filters and store them as template on the insertion sheet in
the display options of the DetailCenter.
A possible filter selection may look as follows to filter out all straight shapes type
HE.
Then the filter can be saved under a certain name (e.g. HE-shapes) using the
template management. This name will be found later in the above-displayed
filter selection.
745
DetailCenter ComposerComposer
Insertion Options
After having defined which detail blocks have to be inserted, the next step is to
specify what has to be done in the drawing when the blocks are inserted.
Title Block
US Mark Number An US mark number is generated for each detail block which
later will be entered automatically as shipping number in the
model drawing.
746
DetailCenter Composer
Dispatch in Assemblies
A set of drawings is generated for each assembly. Detail
blocks not assigned to an assembly are not inserted.
Dispatch in Groups
A set of drawings is generated for each group. Detail blocks
not assigned to a group are not inserted.
Ascending
Separated
When you have selected the option Insert Separated by Single, Group, View,
the following options are available in addition as well.
747
DetailCenter ComposerComposer
Single Parts
The single parts are inserted separated from each other and
ascending by their position number in the following order:
- Shapes
- Poly-plates
- End and Base Plates
- Stiffeners
- Bent Shapes
- Other Component Parts
Groups
Views
At first, all above-mentioned part types are collected per type and then inserted
one after the other in ascending order each on a separate drawing sheet (or
more, if necessary).
748
DetailCenter Composer
Failed Insertion
Increment X
Increment Y
Distance
Arrangement
Note: The parameters specified here control the output accuracy; they can
however also have a considerable influence on the time needed for the insertion
process.
Failed Insertion
At a failed insertion, the detail block is inserted outside the drawing on the
coordinate (5000, -5000). The rest of the drawing remains empty.
749
DetailCenter ComposerComposer
Output Specifications
Certain parameter files control the following selection parameters for drawing
insertion.
The description of the files can to a large extent be found in the chapter
DetailCenter Express. In the following, we will only describe the parameters
necessary for DetailCenter Composer in the chapter Technical Details.
Scale File
Here, you see the file which gives rise to the drawing scales.
Border Frame File Here you see the file which gives rise to the drawing frame
definitions.
Mark Number File Here, you see the file which gives rise to the definitions for
the US mark number, if you have selected the option Use US
mark number.
Detail Output
You can modify the files and the paths of the specifications by clicking on the
small button on the right side of the corresponding display.
750
DetailCenter Composer
Drawing Frame
Scale
The scale that has to be the base for the output drawing file.
Do not Scale
Note: If you want to work with scaled (bigger or smaller) drawing frames or true
to life sizes, please take care that all detail blocks to be inserted here have the
same scale like the drawing. Otherwise, type sizes and symbol scaling (position
flags, labelling...) will not match together.
The best is to detail all detail blocks in a smaller size (1:xx) and to use the option
Do not Scale Frame. Then, everything will be ok.
751
DetailCenter ComposerComposer
Here, you can enter any text that will be inserted into your
drawing number, depending on whether the corresponding
variable is used.
Drawing Number Here, you can indicate another definition of the number if you
temporarily want to modify the specifications of the sheet
template file.
Drawing Name
Template
Next Page
752
DetailCenter Composer
Then, the indicated values are entered into the header of the drawing
corresponding to the sheet template file.
753
DetailCenter ComposerComposer
Finalising Works
Finally, you can specify whether you want to delete the detail blocks after
insertion.
Note: When the detail blocks are deleted here, the insertion information cannot
be transferred into the model and an automatic update of the 2D-drawing would
not be possible any more.
754
DetailCenter Composer
755
DetailCenter ComposerComposer
Edit Templates
You can also edit the existing templates in batch insertion mode by double
clicking.
756
DetailCenter Composer
Important Parameters
Area1
Area2
ExcludeArea 1-4 Drawing areas where detail blocks mustnt be inserted. Later,
these areas may e.g. contain parts lists, company stamps or
other information about the company.
The example shows the most important areas. In addition, the meaning of the
detail distance (dialog specification) is displayed as well.
757
DetailCenter ComposerComposer
Drawing Directory
At the output of collected sheets, a drawing directory is automatically created as
text file (*.txt) and as dBASE-file (*.dbf). The files are stored under the name of
the model in the detail directory. At the next output with DetailCenter Composer
both files are overwritten.
DetailCenter Insert Express! drawing list
---------------------------------Output date: 27.02.2006
Output path: C:\Programs\Bentley\ProSteel\R18.0\autocad 2008\detail
Job number: A23-5674F
1.) inserted drawings
Pos
|GroupPos |Name
|GroupName
|Scale
|DwgFile
========|=========|=====================|==============|=========|==========
01
|01
|IPE 400
|IPE 400
|1.000000 |C:\Program
02
|02
|RRK 250x150x8
|RRK 250x150x8 |1.000000 |C:\Program
03
|03
|RRK 250x150x8
|RRK 250x150x8 |1.000000 |C:\Program
.
.
2.) error report
Pos
|Info
========|=====
In this file, you can see position, group position, name and group name of the
corresponding component part as well as the file name of the created drawing
and the scale. If an error occurs during insertion, this will be indicated, too.
758
RevisionCenter
C.6
RevisionCenter
759
RevisionCenter
Documents
Documents, in the context of the RevisionCenter, are any outputs based on the
associated 3D model. The following are currently supported:
Detail blocks (details)
2D drawings (combination of inserted detail blocks)
Database for parts lists (create parts list)
Parts lists output (process parts list)
NC data file
PPS data file
If the relevant document is created, certain data is written to the model. The
document can then be opened from the RevisionCenter, re-generated, or sorted
and filtered based on its creation data (name, date, etc.).
Update documents
Since the components involved also form part of the creation data, when
components are changed you can immediately see which documents do not
match the current version of the model. These usually need to be updated, and
you can do this through the RevisionCenter.
The update can be done without versioning (if, for example, you are still at the
editing stage) or by issuing unique version numbers if the documents are
finalised.
Versioning documents
If you are working with document versions, you can open earlier, interim
versions of a document. Before the document is updated, the system creates a
copy of the old document file and creates a separate entry for it with creation
data.
This means that you can, at any point, view a workflow history and verify when
and where something was changed. You can, of course, open these interim
versions just as you can the current document.
760
RevisionCenter
Modifications
Modifications are any alteration that you make to a component after a document
has been created from that component. Unlike an earlier solution in which the
component was merely marked as changed, you can now record the detail of
when a component was altered by which action.
This gives you a tool that you can use to keep track of the intended (and
unintended) alterations made to your model.
Relationship to the creation data
The relationship between component and document results in the fact that a
modified component, like a document, can also be marked as changed. But
there is room here for the system to be more intelligent:
Since all the modification data is recorded, particularly the reason for the
modification, though moving a profile does indeed impact on the associated
group drawing, it has no effect on the drawing of the individual part.
Further into the future, this relationship will also mean that it is possible that, for
example, changing the material of a component only marks a parts list as
changed if the parts list also displays the material.
Data management
All the data about modifications is also recorded in the model, which of course
may result in very large volumes of data, depending on the scope. However, you
may also deactivate this option so that you identify changes less
comprehensively, as was the old style.
Important: Because parts lists, NC data, etc., is also now being managed,
the model also needs to be saved after any such output if you are using
the RevisionCenter. Otherwise you will lose data and there is no
guarantee that the RevisionCenter will continue to work correctly.
761
RevisionCenter
762
RevisionCenter
763
RevisionCenter
764
RevisionCenter
Version history
If there are older versions of a document, these are shown as subordinate to the
current version, unless filtered out. The documents can likewise be opened and
their creation dates viewed. However preview is not possible.
The example on the left shows a drawing which
has already been changed three times. On
creation each new document is version number
0, and each revision can be supplied with a
comment.
765
RevisionCenter
Dialogue commands
STRUCTURE (1)
Click on this button to open the dialogue for details of how the
components list is displayed. You can select the standard display or an
individualised structure, and set your own filters.
UPDATE (2)
Click on this button to start a search for the selected drawing or to analyse it.
You have to do this if you activate a different drawing in the MDI environment or
if you have modified the current drawing (e.g. issue of new documents).
INFO / PREVIEW (3)
Click on this button to switch the display of the document data.
You can choose between a simple list display with the creation dates or
a combined display which allows a rough preview of drawing
documents. The size of this preview graphic is automatically modified if
the height of the above list is changed.
766
RevisionCenter
Update document
If components have changed, it is usually necessary to update the relevant
documents. You have two options for doing this: Updating with and without a
new version number.
Updating without version number
To do this, select Update document in the popup menu. The content of the
document is updated, but no copy of the old versions is stored. One exception is
the internal component versions (see following section Component Overview),
which are changed.
Updating without version number may be used if you have already created a
new version and further revisions are necessary which do not require a separate
version (e.g. correcting errors, provided the document has not yet been
distributed).
Updating with version number
To do this, select Update document (with new version) in the popup menu. A
dialogue appears, for you to input another Comment on current revision.
This results first of all in a new version of the document being created (see also
under Create new document version) and then the content is completely
updated.
Display document
To do this, click on Open document in the popup menu and select the desired
document folder. The document is now opened in ProStructures or a suitable
program.
For certain types of document, e.g. PDF, you should however link the type of file
with an appropriate program.
767
RevisionCenter
Update document
If a component is changed, you can automatically update it on the drawing
documents which contain this component. To do this, select Update 2D-drawing
in the popup menu. The component is then reworked and replaced in the
documents.
Updating does not however result in an updating of the entire document. Only
the individual component is dealt with and there is also no new version of the
document.
Display document
To do this, select Open 2D-drawing in the popup menu. The drawing file that
contains the component is then opened. If you have inserted the component in
several drawings, you will receive a list of all the files to select from.
768
RevisionCenter
Imagine you have a change which applies equally to both components or else
more unfortunately just one of the components. Or one of the components has
been deleted or copied, that means the total number of parts is changed.
Both changed, both item numbers unchanged
In this case an update can take place, as nothing changes in the significance of
the correlations. Therefore this is simply a deficient updating of the document
(Updating conflict).
769
RevisionCenter
Both changed, both item numbers also new
This is also not a problem, as following updating the document will likewise
display the new item number. Therefore this is simply a deficient updating of the
document (Updating conflict).
One component changed, related item number remains same
Now you have an error in the positioning. This has nothing to do with document
management, but is likewise detected. First of all you have to correct the
positioning (Very severe conflict).
One component changed, related item number changed
The relationship of the documents will now lead to problems. Depending on
which component you have changed, you will receive different responses
(Severe conflict).
If you have changed the subordinate and therefore the not-inserted component
(B), then the updating will correctly detect the drawing for the inserted
component (A). However you now lack the new detailing for component (B).
If however you have changed the primary and therefore the inserted component
(A), then updating will amend the drawing to the changed status and show the
changed item as well. However, you lose the correlation to the formerly
subordinate component (B), which was also represented by the drawing and is
now missing.
Component deleted or copied
As the total number of components is not automatically updated, an incorrect
number of parts will be displayed in the updated documents where these are
shown (Severe conflict).
Identifying conflicts
As detection of conflicts can demand some time, especially for larger models,
detection does not take place automatically.
Use the UPDATE button to start an analysis of the model and reconciliation with
the internal creation dates of the components and documents. The conflicts are
then displayed in the list.
770
RevisionCenter
Displaying conflicts
Conflicts are basically identified individually for each item number. Under the
conflict entry you can find entries for all the components used in the model
these are known as error log entries. The colours and symbols immediately give
you information on the nature of the conflict.
Conflict symbols
The conflict summary differentiates between two key types of conflict, which are
also displayed in different colours:
Serious conflicts are identified with red symbols and mean that the document
will be faulty following updating. To deal with these first and foremost manual
intervention is necessary.
Updating conflicts are identified with grey symbols and mean that the
document is currently faulty, but will be corrected following updating.
The individual error log entries for each conflict
distinguish between the subordinate components (1)
and the components that create the document (2).
All data naturally relate only to the reconciliation with the 3D-model and the item
number shown in the conflict.
Description of conflict
Special significance is given to the display of creation dates in the conflict
overview. Here you have detailed information on the nature of the conflict and
possible solutions.
In particular comparison of item numbers and group structures on creation of the
document with the current status of the model are of major assistance when
correcting errors.
771
RevisionCenter
Resolving conflicts
As already mentioned, the conflict overview is primarily used for information, so
that you can take suitable activities. Many things cannot be dealt with
automatically or can arise owing to an application error (which it will at least
warn you of here).
Nevertheless the conflict overview does offer you two auxiliary functions:
Directly repair conflict
Updating conflicts which are repaired by simple updating of the document can
be dealt with directly. First select the conflict entry and then in the popup menu
Repair conflict.
The component concerned is then automatically updated in the document and
the conflict should disappear.
Change component features
If you want to view other component features or change the item number
manually because of an error, you can do this easily via the error log entries
(which represent one component in the model).
First select the error log entry and then in the popup menu PS properties. This
opens the dialogue for changing object properties in the model. You can find
more information on the object properties in the appropriate sections of this
manual.
All other problems must be dealt with using the functions and procedures
described elsewhere in this manual.
772
Cranked 2D-View
C.7
Cranked 2D-View
You can insert cranked views into the model if you require cuts and views
through your models that are not situated on one plane. During detailing, they
are treated like standard plane views; they show, different depths of the model
simultaneously in one view and allow hiding of unwanted or less interesting
areas.
Example for a cranked view (here only as view):
In the 2D-view, the supports A1, B1 and C2 are displayed.
Add Cut
After starting this function, you first have to click on the start of polyline
(intersection line) and then add the other points of the intersection line. Please
pay attention that the line doesn't intersect nor that it is running backwards. In
addition, the segments have to be perpendicular to each other. Otherwise, you
don't obtain a satisfactory result.
Terminate the entry by pressing the right mouse key if you do not want to add
any further points. Now, you are prompted to specify the direction and depth of
projection by clicking on another point (in relation to the start). All areas of the
component parts, which are intersected by the polyline, are later displayed as
cut all areas which are situated within the intersection depth, are displayed as
standard projection.
Then, the following dialog appears which is also opened in case of modification
of a cranked view via ProSteel properties.
773
Cranked 2D-View
Name:
Depth:
Height:
Here you specify the height of projection of the view. All areas
that are situated outside of this height are not displayed.
Colour:
3D-Display:
Display Depth:
774
North Symbol
C.8
North Symbol
This function allows you to add a benchmark to your model, which may be
evaluated later in different ways.
At the moment, US-benchmark-symbols are available to help with the assembly
of girders by indicating their alignment during installation. The point of the
compass, which indicates north, is situated at the left side of the symbol or
above if it is aligned horizontally (or at the upper end if it is aligned vertically).
775
North Symbol
Options:
Symbol:
Block:
776
North Symbol
Horizontal Alignment
Here, it is possible to select either the built-in symbols or external blocks. As the
proceeding is the same as already mentioned concerning the actual benchmark,
we don't repeat these settings here, but only describe the additional options.
Settings
The display for the alignment symbol for the points of the
compass is set here.
In the input field End Offset, you enter the distance between
the insertion point of the symbol and the left resp. lower end of
the shape.
In the input field Center distance, you enter the distance
between the insertion point of the symbol and the center of the
shape.
In the input field Colour, you enter the colour of the symbol as
AutoCAD-colour number.
Horizontal is valid for horizontal girders and vertical is valid for vertical girders.
777
North Symbol
Vertical Alignment
Settings
The display for the alignment symbol for the upper edge of the
component is set here.
In the input field End Offset, you enter the distance between
the insertion point of the symbol and the left lower edge of the
shape.
In the input field Offset, you enter the distance between the
insertion point of the symbol and the upper edge of the shape.
In the input field Colour, you enter the colour of the symbol as
AutoCAD-colour number.
User-defined Symbols
You have to define an AutoCAD-block in your model drawing or as external
drawing (wblock) containing the block attribute LABEL to apply user-defined
symbols. This attribute is filled with the current text for alignment.
778
North Symbol
Shape Labelling
Annotations:
DetailCenter:
779
North Symbol
780
C.9
Some steel constructions are very complex so that the system is not always
able to determine the suitable dimensioning automatically. Often it is even not
possible to find all suitable points because important reference dimensions such
as, weld check dimensions, or similar values have to be defined individually and
are not automatically known to the system.
For this purpose, you can define dimensioning points directly in the model for
the derivation of group drawings or overviews; the system has to be forced to
dimension them. In contrast to the subsequent manual dimensioning of 2D
workshop drawings, the advantage of this function is that they can be updated at
an automatic 2D-update.
Group General
View:
781
Only Points
Here, you specify the size to be used for depiction of the two
measured points.
Layer
Only in Plane
The picked points are projected onto the current view plane.
Thus, an object snap into the depth is avoided.
Loop
Group Options
Horizontal
Vertical
Direct
Baseline Dimensioning When you have seized a reference point with several
target points, each target point will get its own dimension
(starting from the reference point). Otherwise, reference point
and target points are created as continuous dimension chain.
In Groups
In Views
ECS-System
782
Dialog Commands
SINGLE
Click on this button to add a single dimensioning object consisting of
the start and target point.
You first have to click on the group this dimensioning object is to be
assigned to. Then, you click on the start and afterwards on the target
point of dimensioning.
SEVERAL
Click on this button to add a dimensioning object with a reference
point and several target points.
You first have to click on the group this dimensioning object is to be
assigned to. You then click on the base point of dimensioning and
afterwards the other dimension points. Pressing ESC key ends adding further
dimension points.
783
Selection of Views
In principle, dimensioning objects have to be assigned to a group or to an
assembly, even if the dimensions only appear in an overview drawing. At use in
nested group structures, they are always assigned to the lowest hierarchy and
controlled by means of their parameters at detailing.
If you pick e. g. the subordinate part of a subgroup which is part of a standard
component part group, the dimensions will only be displayed in the detailing of
the component part group, when manual dimensioning points have been
activated there for subgroups.
At the later detailing, the dimensions are only displayed in the view that
corresponds to a view at insertion (or to the opposite direction). Therefore, you
should insert a dimensioning object on a component part in the view in which
later you want to see the length to be dimensioned.
Hint: When the dimension doesnt appear in the desired view, it was probably
inserted in a wrong UCS plane and perhaps the dimensioning points were only
corrected later. You can check this by making display the coordinate system of
the dimensioning object. Its X/Y-pane has to be parallel towards the view plane.
If you want to see the length in two views that are not opposite to each other,
from view direction, you have to add the dimensioning object for a second time.
784
785
786
Global Scale
Like AutoCAD, ProSteel works in drawing units according to the scale less
method, a natural scale of 1:1 being assumed (i.e. a drawing unit corresponds to
one millimetre natural size).
Any detailing with respect to the 2D shop plans, however, is prepared in a scale
you entered beforehand. However, if you want to attach e.g. position flags later
that have been entered in the original size (mm) in the pre-settings you must
set a scale in order to ensure uniform sizes of these elements and a uniform
aspect of your drawings. This so-called Global Scale basically corresponds to
the later plot scale of your drawing.
When the program needs a scale and no special scale is entered, the global
scale will be adopted.
When using the command, the following prompt is displayed in the command
line
Previous ProSteel Scale = 1.0000
Please enter the new default scale 1: ?
The current scale is displayed. Now enter the new scaling factor to be used for
your work. When you enter e.g. the value 10, the default scale 1:10 will apply.
Do not confuse the global scale with the length scaling. The global scale refers
to the later printout of the drawings and scales text sizes, symbol sizes, etc.
787
Global Scale
788
Drawing Border
789
Drawing Border
Activate Limits
If this field is checked, the drawing limits are put on the edge
of the border to avoid drawing outside of the border.
Here, you load the selected entry and the drawing block into
the model area.
Here, you load the selected entry and the drawing block into
the paper area.
Creation of Entries
Select the main point and either press the right mouse button for the
subordinate menu or the button CREATE. The following dialog opens:
790
Drawing Border
Block Path
Width
Enter the width of the block if you want to work with active
limits. If the field Active Limits has been checked, these
values are preset as limits with the specified scale.
It is of course possible as well to specify different values for
the limits.
Height
Enter the height of the block if you want to work with active
limits. If the field Active Limits has been checked, these
values are preset as limits with the specified scale.
It is of course possible as well to specify different values for
the limits.
Comment
After these data have been inserted, a new subordinate entry is displayed in the
tree, which still has to be named. Then, the entry is created and can be used
immediately.
791
Drawing Border
792
Manual 2D-Cut
Label
Here, you enter the text without the cutting code that has to
be used as designation. Enter e.g. Cut.
Sign
Text Style
Layer
Line Type
Select the line type to be used for the depiction of the cutting
line.
793
Manual 2D-Cut
Detailing Style
Colour Symbol/Text In the input fields for Symbol and Text you enter the colour of
the cutting arrow and of the text. You can either specify the
colour directly by entering the AutoCAD colour number, or you
click on the desired input field and then on the SELECT
button. Then, the AutoCAD dialog for colour selection is
displayed where you can select the colour directly.
Text Size
Create Block
Complete Groups
Dialog-Commands
LINE
Click on this button to create a cut through component parts along a line
to be selected.
Select the parts to be depicted, then the cutting line. Then, you have to
indicate the depth of the cut. If you press ESC here, only a cut at the
corresponding position will be made. Otherwise, the parts will be cut at the
position and the projection of the rest will be displayed.
After having created the cut and after having attached the cutting code, you can
place the result anywhere you like.
OBJECT
Click on this button to create a cut on the base of a cut object. This may
be a view frame or an offset cut. You only have to select the object;
selection of the parts is carried out automatically.
UCS
Click on this button to create a cut of 3D component parts at the current
UCS. After selection of the parts, the cut is created at the XY-plane of
the current UCS.
794
Manual 2D-Cut
Position Flags
Apart from the actual cut display, it is also possible to attach position flags in
manual cuts. In addition, you can add component part information to 2D-lines to
enable the attachment of position flags at a later moment.
Position Flags
Template
Select the distribution template for the position flags which you
created before using the function for position flags.
Scale
Element Data
795
Manual 2D-Cut
Group Symbol
Symbol
Continued
The two partial lines are connected through the cut part.
By Side
Arrow Size
Distance/Length Here, you specify the distance of the cutting lines, from their
beginning to the utmost bordering edge (e.g. the
dimensioning), and what has to be the length.
Group Block
Block
796
Manual 2D-Cut
Block Path
Here you indicate the directory with the files containing the
block definitions for the cutting arrows. Select the directory via
the neighboring button.
Block Top
Here you select the block for the upper cutting arrow.
Block Bottom
Here you select the block for the lower cutting arrow.
797
Manual 2D-Cut
798
Manual Dimensioning
799
Manual Dimensioning
Group Settings
Alignment
800
Manual Dimensioning
Origin
Reference Point Here, you specify whether a reference part has to be used for
dimensioning. This is necessary to evaluate shape
shortenings correctly. However, the part has to be an
intelligent 2D part.
No A reference part is not used for dimensioning and all
lengths are evaluated in the measured length.
Default
With Angle
With Radius
801
Manual Dimensioning
New Scale
The scale used for converting the measured lengths and text
sizes depending on the settings for part scaling under Parts
Not
Here, you enter e.g. the value 10 if you have selected the
scale 1: 10 with object scaling at detailing. The details now
have been decreased by factor 10.
Shape Edges
Overall Dim.
Always positive
Display Zero
Display First
802
Manual Dimensioning
Display Last
Others
Info Window
Detailing Style
Here, you select the detailing style controlling the settings for
dimensioning style, optimization, etc.
At automatic part dimensioning, you also specify the points of
a part or of a group to be dimensioned in the detailing style.
Therefore, at identical detailing style the result of automatic
detailing and automatic part dimensioning are in no way
different.
Dialog-Commands
SINGLE PART
Click on this button to dimension a shape or any plate automatically. The
relevant points for dimensioning are determined according to the settings
in detailing style and the dimension chains are attached.
You have to click on the part to be dimensioned. If the Choose Position
option has been activated, you can place the created dimension chains at any
position you like.
For pre-selection of dimensioning direction, the option As Part is recommended
for most cases, you can, however, specify other directions as well.
GROUP
Click on this button to dimension a group automatically. The relevant
points for dimensioning are determined according to the settings in
detailing style and the dimension chains are attached.
You have to click on any part of the group you like. If the Choose Position
option has been activated, you can place the created dimension chains at any
position you like.
For pre-selection of dimensioning direction, the option As Part is recommended
for most cases, you can, however, specify other directions as well.
803
Manual Dimensioning
END PLATE
Click on this button to dimension an end plate automatically. The relevant
points for dimensioning are determined according to the settings in
detailing style and the dimension chains are attached.
You have to click on the end plate first and then the connecting shape (this is
the shape to which the end plate belongs). If the Choose Position option has
been activated, you can place the created dimension chains at any position you
like.
For pre-selection of dimensioning direction, the option As Part is recommended
for most cases, you can specify other directions as well.
INSERT DIMENSION
Click on this button to insert new dimensions in an existing dimension
chain. The other dimensions will be adapted.
Select all dimensions belonging to this chain. Then you have to pick a
dimension as reference dimension for the position of the dimension chain. If this
demand is only confirmed with RETURN, the first dimension of your previous
selection will be used.
Now the program filters the dimensions, which are not situated in a line with this
reference dimension. Dimensions of other dimension chains may also belong to
your selection (e.g. due to Crossing the selection).
Now, the dimension chain will be reconstructed and you can then insert the new
dimensions.
DELETE DIMENSION
Click on this button to delete a dimension from an existing dimension
chain. The other dimensions will be adapted.
Selection of the dimension chain and of dimensions is identical with the
dialog command INSERT DIMENSION it has not to be described once again.
MODIFY DIMENSION CHAIN
Click on this button to modify the style of a dimension chain, e.g. to
convert it from normal dimensions to coordinate dimensions or to modify
the detailing style.
Selection of the dimension chain and of dimensions is identical with the dialog
command INSERT DIMENSION; it does not have to be described once again.
804
Manual Dimensioning
SINGLE DIMENSION
Click on this button to attach a single dimension.
Linear Dim:
Arc Dimensions: Click on the centre of the arc first and then the starting point
and end of the arc (the end will be corrected correspondingly).
Afterwards, you pick the dimension line position.
An arc is principally looked on counter-clockwise from
beginning to end.
Angle Dim.:
Click on the vertex of the angle first and then the end of the
first and second side. After you pick the dimension line
position.
An angle is principally looked on counter-clockwise from
beginning to end.
DIMENSION CHAIN
Click on this button to attach a dimension chain out of several dimensions.
Click on the position of the dimension line first and then the points to be
dimensioned.
The dimensions are aligned according to the direction. Depending on the
settings for direction and part reference, you still have to click on a reference
line and/or a reference part. If you selected the option As Picked for the
direction, the first two dimension points determine the direction of the dimension
chain.
If you selected the option Continuing Dimension Chain, you are dimensioning
according to the AutoCAD-dimensioning function Continue. If this option has
not been activated, you continue indicating pairs of points for all dimensions
following the first one. You can obtain an interrupted dimension chain with
several dimensions.
FENCE CHAIN
Click on this button to create a fence chain dimensioning. The dimensions
are aligned according to the direction. Depending on the settings for
direction and part reference, you still have to click on a reference line
and/or a reference part.
805
Manual Dimensioning
806
Manual Dimensioning
Dimension Chains
During the acquisition of the measurement points the dimension chains are able
to capture the points correctly even if the dimensions have been indicated in a
different sequence or if the dimensions overlap.
The picture below illustrates the interconnections:
807
Manual Dimensioning
808
Manual Dimensioning
809
Manual Dimensioning
810
Elevation Flags
Elevation Flag
Layer
No Dynamic
Scale
Length Scaling
811
Elevation Flags
The distance in z-direction is indicated in the
elevation.
The distance in y-direction is indicated in the elevation.
The distance in x-direction is indicated in the elevation.
A symbol is created within a group, which will be output as
elevation at later detailing.
Click on the button representing the desired measurement and the elevation can
be inserted.
First click on the definition point (dimension point), then you can position the
elevation symbol (ORTHO is activated automatically) and finally, you position
the dimension text (ORTHO is deactivated again when it was in the OFFposition before the function was selected).
812
Elevation Flags
X, Y, Z-Coordinate Here you enter the coordinates of origin for Length (Y), Width
(X) and Height (Z) measurements. The picked points will then
be referenced to these coordinates.
Usually you enter the origin of the corresponding work frame.
The coordinates can also be defined in the drawing using the
mouse.
813
Elevation Flags
Elevation Depiction
Elevation Style
Use this box to select the style to be applied for the depiction.
Create Geometry
Block Geometry An AutoCAD block specifies the depiction of elevations. Any block
can be selected.
Block Path
In this field, you specify from which directory the blocks for
selecting the geometry of the elevations have to be read.
Bitmap
You can set an own bitmap for a style for easy recognition.
This bitmap then is displayed in the selection box as well.
Click on this button to save the current settings as style.
Click on this button to load a style for the elevations and thus
to use it again
Click on this button to modify the display of the elevation if
Create Geometry has been selected.
814
Elevation Flags
Geometry Definition
Line Type
Default Format
You can indicate a certain text format with a variable $(V) for
the measurement to the elevation. The variable then is
replaced by the current value.
Text Style
Note
815
Elevation Flags
Group Options
Guide Line
Dynamic
Bottom Side
Thousand sep
Group Sizes
Symbol Size
Text Size
After Decimal
Pre-Decimal
Group Colours
Colours
816
Use the fields Line and Text to set the corresponding colour
for the height object. -1 as value means that the presetting is
used.
Elevation Flags
In the following, you can see an example of different elevations:
817
Elevation Flags
Style Management
Your elevation styles are managed in this part of the dialog. New styles can be
created; existing styles can be loaded, updated or even deleted.
818
Weld Symbols
819
Weld Symbols
Weld Style
Layer
Thickness Top Side Here, you can overwrite the value of the welding
thickness of the style to create different thicknesses with
identical default settings.
Thickness Bottom Side Here, you can overwrite the value of the welding
thickness of the style to create different thicknesses with
identical default settings.
Scale
820
Weld Symbols
Create Group
Treat as one
If this option has been activated in the CAD system the group
is set on this selection mode.
With Welds
Gap
821
Weld Symbols
Weld Style
Use this box to select the style that has to be applied for the
display.
Created Geometry The depiction of weld symbols is defined in
this dialog by means of specified parameters.
Block Geometry
Block Path
In this field you specify the block path for selecting the
geometry of the weld symbols have to be read.
Bitmap
You can set your own bitmap for better recognition of the
style. This bitmap is displayed in the selection box as well.
Click this button to save the current settings as style.
Click this button to load a style for the weld symbols and to
use it again.
Click this button to specify the general settings of the weld
symbol or the weld seam.
822
Weld Symbols
Click this button to specify the special settings for the upper
side of the weld symbol (upper weld seam).
Click this button to specify the special settings for the lower
side of the weld symbol (lower weld seam).
Click this button to specify further settings for the evaluation in
the parts lists.
Line Type
Line Block
Text Style
Here you indicate the AutoCAD text style for the labels.
823
Weld Symbols
Options
Text Size
Symbol Size
Scale
Enter the scale for the data in the entry fields Text Size and
Symbol Size. When selecting this function, the default scale is
entered automatically.
Colour
Specify the colour numbers for the Line, the Symbol and for
the Text.
Thickness
Prefix
Length
Gap
824
Weld Symbols
Comment
Add. Length
Symbol
In this list, you can select the type of the weld seam (flat-flap
weld, HV weld, etc.).
Toward Position
Symmetrical
Material
Register
Weight/LU
Price/LU
825
Weld Symbols
Style Management
In this part of the dialog, your weld styles are managed. You can create new
styles, load styles, update or delete styles.
Press the above symbol to create a new weld style. The style
then will be stored as *.sty file with the default settings in the
directory for weld styles. Now you can work with this style on
all other pages of this dialog.
If you want to work with a special style which is not stored in
the drawing, but on your hard drive, you can load this style
using this function.
Select the corresponding *.sty file in the directory for weld
styles and load the file. The style will be available at once.
Use this function to remove a style, that is not required any
more, from your drawing.
Click this button to change the order of the display.
The order in the display of the style list is not sorted, but you
can sort yourself. Use the two arrow keys to scroll the
highlighted style up or down in the order.
826
Weld Symbols
Use this function to update the styles loaded in your drawing.
All styles in the drawing are replaced by the styles stored on
the hard drive.
827
Weld Symbols
828
Short 2D manually
Select this command and you will be first prompted for the shape to be
shortened which you have to click. Then you are prompted for the starting and
end point of the shortening, which you can either enter or pick. If you press the
ESC-key instead, the shortening is automatically determined and carried out, as
it is the case for detailing.
If you want to dimension the shape manually later, you can then consider the
shortening as well.
Note: In some cases it may be that the command doesnt work as it should. In
this case, check whether the drawing elements you want to treat are blocks
(which cannot be dissolved). You first have to dissolve these blocks before you
can go on.
829
Short 2D manually
830
2D-Cutout
C.18 2D-Cutout
Using this command, you can cut any 2D lines at a polyline at the same time.
After selecting the command, you have to pick the points of the polyline. The
same command functions are available as when drawing a polyline.
Then, all of the lines extending past the polyline are cut off at this line.
When you want to use this function to cut out intelligent ProSteel-2D-objects
(such as shapes after detailing), you first have to explode them into AutoCADlines. However, dont forget that after that the objects have lost their properties.
831
2D-Cutout
832
Automatic 2D-Cut
Hole Display
Block Path
The path where the blocks for hole display have been stored.
Bitmap
833
Automatic 2D-Cut
834
Automatic 2D-Cut
Min. Dm
Max. Dm
Visible
Hidden
835
Automatic 2D-Cut
Style Management
In this part of the dialog, your hole styles are maintained. You can create new
styles, load, update and delete styles.
836
Automatic 2D-Cut
Add Cut
After having loaded the function, you first have to select the shape, where a cut
is to be inserted. Then, you have to click a point on the cutting plane. The
cutting plane will always run through this point perpendicular to the center line.
Finally, you are asked for depth and direction of cut, which will be defined by
clicking on another point. On one hand, you indicate the view direction of the cut
and on the other hand, you determine its depth (this point will also be
perpendicular to the center line). The resulting cutting planes will be displayed
dynamically during selection for control reasons.
The depth of the cut decides how much of the components situated behind the
cutting plane is to be displayed.
837
Automatic 2D-Cut
Modification of Cut
Cuts can be modified or deleted from Shape Properties.
Here, you see the number of cuts existing in the shape as well
as the number of the current cut.
Active
If this field is checked, the cut will be taken into account during
detailing. It is possible to exclude a cut without having to
delete it.
Cut Depth
Alignment
Zone
838
Automatic 2D-Cut
Create Cut
839
Automatic 2D-Cut
840
Flatten Viewport
Name
Ident
Part Selection
Output
841
Flatten Viewport
After the 2D-output was created, all layers in the viewport are
switched off except the layers required for the depiction of 2Doutput.
Click on this button to add or remove component parts to/from
selection set for 2D-output.
Click on this button to carry out the calculation of the hidden
edges. This button is only visible after selection of a valid
detailing style.
Click on this button to delete again the drawing elements
which had been newly generated together with the creation of
the hidden edges. The layers in the viewport are switched on
again.
Here an example for output with automatic selection in paper area. The position
numbers were inserted into the drawing before in paper area.
842
Flatten Viewport
Detailing Style
843
Flatten Viewport
844
Miscellaneous
846
D.1
Here, you can enter your parts list data and then, this part will be recognized as
ProSteel component part.
You can modify this property using the properties command. You can use it at
positioning and in the parts list as well. However, a 2D-depiction cannot be
generated when no volume parts are contained.
847
These are two examples of possible special shapes. The left shape was drawn
as a cross-section and then stored as a special shape, the right one is a
combination of two U-shapes.
848
849
Here, you select the desired resolution. If resolutions have already been defined
for the special shape, you can modify the defined resolution using this method.
Definition of Cross-Section
Defining the closed and the not crossing contour of the cross-section normally
creates a special shape. Depending on the setting, this can be done using polylines or individual lines and arc segments.
Alternatively, you can define special shapes of regular wall thickness (e.g. cold
rolling shapes) by means of an open poly-line and by specifying the thickness.
See Settings.
850
After end of the geometrical definitions, now the property dialog for specifying
the parts list data will be displayed.
Enter the name of the parts list, notes, material,
etc.
Starting from the cross-section drawing and the
entered material data, the program calculates the
weight in kg/m and displays it in the entry field
Weight. You can determine which shape data will
be applied to the standard parts list. It is also
possible to change the calculated weight.
When you have defined a user-defined center, you
also specify here whether it is used to determine
the center line or whether the calculated center line
has to be used.
851
Settings
Selection Mode Here, you specify whether the contour selection has to be
effected via an existing poly-line or via selection of individual
segments.
Shape Thickness When you have selected an open poly-line, the contour will
be created along the poly-line with the indicated thickness.
The poly-line is the neutral fibre.
Shape System
852
Roof-Wall-Shapes
The creation of roof-wall-shapes is identical with the creation of general special
shapes. The only purpose for dividing them is to have a clearer survey and still
another feature of differentiation.
Combination Shapes
Combination shapes are not created using poly-lines or line elements. You have
to arrange the shapes in the WCS in the way they have to be built later for
definition. The best is to apply short shape pieces (e.g. with a length of 100 mm)
in the cross-section. Please note, however, that they mustnt be mirrored.
853
854
FILE=TEST.DBF
RESOLUTION=NORMAL;
THICKNESS=5.0;
STARTPOINT(x, y);
STARTPOINT(x, y)
INSERTPOINT(x, y)
RESOLUTION=END
RESOLUTION=LOW
RESOLUTION=END
For the description of the polygon segments, commands for lines and arcs are
at your disposal which can be described with relative or absolute coordinates.
LINEAR_TO(dx, dy)
LINEAR_AT(x, y)
ARC_TO(r, phi)
855
Normally, the special shape is described using one or more closed poly-lines.
However, an easier description can be selected for thin-wall-shapes (cold-rolled
shapes in most cases).
You can specify the wall thickness d by indicating the command THICKNESS=d
and only have to describe the neutral fibre (open polygon) of the cross-section.
The program then automatically calculates the required closed polygon.
Create Database (Shape Sizes)
In the database, a common DBASE-file, you only have to file the data records of
the different variables and some information about the parts list.
Field
Field Name
Field Type
KEY
Text
1
2
3
4
5
NAME
NOTE1
NOTE2
ITEM
MATERIAL
Text
Text
Text
Text
Text
6
7
8... n
WEIGHT
FIELD1
FIELD2 ... n
Double
Double
Double
856
Content
ProSteel-shape designation
(access key)
Shape name (display, parts list)
annotation field 1
annotation field 2
item number
Material index, not implemented
at the moment
weight per meter
value of the first variable ($1)
value of the next variable ($2...$n)
857
858
Act
From
Width
Height
Item
Material
Treat Parts..
Check Flats
Monitor Point
Here, you can define whether you want to see and modify the
insertion points of the current plate or whether you want to see
and modify the insertion points of the reference plate. The
current plate will be aligned correspondingly.
X-Pos
Y-Pos
Rotation
Insertion Point
Depending on the setting, you can see here the insertion point
of the current plate related to the reference point or the
selected reference point at the reference plate.
Relative to
Element
Pos
859
Top Flange
Bottom Flange
Web Plate
Treat Parts
Create Flange
If you dissolve such a shape and you have modified the web
in a way that the flanges have to be bent, they normally are
built like arc shapes. If this option is activated, straight flange
segments will be created.
Check Flats
860
861
Each number indicates a parameter the value of which is entered in the dialog.
By means of preview, you can control at any time how your shape has to look
like. Afterwards, the shape can be saved and the properties of the special shape
can be indicated.
862
BlockCenter
D.2
BlockCenter
863
BlockCenter
Navigation Dialog
In a tree structure, all existing block directories or groups are listed in navigation
dialog. You can either choose a display reflecting the directory structure of your
hard disk or a user-defined display. Sorting of the user-defined display can be
designed freely to a large extent and then saved as a template (see function >'Template'). In addition, you may set different display filters.
Navigation dialog is used when:
- The current block directory (or block group) is modified
- A directory is created or removed from hard disk
- Blocks are created
- The database structure is revised
- The sorting of the display is changed.
If a block group (e.g. system construction XYZ) has been selected, you also
could hide this dialog to gain more space for construction on your screen.
864
BlockCenter
Selection Dialog
In selection dialog, all blocks existing in the selected directory (or in the selected
block group) are listed. They are displayed together with the drawing name and
a preview. Of course it depends on the settings of sorting and filters in
navigation dialog which block drawings are finally offered for selection.
Selection dialog is used when:
- a block is inserted into a drawing
- an existing block is modified or deleted
- the search data (classification) of the block are entered or modified
The figures of preview are created by AutoCAD during saving of a drawing and
show this drawing including current zoom setting at the moment of saving. Apart
from scaling of size, you don't have any further influence on the display within
the BlockCenter.
Database
In contrast to other ProSteel-functions, where all required data are stored in the
drawing, BlockCenter is working with an additional database. The advantage of
this database is that the blocks, especially if there are a great number of blocks,
available at once after the function has been loaded. Neither a prolonged search
in the directories nor a query of drawing data is necessary any more. In addition,
user has a greater influence which drawings are integrated into the BlockCenter
and which ones are not integrated.
The database format was developed for the BlockCenter and permits fast
access to all data required for sorting and selection. The additional content of
the database (user-defined database fields) can be designed as you like. You
may decide yourself which data fields are used to classify your blocks for
selection and search and how they have to be named.
Different properties of the block drawing are already taken from the drawing
when a block is created (or even at a later time) and entered in previously
defined database fields. Some search criteria will be available at once. If these
fields are not required, they can of course be removed from the database.
865
BlockCenter
Creation
Select the option directory structure as display for the creation of a block. Now
check the directory where the block has to be stored in navigation dialog and
select the entry create block via context menu.
Select all components of the model which have to be adopted in the block and
pick the main insertion point of the block. Finally, you are asked for the
alignment of the block to allow insertion with correct alignment afterwards: When
you select ESC, the correct UCS will be used. Alternatively, it is possible to pick
a point on the later x-axis as well as a point on the x/y-plane.
Please note, however, that at later insertion the block will automatically always
be aligned in a way that the coordinate system pre-defined here is
corresponding with the current drawing UCS. It is however possible to define
alternative insertion points and alignments.
Now, a new drawing will be created and displayed containing the selected
component parts. This drawing can be modified further as you like: you can e.g.
add other ProSteel- and AutoCAD-elements or additional insertion points.
Hint: As long as this drawing has not been saved, it cannot be adopted into the
database. It is possible to cancel block creation.
It is not before the block drawing has been stored once which can also be
done when you quit this function that the block will be finally adopted into the
database and be displayed as preview in selection dialog.
Selection
Select an appropriate sorting in the settings and then check the desired block
group in navigation dialog by clicking on it. Depending on the setting, this may
either be a directory or any user-defined sorting criteria.
Within navigation dialog, you may scroll up and down the tree structure, as you
are accustomed to doing in Windows-Explorer.
866
BlockCenter
If you click on a new entry, selection dialog will be filled with small preview
figures as well as with the file names of available blocks. Only those blocks are
displayed, which have been adopted into the database and which meet the
possibly activated filter condition. There may be other drawings included in the
directory.
Select the desired block by clicking the preview figure in selection dialog. Above
the selection list, additional information on the selected block will be displayed
which can also be defined freely.
Modification
When you want to open an existing block for working or looking on it, select the
entry Edit block in the context menu after block selection.
The block drawing now is opened as new drawing that can be modified. If you
want to keep the modification, the drawing has of course to be stored.
Delete
Select the entry delete block in the context menu after block selection to remove
a block from the database. Now, you can determine whether you only want to
delete the entry in the database or also the complete drawing on your hard disk.
If you don't delete the drawing, it is possible to adopt it again into the database
at a later time.
Any additionally entered data of this block are of course lost because they have
been stored in the database and not in the drawing. Additional insertion points,
are kept, because they are stored in the drawing as visible objects.
867
BlockCenter
868
BlockCenter
869
BlockCenter
870
BlockCenter
Insertion points
here, you specify the ball diameter with which the additional
insertion points will be displayed.
Here, you can set the height of preview windows in the display
dialog.
Directory...
User...
ARROW RIGHT Click on this button to add a property field to the list. Then, a
dialog box will be opened where the existing database fields
are displayed. Select the desired field out of this list.
ARROW LEFT
Click on this button to remove the checked field from the list.
Display All
Incomplete
871
BlockCenter
Use Filter
Display Filter
User-defined Sorting
One important strength of the BlockCenter is the user-defined sorting according
to any user-defined criteria. Fur this purpose, you can define your own database
fields and fill them later with data of the corresponding block.
In the settings, you may now specify a hierarchy according to which the blocks
have to be displayed at a user-defined sorting. Here an example to make things
clear:
Let us assume that among others you created
database fields for the shape, for the whole pattern
and for the shear protection to classify prepared root
points and you indicate exactly these fields in this
order as sorting.
If you now switch over to user-defined sorting, the
tree-structure in the navigation dialog will be as
follows: the contents of the field 'shape' will be
displayed on top level, the contents of the field 'hole
pattern' will be displayed on the following level below,
and so on.
For each data input, e.g. in the field 'shape' (e.g.
HEA140 and HEA160) an entry will be created on the
same level in the tree-structure and blocks with
identical contents will be sorted there (analogously to
the directories and sub-directories on the hard disk).
This helps you to find out similar blocks at a great
number of blocks.
To avoid slightly differing entries for the same thing, all data existing for this field
will be displayed in a list at data input. Assignments can be made, too. This
helps you to avoid that once you enter e.g. HEA140 and once you enter
HE140A.
872
BlockCenter
Here, you see the field names of already defined data fields. If
you want to edit or to delete one of the fields, click on it for
selection.
Field Name
Here, you enter the field name of the new database field. Field
names always consist of capital letters (small letters will be
automatically transformed) and already existing names are
ignored.
It is useful to enter reasonable field names as these are
displayed in the selection dialogs for sorting and search. For
each field a description may be added as auxiliary text for the
other dialogs.
873
BlockCenter
Dialog Text
Here, you specify the labelling of the input field for field data in
the input dialog for block data.
Description
Display:
Group Data
Text Field
Integer
Floating Point
Floating Point (fix) Data are evaluated as float. If the imperial unit system is
used, the units will not be displayed in inch and foot (e.g. for
angles).
874
BlockCenter
875
BlockCenter
876
BlockCenter
Update of Database
Click on the entry Update database in the context menu of navigation dialog to
update an existing database. In this case, the program searches for drawing
files, which dont exist any more in the block directory, and removes them from
the database. At the same time, new drawing files and sub-directories will be
adopted into the database.
At update of the database, the entered data and modifications of data fields are
kept. You may define via pre-settings what has to be done with the standard
fields during update.
When the option 'Don't replace standard fields' was selected, no entries in the
standard fields will be modified, i.e. new drawings won't be examined either.
When the option 'Always replace standard fields' was selected, all drawings will
be searched for standard data and any possible modifications will be lost.
When the option 'Only replace blank standard fields' was selected, newly added
drawings will be examined, as their standard fields are still blank. All others
won't be taken into consideration.
When some standard fields were removed from the database, they won't be
restored during update. By means of update, it is, however, possible to make
sure that modifications in the block files will cause an update of the remaining
standard fields. The program assumes that deleted standard fields won't be
required any more.
Please note that each drawing in question has to be opened for update in order
to determine the drawing data. This process may require some time until it is
finished.
877
BlockCenter
Display Filter
Another strength of the BlockCenter is the display filter according to certain
search criteria. Before the blocks are displayed in the selected sorting, the
program first checks whether each single block meets the filter conditions on the
basis of its database entries.
For this purpose, logical links may be created between the existing data fields
and their contents. There is no limit concerning the complexity of the query.
Different filter combinations can be stored as templates and then defined as
activated filter in the settings for the sorting.
You may e.g. specify that only blocks having holes
will be displayed if they have 4 enforced holes.
Then, the neighbouring figure will show you the
result of filtering at a given sorting according to
shape, hole pattern and if they are enforced.
To be able to work reasonably with the filters, user
should have a certain mathematical understanding of
logically linked notions. It is very easy to create a
filter condition never producing any positive result at
all in combination with the existing data a
corresponding check doesn't take place.
Boolean operators
Simple queries only consist of one comparing condition such as e.g. whole
pattern = 4. It is, however, the logical link between several comparing
conditions, which is really interesting.
Therefore, you may specify a logical operator by means of which the next
inserted comparing condition shall be linked with the existing condition. To
facilitate input, previous pairs are automatically put into brackets, in case of a
change of the operator. It is possible to create search queries such as (A AND
B) OR (A AND C) in an easy way. A, B and C here are variables of simple
comparing conditions of data field, operator and content.
An existing term can be manually put into brackets, too, if the condition is not in
pairs. The following condition serves as example: ((A AND B) OR C) AND D.
878
BlockCenter
Define Filter
To define a filter term click on the entry Edit display filter in the context menu of
navigation dialog. The following dialog box will be opened:
Display fields
> Left
> Operator
> Right
879
BlockCenter
After all three components of a comparing condition were preset; you can add
this condition to the complete filter condition by clicking on the INSERT button.
Depending on the existing conditions and selected logical links, appropriate
brackets are set by the program.
Group Filter Condition
Display field
OPERATOR OR
Click on this button to select the logical operator OR as logical link for the
following comparing condition.
BRACKET
Click on this button to force the program to put the existing filter
conditions into brackets manually.
Brackets are always necessary when the complete result of a (partial)
condition has to be linked with another, as the combination of (A AND B) OR C
is different to A AND (B OR C).
INSERT
Click on this button to add the current comparing condition to the
complete filter condition.
880
BlockCenter
DELETE
Click on this button to delete the comparing condition, which was added
last.
DELETE ALL
Click on this button to delete the complete filter condition.
881
BlockCenter
882
Roof/Wall Panels
D.3
Roof/Wall Panels
This command allows you to divide any surface with roof-wall shapes and
display them in colour. You choose orientation and grid spacing. The program
then determines necessary cut-outs in the shapes.
You can work with all shapes, including special shapes and plates. Layout is
done on the active UCS plane. It is recommended to use a top view of the UCS
plane.
Surface Layout
To divide a wall surface by means of front shapes, outer bordering of the
surface as well as possible inner cuts have to exist as poly-lines first.
After having loaded the function, click the Outer Poly-Line of the Surface first
and then the direction determining line for alignment. Now, pick the Origin of
Division and the following dialog appears for further specifications:
883
Roof/Wall Panels
Max. Length
Here, you are prompted to indicate the grid length (i.e. the
lengths of the shapes to be installed).
Grid Width
Here, you are prompted to indicate the grid width. If the grid
width exceeds the shape width, the layout will show gaps - if
the grid width is smaller, you will have overlaps. In the
neighbouring input field, the shape width of the currently
selected shape is displayed (see Shapes tab).
Depth
Here, you enter the distance between layout and active UCS
plane. By entering positive values, you move the surface
along the positive Z-axis of UCS.
Offset Top
Here, you enter a projection of the shape over the grid length
at the upper end. If you enter a positive value, the shape is
shortened and a gap is shown. If you enter a negative value,
the shape is extended and overlaps with he next grid element.
Offset Bottom
Here, you enter a projection of the shape over the grid length
at the lower end. If you enter a positive value, the shape is
shortened and a gap is shown. If you enter a negative value,
the shape is extended and overlaps with the previous grid
element.
Offset Side
Dynamic
Cut
Offset
Here you enter how grid lines are moved against each other in
longitudinal direction. No offset means that they are not
moved.
Centered offset means that they are moved in a way that a
new line begins in the middle of the previous line (laid brick
pattern).
Dimensions mean that the lines are offset against each other
by a value you entered in the neighbouring input field.
884
Roof/Wall Panels
Colour Normal
Select a colour for all shapes not being cut by entering the
AutoCAD colour code. The colour can also be selected by
clicking the BUTTON which is situated at the right.
Colour Cut
Original Colour
Shape Selection
Choose the component parts to be used for installation on the second page.
Shapes
Plates
If the Use Poly-Plates field is checked, a rectangular polyplate is used as installation element instead of a shape.
You can determine the dimensions in the Plate Width and
Plate Thickness input fields, the length corresponds to the
Grid Length corrected by the offset value.
You can specify a name for the plate in the selection list. If the
Grid field is checked, a plate grid (e.g. for a grating at the
installation of stage coverings) is created for being displayed.
885
Roof/Wall Panels
Poly-Cuts
You can enter additional cut outs into a surface at which the shapes have to be
cut as well. In order to do this, the poly-lines of the cut outs are required which
can, however, still be drawn when the function is activated.
Poly-Cuts
Here, you can see the number of additional cut outs existing at
the moment.
By clicking this button, you can insert a cut out into the
division. Click the poly-line of the cut out in order to do so.
If the poly-line doesnt yet exist, you can draw it directly before
loading this option.
By clicking this button, you can delete the currently selected
cut out and close the surface at this position.
If you have several cut outs in the division, you can select the
required cut out by pressing << and >>.
886
Roof/Wall Panels
Here the example of a gable wall automatically lined with wall facing elements.
The dark surfaces show the elements that do not have to be cut out; the light
surfaces have to be cut out. In addition, 2 openings have been inserted.
887
Roof/Wall Panels
888
D.4
889
Group Distances
Spacing
Front Offset
Here you enter the distance from shape start to the first
insertion point.
End Offset
Here you enter the distance from last insertion point to the end
of the shape.
890
Insertion Rules
Hole Dia.
Slot Length
Group Options
Shape Center
Create Marks..
Lower
No Detailing
Insert Blocks
Create Group
In Part List
In Bolt List
Group Dimensions
Dia
Bolt diameter
Length
Bolt length
891
Bottom Dia
Bottom
Top Dia.
Top Length
Bolt Dia.
Bolt Length
Group Others
Name
List
Here you see two examples for the distribution of welded bolts on shapes:
892
The options concerning the distribution are identical with the distribution of
thread bolts. So you can refer to this chapter for more detailed information.
Hole Dia Sign
You can specify a code for the drill holes to be created. This
code serves for selection of special NC-programs being able
to recognize this code.
Block path
List
893
Data Base
Seize Parts
894
NAME
BLOCKPATH
HOLEDESCRI
HOLEDM
HOLELENGTH
LENGTH
DM
FOOTDM
FOOTHEIGHT
HEADDM
HEADHEIGHT
NIPPELDM
NIPPELLENG
895
896
D.5
Auxiliary Tools
D.5.1
Collision Check
Min. Volume
Display Scaling
Actual/Max.
897
898
Options
During collision check, you can specify which component parts have to be
checked against each other. A filter is available for the selection of the parts to
be checked.
Shapes
Plates
Bolts
Bodies
Highest Resolution
The component parts are temporarily switched over to highest
possible resolution for collision check.
Mounting Area
899
D.5.2
Center of Gravity
Use this function to calculate the center of gravity of any parts. Select the parts
in question and the calculation is started. A ball in the model and numerically in
the dialog line visually displays the result.
There, you obtain information about the defined volume, the exact coordinates
of the center of gravity (in world coordinates) as well as the total weight of the
parts.
Please note that, in contrast to previous versions than Release 18, different
specific weights are taken into consideration.
900
Resolution Max. Indicate the resolution of the unfolding. The higher the
indicated value, the more detailed is the scan of the
component searching for any possible outlets or notches. The
greatest acceptable value is 360.
Use ACIS
Inner Contour
901
Tessellation L.
Bend Line
Create Tessel.
Tessellation L.
Creating Development
After you have exited the dialog, you have to click the shape that is to be
unwound or developed. The desired operation is then supplied sticking to the
crosshairs. Position it freely anywhere in the model and process it further if
desired.
If you have selected Inner Contour, both developments are sticking to the
crosshairs in the form of two properly positioned blocks. Position them anywhere
in the model and then process them individually.
902
D.5.4
Move Objects
Use this function to simulate moving of any parts along a line, poly-line or spline.
This can be applied for visualizations or to check whether parts can be
assembled. The objects are moved along a guideline in a set speed. In addition,
you can choose whether you only want to move the parts or whether they have
to be rotated as well.
Resolution
Enter here into how many equal parts the guide line has to be
divided. The higher the value, the more regular and the more
fluent the simulated movement will be.
Delay
Move and..
The objects are not only moved along the guide line, but also
rotated around this line. This means, if you have a sharp
bend in the line, the parts will be rotated along this bend.
After clicking the OK button, seize the guide line first. This may be a line, polyline, spline or an arc. Then seize the parts and the simulation starts.
903
D.5.5
Create ACIS-DWG
Batch Processing
To avoid having to process each drawing individually, batch processing is
available if you have many drawings. All drawings of a directory are processed
automatically and the converted drawings are saved in another directory.
Source Directory Enter the directory containing the drawings you want to have
converted automatically.
Target Directory Enter the directory where you want to save all converted
drawings. The target directory mustnt be identical with the
source directory nor must it be beneath the source directory.
Purge Drawing
Recursive
Groups
Each component part group is converted as common ACISbody. Otherwise, each component part of the group is
converted individually.
904
Resolution
Delete
Keep Layer
905
D.5.6
Batch Processing
To avoid having to process each drawing individually, batch processing is
available if you have many drawings. All drawings of a directory are processed
automatically and the converted drawings are saved in another directory.
Source Directory Enter the directory containing the drawings you want to have
converted automatically.
Target Directory Enter the directory where you want to save all converted
drawings. The target directory mustnt be identical with the
source directory nor must it be beneath the source directory.
Purge Drawing
Recursive
906
907
D.5.7
908
D.6
Analysis display allows you to control and to work on the effective static analysis
lines of the shapes to get an optimum output for translation to static analysis
programs. From the individual interfaces, you can force the output of analysis
display. The effective lines defined by you will be output instead of the center
lines of the shapes.
If no modifications were made here, the effective lines correspond to center
lines. This function offers you, the possibility to modify the effective lines
independently of the insertion of a shape to balance e.g. eccentricities, if these
have no importance for calculation or to close open nodes.
Effective Lines
After loading the function, you first have to select the objects that are to be
switched to analysis display. Having made this selection, you only see an
individual line of each shape, representing the effective static analysis line. The
different colours within the line help you to recognize whether the end is
connected with another shape (representing a node) or whether it is open (e.g. a
cantilever).
If the end is open and not a cantilever, then you are dealing with eccentric
shapes in most cases and you could create a closed system by means of this
function.
It is possible to modify the effective lines manually by using the offered options
of this function or by modifying them via AutoCAD grips.
909
Check colours...: If this field is checked, the colours of the represented shape
ends will be verified automatically, every time the function is
loaded. See button ->'Update colours'
Check connect...: If this field is checked, the different parts will be verified
automatically whether they are connected with each other or
not, every time the function is loaded. Display is adapted
accordingly.
Hide ...
Shorten offsets: If this field is checked, the cantilevered ends at a node will
be shortened, so that there will be no offsets.
You can specify the maximum possible offset in the
corresponding input field Max. Offset. All values larger than
the actual value e.g. a cantilever and will not be taken into
account.
When this button is clicked, the program tries to connect the
effective static analysis lines automatically to create a closed
system. If the effective lines are situated in a common plane,
they are extended to each other and a node is symbolically
represented as a ball. At the same time, the ends adopt the
same colour as the center part of the line to display a closed
connection. Please note, that the penetrating lines are not
divided at the nodes. You can force this division later during
export.
When this button is clicked, the program verifies whether a
connection to neighbouring parts or an open end exists. The
represented colour will be modified accordingly. Red
signifies that there is an open end and green means that this
end is connected with a neighbouring part.
The difference between this function and the function
'Automatic' is, that here the program only checks and the
display is updated where as the function 'Automatic' tries to
create a connection and when doing this can also modify the
effective line.
910
Start X,Y,Z
End X,Y,Z:
911
Manual input:
912
Data Exchange
D.7
D.7.1
Data Exchange
General Information about Data Exchange
It is possible to send and receive data to and from other programs via the import
and export interfaces of ProSteel. In most cases, these are 3D-constructions of
other CAD-programs or the static analysis systems of programs for static
analysis calculations.
The exchange takes place via a special file format defined by independent
standard committees like e.g. Deutscher Stahlbauverband DSTV (German
Association of Steel Construction) or even by the program manufacturers
themselves. The data to be exchanged are mostly saved as ASCII-text file;
therefore they are independent of the used operating systems. In case of
possible transfer problems they can be adapted with any text editor you like.
Additionally to the "acknowledged" formats, ProSteel also has its own exchange
format based on a clear text file. This format exactly describes the positioning
and detailing of component parts, group structure and parts list or part
information.
913
Data Exchange
914
Data Exchange
915
Data Exchange
Here, you select the shape type. When the input field Material
has been checked, this previous type selection is not
available.
916
Data Exchange
Replace as
Enter a new designation and insert it into the list. The program
doesnt differentiate capitalization or the use of small initial
letters.
Since exchange designations can only be inserted, you have
to insert the new entry first and then delete the old one, if you
only want to modify an entry.
INSERT
DELETE
DELIVERY
Shapes
Material
All
Ready
Open
Group Others
File
Content
Add Names
917
Data Exchange
Dialog-Commands
LOAD
By clicking this button, you can load an exchange list. It is also possible to
import an exchange list in dBASE-format by selecting the file type in the
file selection dialog, which opens then.
dBASE-import is not available when you select the dialog via the interface
dialogs.
STORE
By clicking this button, you can store the current exchange list. It is
possible to export an exchange list in dBASE-format by selecting the file
type in the file selection dialog, which opens then.
dBASE-export is not available when you select the dialog via the interface
dialog.
NEW
By clicking this button, a new exchange list is created based on the shape
and material database of ProSteel.
Thus, you obtain all available internal names and you can add the desired
exchange designations to them.
If the field Add Exchange Designation at New/Update has been checked, the
exchange designations of the shape database are entered, too.
UPDATE
By clicking this button, new entries based on the shape or material
database of ProSteel are added to the current exchange list.
918
Data Exchange
919
Data Exchange
Content
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7... n
line type, (F) group line (S) shape entry (M) material entry
shape type when shape group or "Material" when material group
ProSteel shape file (when material group: no entry necessary)
Internal ProSteel designation metric
Internal ProSteel designation imperial (for material like field 3)
exchange designation (1st list entry, is also export name)
if need be, further exchange designation (2nd list entry)
if need be, further exchange designations (next list entries)
TYPE
FAMILY
FILE
METRIC
IMPERIAL
EXCHANGE
IMPORT1
IMPORT2 ... n
(shape file)
(shape type)
Type designation (e.g. DIN_HEA); the different sizes are the shape
entries up to the next group line.
920
Data Exchange
Control Field
Options
921
Data Exchange
In the following chapters, you will find a description of the different interfaces
and of their property pages. In most cases, the corresponding manufacturers or
standard committees can obtain a description of the interface formats.
Dialog Commands
CONTINUE (OK)
By clicking this button, import or export will be continued, if the selected
interface command is waiting for further specifications or if the process has
been stopped for your information.
LIST
By clicking this button, you can select an existing exchange list for import
or export.
PROCESS
By clicking this button, you can process an existing exchange list for
import or export or select another list.
FILE
If you click this button, the read or created interface file will be displayed if
it is an ASCII-text file.
ERROR REPORT
By clicking this button, you can view an error report, if it is created by the
selected interface command. In this error report, you are e.g. informed
whether errors have occurred in a read file or whether certain data cannot
be evaluated by ProSteel.
922
Data Exchange
Import Data
When this function is loaded, a file selection dialog opens where you can select
the required interface under File Type. Then, you select the file to be imported.
Depending on the interface, an interface dialog opens where you can make
further specifications concerning the data to be imported.
After file selection resp. after confirmation of import process in the dialog, the
data are evaluated and the ProSteel model is created. Depending on the
complexity of the interface and on the volume of the data, this process may take
some time. You are, however, informed about the current state in the AutoCADcommand line or in the interface dialog. After the creation of the model has been
finished, a note box will be displayed.
Working Areas
A working area can be created automatically to allow you to work with the basic
views of the imported model immediately. A rectangular working area will be
created approximately describing the outer dimensions of the model (only the
end points of the shape axes are considered at the calculation).
This is an ideal starting point for the control of the imported model resp. for the
creation of further views.
923
Data Exchange
Unknown Designations
As the data in the exchange formats mostly are the used shapes and plates, it is
recommended to provide all existing shape databases correctly. You should do
this above all if you import constructions containing foreign shape series. In
most cases, the interface formats only transfer one shape name as reference;
the actual information on the geometry of the cross-section comes from the
importing program.
ProSteel supports so-called exchange lists to cope with the different
designations. The imported name is translated into a valid ProSteel shape and
the selection of substitute cross-sections is made possible.
If the name does not exist, the shape is considered to be unknown. A dialog
appears where you can assign a ProSteel shape to the unknown shape.
Unknown
ProSteel
here, you enter the access code or you select the shape from
a list by clicking SELECTION button. The shape type (e.g.
HEA) is displayed first at selection. After having selected the
shape type, you can select the required shape from the
existing shape sizes by double-clicking the entry.
Permanent
924
Data Exchange
General Settings
If the interface dialog is available in the selected import format, it can also
contain a page for General Settings apart from the specific pages. This page is
identical for all interfaces and permits settings for the import process. Depending
on the implementation degree of the interface, it is possible that certain fields
are not activated.
Error Report
Working Area
> Name
Here, you can indicate the name of the working area. If it still
exists, the new views obtain the index "2".
Connect
Data Exchange
> Max. Distance Here, you enter the maximum distance, which is allowed for
the end points to be connected to be recognized as
continuous shape.
> Tolerance Value Here, you enter a tolerance for possible deviations of the
gusset coordinates.
This is reasonable when you import data of static analysis programs as these
are generating a system of bars from gusset to gusset (e.g. plate connection)
although in reality it is a continuous shape.
Connecting Shapes
The static program transfers this system as 4 bars of 1-2, 2-3, 4-2 and 5-2. Four
shapes are created first which are connected in the way that there will be one
remaining shape of 1-3 and one of 4-5.
Supposed the fact that bars of 1-2, 2-3, 4-4a and 5-5a were transferred, the bars
4-4a and 5-5a would only be connected to a shape if the distance of 4a to 5a
was smaller than indicated in Max. Distance input field.
926
Data Exchange
Conversion
If the interface dialog is available in the selected import format, it can also
contain a page for Conversion apart from the specific pages. This page is
identical for all interfaces and permits settings for the import process. Depending
on the implementation degree of the interface, it is possible that certain fields
are not activated.
Query
Import-Table
Here, you see the file name of the currently used exchange
list.
927
Data Exchange
Export Data
When this function is loaded, you first have to select the parts to be exported in
the model and a file selection dialog opens and you can select the required
interface under the option File Type. Then, you select the file to be exported.
Depending on the interface, an interface dialog opens where you can make
further specifications concerning the format.
After file selection resp. after confirmation of export process in the dialog, the
model data are evaluated and the data record is created. Depending on the
complexity of the interface and on the volume of the data, this process may take
some time. You are, however, informed about the current state in the AutoCADcommand line or in the interface dialog. After the creation of the file has been
finished, a note box will be displayed.
928
Data Exchange
General Settings
If the interface dialog is available in the selected export format, it can also
contain a page for General Settings apart from the specific pages. This page is
identical for all interfaces and permits settings for the export process. Depending
on the implementation degree of the interface, it is possible that certain fields
are not activated.
Error Report
Nodes
> Protection
> Max. Distance Here, you enter the maximum distance, which is allowed for
the end point of a shape towards the continuous shape to be
recognized as shape to be divided.
929
Data Exchange
Here, you enter the minimum length of the bar, which has to
be created by the division. If this length is smaller, a division
will not be made and eccentricities will be determined instead.
This is reasonable when you export data to static analysis programs as these
are expecting a system of bars from gusset to gusset (e.g. plate connections)
although in reality it is a continuous shape. As ProSteel of course cannot be as
specialized as a static program, you can switch off this option by this way, if the
static program offers better functions for this purpose.
Analysis
Dividing Shapes
The ProSteel model has the shapes of 1-2, 3-4 and 5-6. The shape of 1-2 is
divided first into two parts of 1-6a and 6a-2.
Another division of the new created shape 1-6a and two other parts 1-4a and
4a-6a is made, if the resulting two bars have at least the same length as
indicated in Min. Bar Length input field.
930
Data Exchange
Conversion
If the interface dialog is available in the selected export format, it can also
contain a page for Conversion apart from the specific pages. This page is
identical for all interfaces and permits settings for the export process. Depending
on the implementation degree of the interface, it is possible that certain fields
are not activated.
Always Flat Steel It is always a flat steel shape, which is exported even if the
type has not been defined as flat steel in the database.
If Unknown
Always Poly-Plate Each flat steel shape is exported as poly-plate (metal sheet).
Query
931
Data Exchange
Export-Table
932
Here, you see the file name of the currently used exchange
list.
Data Exchange
D.7.6
There is a direct data interface to the analysis program for static analysis
calculations RSTAB of Messrs. Ing.-Software Dlubal GmbH which works without
explicit exchange file. The prerequisite is that ProSteel and RSTAB have been
installed and started on the same machine.
Apart from the transfer of the system and of the cross-sections, this exchange
supports a better adaptation of the system to the requirements of static
calculation with RSTAB as well as an intelligent modification mechanism. Only
the corrected cross-sections or insertion points of existing bars/shapes are
transferred so that already assigned data in the other software are kept.
After having selected the command, you obtain a list of the interfaces supporting
the direct exchange. Select the entry 'Dlubal RSTAB' and the dialog for data
export with an RSTAB-extension will be displayed. Since the data exchange is
based on an extension of the Product Interface Steel Construction, please refer
to the corresponding chapters there for further information.
After the transfer was started, RSTAB will automatically report data import. For
more detailed information, please refer to your RSTAB-documentation.
If you want to work with the modification mechanism, dont forget to save your
model after data export because information is stored in the drawing database.
Import in ProSteel
When you receive RSTAB data, ProSteel will automatically report the data
import.
If you want to work with the modification mechanism, the corresponding
ProSteel model has of course to be open before. On an additional dialog page
for RSTAB data import you can select which modifications have to be
transferred to your ProSteel model.
933
Data Exchange
D.7.7
New Interfaces
In this chapter, you will find a description of the interface dialogs and
implementation degrees of the different interfaces. Please note, however, that
this is the state at printing of the manual and that your current ProSteel version
can have been extended in the meantime. Please refer to the up-dated hints o n
your installation-CD.
As the implementation degree of import and export can differ from each other,
these areas are treated separately at each interface description. These are data
which can be interpreted or written by ProSteel at the very moment the import
exchange file might however contain further data which could be read at a later
moment.
Due to their data structure, most of the interfaces support this selective reading
of data. Load data of static programs can e.g. be assigned to an element, the
position in the space as well. If the load data cannot be evaluated, this doesnt
have any influence on the interpretation of position.
934
Data Exchange
935
Data Exchange
This page shows the entries of the exchange file header and doesnt accept any
further settings. You can only interrupt the import process if it isnt the required
file.
Group Others
Ignore
936
Data Exchange
Group Format-Selection
CAD
Static Analysis
Data Export
ProSteel is able to export the CAD-system data for standard shapes and plates,
however without detailing processes and connection elements. A plate made out
of a number of polygons is exported correctly. If different detailing processes
created it, only the basic polygon will be output.
In addition, the static system for standard shapes can be written. Depending on
the settings on the General Settings page, it is tried to determine intermediate
gussets for connections and eccentricities.
After file selection, you can enter the header area specifications in the appearing
interface dialog.
Click on the OK button of the dialog box to continue the export. The model is
analysed and the export data record is prepared according to your settings on
the Option page. The data then are written in the selected file by once again
clicking the OK button.
937
Data Exchange
Output File:
You can see the selected output file as this name is entered in
the exchange file.
Input Field
Here, you enter the variable header area data or the part code
(authorization).
The authorization is entered in the header area and builds
together with a time mark the code for the origin resp. the
modification of a component part.
CAD / Static
Mixed
A file of CAD and static data is written. The CAD data are
preferred and the static data describe the static system of
these CAD data.
This is an option for a later implementation degree.
938
Data Exchange
939
Data Exchange
Group Others
Bolts
Processing
Sum up
Groups and single parts having the same position number are
summed up to one entry and the corresponding number of
pieces is indicated.
In this case, the exported geometry and drawing data can only
partly be used because they only refer to the first part
acquired by chance. This option is, however, reasonable for
the evaluation of parts list data because it can help to
minimize the data record considerably.
Here, you enter the accuracy for all values except for the
coordinate points. It is always the complete number of digital
places which is exported, if need be they are filled up with
noughts.
Coordinates
Inches
940
Data Exchange
Data Import
All model data including detailing processes, structures and component part
references (logical links) are entered which are necessary for the assembly of a
complete ProSteel model.
Afterwards, the model can be detailed with the same functionality as if it was
created in the importing system.
Data Export
ProSteel can export the 3D-model data including any detailing processes,
structures and component part references (logical links).
This means that all data necessary for the assembly of a complete ProSteel
model in another ProSteel target system will be sent.
Afterwards, this can be detailed with the same functionality as if it had been
created there.
941
Data Exchange
STAAD III-Interface
The STAAD III interface serves for the exchange of static systems between the
programs of STAAD program family and ProSteel. Data can also be exchanged
with any kind of software being able to interpret this format.
File Format: ASCII text file with the extension *.std
The exchange format corresponds to the output file of the graphic editor of this
program family.
Data Import
ProSteel is able to evaluate the static system data for standard shapes, i.e. the
position of the parts in the space including eccentricities. Please note that it is
not possible to interpret all shortened display forms like REPEAT etc. in the data
format of the exchange file. The list shortenings of the form n TO m are,
however, understood.
Data Export
ProSteel is able to export the static analysis system for standard shapes.
Depending on the settings on the page General Settings, it is tried to determine
even intermediate gussets for connections and eccentricities.
942
Data Exchange
STAAD.PRO Interface
The STAAD.PRO interface serves for the exchange of static systems between
the programs ProSteel and STAAD.PRO. Data can also be exchanged with any
kind of software being able to interpret this format.
File Format: ASCII text file with the extension *.std
The exchange format corresponds to the output file of the graphic editor of this
program family.
Data Import
ProSteel is able to evaluate the static system data for standard shapes (from the
single shape table in STAADPRO), i.e. the position of the parts in the space
including eccentricities. Please note that it is not possible to support plates/sheet
metal plates and shapes with double cross-sections, back/back cross-sections
and weld shapes in this version.
Data Export
ProSteel is able to export the static analysis system for standard shapes.
Depending on the settings on the page General Settings it is tried to determine
even intermediate gussets for connections and eccentricities.
943
Data Exchange
PXF-Interface
The PXF interface serves for the exchange of constructions between the
programs of REBIS program family and ProSteel. Data can also be exchanged
with any kind of software being able to interpret this format.
File Format: ASCII text file with the extension *.pxf
Data Import
ProSteel can evaluate the data group 4000 for standard shapes, i.e. the position
of the parts in the space. In addition, general data groups and coordinates that
are necessary for transfer are evaluated.
Data Export
ProSteel is able to export the data group 4000 for standard shapes. In addition,
general data groups and coordinates that are necessary for transfer are
exported.
944
Data Exchange
SDNF-Interface
The SDNF interface (Steel Detailing Neutral Format) serves for the exchange of
CAD-data between programs being able to interpret this format. A static analysis
system can of course also be transferred via the shape position.
File Format: ASCII text file with the extension *.sdf
Data Import
ProSteel is able to evaluate the CAD-system data for standard shapes and
plates, i.e. the position of the parts in the space without detailing processes and
connection elements. Plates, the contours of which are transferred as polygons
are displayed correctly. If cuts or similar things created the shape, this
information would be lost and only the mostly rectangular basic solid would be
displayed.
Data Export
ProSteel is able to export the CAD-system data for standard shapes and plates
without detailing processes and connection elements. A plate made out of a
number of polygons is exported correctly. If detailing processes created it, only
the basic polygon will be output.
In addition, the static analysis system for standard shapes can be written.
Depending on the settings on the General Settings page, it has tried to
determine intermediate gussets for connections and eccentricities.
945
Data Exchange
Input Fields
Units
Here, you can choose the units for the output of length and
coordinate values.
In combination with a suitable exchange list it is thus possible
to create a file with imperial units from a metric drawing file or
vice versa.
Degree of Implementation
The implementation corresponds to standard SDNF-3.0; the following elements
are supported in exchange:
Packet 00
Packet 10
Packet 20
Packet 22
Packet 60
946
Data Exchange
KISS-Interface
The KISS interface (Keep It Simple Steel) provides for the exchange of parts list
data between programs, which are able to interpret this format. Therefore, only
export is possible here.
File Format: ASCII text file with the extension *.kss
Data Export
ProSteel is able to export the parts list data of single parts such as shapes and
plates. Since the KISS format only indirectly supports the group structure, you
can determine the belonging to a certain group by means of dispatch number,
but this is lost in case of similar parts in different groups because each part is
only exported once with its total amount.
Group Others
Customer
Here, you enter the variable header area data of the KISS-file.
947
Data Exchange
Group Annotation
Note
Group Surface
Surface
Switches
Input Field 1
Here you specify the format description for the name of the
part.
948
Data Exchange
Input Field 2
Here you specify the format description for the length of the
part.
BUTTON (X)
L
W
T
Units
c
i
m
Display
d
f
Accuracy
0..8 number of digits after the decimal point or parts of fraction (1/2n)
Thus, the format variable ($Lif3) means that the length of the part is exported
in inches with fraction display and an accuracy of 1/8 inch, e.g. 10-3/8.
If you require e.g. the specification of a plate with the thickness in inches as
fraction (with an exact accuracy of 1/16 inch) as well as with metric dimensions
for width and length having each one digit after the decimal point in the form
PL3/4x200.0 or for the length 300.0, you have to set the default
PL($Tif4)x($Wmd1) in the first input field and the default ($Lmd1) in the
second input field.
949
Data Exchange
CIMSteel/2-Interface
The CIMSteel/2 interface is an internationally used exchange format of structural
analysis and production data which is supported by many other programs as an
industrial standard.
File Format: ASCII text file with the extension *.stp
Data Import
ProSteel can evaluate the CAD system data of standard shapes and plates, i.e.
the position of the component parts in the space including detailing processes
such as drill holes or cuts.
In addition, the structural analysis system for standard shapes can be read, i.e.
the position of the component parts in the space including the eccentricities.
ProSteel can automatically differentiate between the different types of
CIMSteel/2.
Data Export
ProSteel can export the CAD system data of standard shapes and plates,
including detailing processes such as drill holes or cuts.
In addition, the structural analysis system for standard shapes can be written. In
the export dialog, you can previously select whether the complete CAD data
have to be exported or only the structural analysis system.
950
Data Exchange
Degree of Implementation
The implementation corresponds to CIM Steel Integration Standards Release 2.
The file format is according to standard ISO 10303-21:94 (with the entity
definition according to LPM6).
ProSteel can export 3 different types of CIMSteel/2 data models with the entity
definition on certain levels.
Static Data (Analysis Model)
Gusset points of standard shapes including eccentricities, cross-sections of
shapes and material.
CAD-Data (Design Model)
Position and length of standard shapes, outer geometry of sheet metal plates,
cross-sections of shapes and material
Manufacturing Data (Manufacturing Model)
Position and length of standard shapes, outer geometry of sheet metal plates,
cross-sections of shapes, material, volume properties (e.g. drill holes, oblong
holes, intersections)
951
Data Exchange
D.7.8
Previous Interfaces
In the following chapter, you will find the description of the interfaces, which
have already been integrated, in ProSteel for quite some time. They cannot or
not yet be controlled via the common import and export dialog. You can reach
these interfaces by their own command names and each single interface has its
own user control, which often differs from the others.
This does not mean that the used file format corresponds to an outmoded state.
The content of the data is always on the latest passed version of the standard
committees. All these formats have proved their worth in practice and are
intensively used there.
952
Data Exchange
Title Block Data Here, the title block data of the data records 1 through 5 of the
PPS file are defined.
Work No.
Enter the work no. (max. 2 digits). It will appear in data record
No. 1 of the PPS file.
Order No.
Enter the order no. (max. 8 digits). It will appear in data record
no. 2 of the PPS file.
Drawing No.
953
Data Exchange
Index
Prepared by
Output Weight
Output Area
Accord. to DSTV The order of the panels is according to the DSTV standards.
Apart from this, you can determine yourself the order by
entering the values 1-27 in the input fields under Panel Order.
Material=Name+ the name of the component part is set in front of the material
name.
Header
Bolt Quality
Separator
Point at Dec.Val. If this field has been checked, a point is used for decimal
values instead of the comma.
Insert NC-Dat..
Without Group
Title Block
Here you find the optional fields of the drawings title block.
They will all appear in data record no. 9.
Revision Index
Group
Name
954
Data Exchange
Surface
Surface finish
Addition %
Prepared by
TB-Date
Input of TB-date
Approval
Approved
Test Eng.
Order
Output path of the file. Specify the path and the name of the
PPS data output file via the left button. PPS-file name and
path can be freely defined by the user. If possible, it should
contain the order number and a drawing number.
Output of PPS-file is started.
The material designations correspond to the standard names for data transfer of
steel construction issued in August 1993 (2nd. edition).
955
Data Exchange
Hints for Transfer to Knierim
Since the Knierim system cannot process different groups of components
having the same main part as pos. no. 12.1 or12A, these groups require special
handling. In such cases, use the option 25=Max+1 at positioning.
Thus you obtain different position numbers for such cases. The Knierim system
will accept these numbers without any problem since they are handled as Zparts. If you want all component groups to be handled as Z-parts, turn off the
option Transfer Mainpart Group and enter a start value for group positioning.
956
Data Exchange
Example for the Output of a PPS-File
************************************************************
** PPS-DATA FILE created by ProSteel PPS-MODUL V 1.00**
**
** Time 13:49
** Date 25. 7.1996
**
************************************************************
0&@
1&11
2&2222222
4&33&3
5&gggg
9&&&&&&&&&&&
S&M 16 x 70 DIN 6914&70&40&5000&6&&&&&&&&&&&&&&&&&&&1
H&FL 120x20&315&120&11&2&&&&&&&&&&&& 18.876&&&&&6&&1
H&BRFL 160x15&239&160&14&2&&&&&&&&&&&& 18.876&&&&&4&&1
H&BLECH 8x791x864&864&790&8&1&&&&&&&&&&&& 26.187& 0.416&&&&&&1
H&IPE 240&3481&120&4&1&&&&&&&&&&&& 30.700&&&&&&&1
H&BRFL 240x15&309&240&12&2&&&&&&&&&&&& 28.314&&&&&2&&1
H&BLECH 8x488x499&499&488&10&2&&&&&&&&&&&& 7.661& 0.122&&&&&&1
H&BRFL 160x10&698&160&9&2&&&&&&&&&&&& 12.584&&&&&&&1
H&BRFL 200x10&1030&200&6&1&&&&&&&&&&&& 15.730&&&&&&&1
H&BLECH 10x84x95&95&84&18&4&&&&&&&&&&&& 0.423& 0.005&&&&&&1
S&M 16 x 60 DIN 6914&60&30&5001&12&&&&&&&&&&&&&&&&&&&1
H&BLECH 10x95x168&168&94&15&2&&&&&&&&&&&& 0.423& 0.005&&&&&&1
H&BLECH 10x65x114&114&65&17&4&&&&&&&&&&&& 0.247& 0.003&&&&&&1
H&BRFL 200x10&985&200&7&1&&&&&&&&&&&& 15.730&&&&&&&1
H&BRFL 200x10&280&200&13&1&&&&&&&&&&&& 15.730&&&&&4&&1
H&HE 200 A&3850&200&2&1&&&&&&&&&&&& 42.300&&&&&9&&1
H&IPE 240&4317&120&1&1&&&&&&&&&&&& 30.700&&&&&&&1
H&HE 140 A&580&140&5&1&&&&&&&&&&&& 24.700&&&&&1&&1
H&FL 140x20&152&140&16&1&&&&&&&&&&&& 22.022&&&&&4&&1
S&M 16 x 45 DIN 7990&45&20&5002&4&&&&&&&&&&&&&&&&&&&
957
Data Exchange
This interface can read and process data as described herein. Please note that
the format mentioned previously does not give port definitions. Only the correct
shapes can be entered in the defined position.
Herein, the bi-directional information flow of the static
CAD
static is
described. At the very moment, only the flow static CAD has been
implemented.
Import File
Export File
System Lines
All system lines being defined by the data are created. They
are filed in the layer PS_RAHMEN.
Insert Shapes
Connect Elements This option activates optimizing. Shapes of the same type
and of same position are combined in a way that a shape has
maximum length.
958
Data Exchange
959
Data Exchange
960
Data Exchange
NC-Data Output
After you have created your 3D model and performed a positioning
(prerequisite), you may generate your NC data. This is done with the ProSteel
menu option OTHERS / NC DATA GENERATION or by using the
PS_NC_DATA command.
The following dialog box appears after the command has been selected:
Format
Order No.
Here you enter the max.12 digits of the order number, which
will later be the first entry in the parts description header in the
NC file.
Drawing No.
Overwrite
961
Data Exchange
Straight End
Sign
3D Cuts
3D Holes
Metric Output
Upper Edge Mod.The output is arranged in a way that the parts are situated as
in the model, i.e. the upper edge is at the top, no matter of the
parts ECS position.
Insert ProSteel
The ProSteel header is inserted into the file. There you will
find information about date, etc.
Max. Hole Offset Here, you can indicate a maximum distance of the hole center
to the outer edges of the part (reference area) to the inside, up
to which a hole is still assigned to this view. This may be
important for special shapes.
Shapes as Acis Shapes are converted into an ACIS-model before output.
Plates as Acis
Powder Lines
The powder lines of the tight fitting add-on parts are created
for main parts.
INSERT
Click on this button to start the NC-output. You are prompted to select the
parts for which the NC-data have to be generated. After all parts have
been selected, the parts structure is analysed and the corresponding data
records of the NC-file are generated.
962
Data Exchange
Sign
Position No.
Send No.
Job No.
Drawing No.
Label
Note
After Input
The text of the input field is entered into the signature text.
Position
Text Size
Input Field
963
Data Exchange
DXF Options
You can specify the layer names and the colours for the DXF-output of plates.
Contour Layer
Contour Colour
Hole Colour
Text Layer
Text Colour
Line1/2
Any additional text which is written into the output file (Bottom
corner on the left of output); wildcards may be used. The list of
wildcards is as follows:
964
Data Exchange
%DAY%
%MONTH%
%YEAR%
%HOUR%
%MINUTE%
%DWG_PROJECT_NAME%
%DWG_ORDER_NAME%
%DWG_PROJECT_NUMBER%
%DWG_ORDER_NUMBER%
%DWG_DRAWING_NAME%
%DWG_DRAWING_NUMBER%
%DWG_DRAWING_INDEX%
%DWG_CREATED_NAME%
%DWG_CREATED_DATE%
%DWG_CHECKED_NAME%
%DWG_CHECKED_DATE%
%DWG_CLEARED_NAME%
%DWG_ CLEARED _DATE%
%DWG_LVPOS1%
%DWG_LVPOS2%
%DWG_LVPOS3%
%DWG_LVPOS4%
%DWG_COMMENT1%
%DWG_COMMENT2%
%DWG_COMMENT3%
%DWG_COMMENT4%
%DWG_CUSTOMER%
%DWG_DRAWING_PAGE%
Group name
Comment 1
Comment 2
Position number
Shipping number
Article number
Number of groups
Overall number
Family class
Group weight
complete group length
complete group width
complete group height
965
Data Exchange
966
Data Exchange
%KLEMMLEN%
%MOUNTINGBOLT%
%ORIGIN%
%XAXIS%
%YAXIS%
%ZAXIS%
%GROUPREL%
%MODIFYFLAG%
Text Height
DXF-Output as 2D
The exported geometry is exported as plane contour.
All z-coordinates of the geometry are reset to 0 at output.
The option Use Arcs and Lines instead of Polyline serves for
division of polylines into arcs and lines at output.
967
Data Exchange
Output Path
File Appendix
Define how the annex to your files has to look like(.nc, .output,
...)..
Use Drawing
Put P first
968
Data Exchange
All files in the indicated directory are deleted when you click
on this button.
This function creates a block in the drawing from a NC-file.
Only outer contour and drill holes are created. Without outer
contour, no drill holes will be created.
492.48o
492.48o
969
Data Exchange
970
Appendix
972
E.1
973
Dimensions
Width
Length
Height
Riser
Upper Insertion Point If this field is checked, the insertion point is on the upper
side of the staircase instead of on the lower side (and it is
running to the bottom)
Riser Count
Angle
Treading real
Actual Rise
The resulting exact rise of the steps; however, you can specify
a fixed value before and the construction will be calculated
again based on this value.
Dynamic
974
Landings
Lower Landing
The length of the lower stair head. to create the stair head,
you have to check the input field in front of it. Otherwise, the
staircase cheeks are cut at the basic plane and the stair head
is omitted.
Upper Landing
975
Vertical Section Enter a vertical cut from the front edge of the staircase cheek.
This field is only available if no length was specified for the
staircase foot, i.e. if the staircase cheek directly hits the basic
plane.
Ground Distance Here, you can insert a gap between the staircase foot and the
basic plane, e.g. to have enough space for a completing
construction or for foundations. This field is only available if no
length was specified for the staircase foot, i.e. if the staircase
cheek directly hits the basic plane.
Web Grating
Side Offset
Platforms
976
Platform No.
Angle to prev.
If you enter an angle here, you can create the bent running of
the staircase or stair heads for change over (180). Negative
values create an opposite sense of rotation.
Length, Height... Please refer to the figure below for exact meaning of the
distances.
Here you see the most important dimensions of a staircase with intermediate
stair heads and stair heads for change over (standard version):
977
Shapes
Shape Type etc. Here, you select the shapes for the stair and the stair head
cheeks.
Bolts
978
Drill Stringer
Bolt .../Handrail
If this field is checked, the cheeks and the handrail are bolted,
if a handrail exists. Select the required bolt type in the
selection list.
Bolt .../Step
If this field is checked, the cheeks and the steps are bolted.
Select the required bolt type in the selection list.
Steps
Create Steps
Increment
b,c,d
Hole Distance
Hole Dia.
Slot Length
Offset
The offset of the staircase steps from the front edge of the
staircase to the back. Negative values move the steps to the
front.
Handrail
Start Offset
Here, you enter an offset value which moves the start of the
handrail from the front edge of the staircase to the back.
Negative values move the handrail to the front. In case of
staircases without basic stair head, you can move the start of
the handrail to a position where a bolt mounting is possible.
End Offset
Side Offset
Here, you enter an offset value that moves the handrail from
the outer edge of the staircase to the outside. This permits you
to mount the handrail outside the staircase on other shapes or
on the wall.
Height Offset
Here, you enter an offset value that moves the handrail from
the upper edge of the staircase cheek to the top. This permits
you to attach a grout or an individual fastening.
980
Connection
Side Offset
Hand. Template Select the template to be used for the handrail in the selection
list. This template describes the exact structure.
Click this button to preset the handrail structure (shapes,
distances, etc.) or to edit the used handrail template.
Another dialog opens then which is identical with the structural
element Handrail. Thus you can refer to this dialog for further
information.
At staircases with handrail, this handrail will be created as
structural element of its own. This permits you to construct
and modify the handrail in detail independent of the staircase.
981
Work Frame
Created Views
Group Name
Edge Distance
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is
possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the
component part and then select the settings.
982
E.2
This function creates a winding stair as a spiral stair or with outer and inner
strings including a banister rail
All you need to do is click on the Center of the spiral stair and on a point on the
Starting line of the stair (footfall edge). The number of stairs required will
automatically be calculated from your inputs.
A dialog subsequently appears in which you can define your settings under
direct screen control. The dimensions of the stairs can be subsequently
changed by distorting the (yellow) object frame via its handles.
Since a spiral staircase including banisters is a complex construction, the use of
structural elements is currently to be seen in the fields of overviews and
visualization. All of the construction information required has not yet been taken
into consideration.
Here on the left you can see a spiral staircase with strings on both sides and on
the right a spiral staircase with central struts. Both stairs are each represented
without banisters.
983
Dimensions
Design
Direction of rotation
Here you specify whether the direction of
rotation of the stairs is clockwise or anticlockwise. A clockwise
spiral climbs in an anticlockwise direction.
Outer radius
The distance of the outer string from the center of the spiral.
Inner radius
The distance of the inner string from the center of the spiral (if
available).
Gradient
Total angle
Here you input the total sum of the rotational angles of the
spiral. Should you require 2 full turns, for instance, input 720
here.
Step angles
Here you input the horizontal step angles of the stairs, which
refers to the respective distance from the front edge.
984
Step angle overhang Here you input the overlapping angle of the stairs, i.e.
an enlargement or decrease in the stair size. Positive values
increase the size of the steps, negative values decrease the
step size whereby the front edge remains constant
Dynamic
Lower overhang
Here you input the value by which the length of the central
struts on the underside (beginning of the spiral) is to be
changed. Positive values lengthen the struts, while negative
values shorten them
Upper overhang Here you input the value by which the length of the central
struts on the upper side (end of the spiral) is to be changed.
Positive values lengthen the struts, while negative values
shorten them.
Create foot plate
A foot plate is added to the central strut, but the strut is not
shortened in the process.
The diameter of the holes in the foot plate. If you input the
value "0", there are no holes made in the foot plate.
>Hole distance width The distance between the holes in the direction of the
plate width.
> Hole distance height The distance between the holes in the direction of the
plate length.
Profiles
Assembly
Profile type
Profile class
Profile size
Vertical
Horizontal
Angle
The profiles of the outer and inner strings are the same, so
changes to the outer string have an impact on the inner string.
986
Steps
Create steps
Grouping
Height difference
Here you input the footfall height of the first step from ground
level to the upper edge of the step.
987
Plate thickness
Bending radius
The inner radius of the fold, should any front or back edge
length be given.
The length of the front fold (this refers to the straight piece of
the inner edge).
The lengths of the back edge (this refers to the straight piece
of the inner edge).
Straight outer edge The outer edge of the step is designed as a straight edge
(string of the arch). Otherwise this is adjusted to the radius of
the spiral.
Open at the top
The fold of the step occurs towards the upper side of the step.
Enable banisters If this field is selected, the steps are drilled on the outer side to
take the banister posts.
> Number of posts
> Diameter
> Distance from front edge The distance of the post hole from the front edge of the
step (in radian measure).
988
> Spacing
> Height difference The distance of the banister posts from the upper edge of the
step.
Step width
Angular extension
The outer edge of the step is bigger than the inner edge by
this value, creating an angular stair.
b,c,d
Hole spacing
Hole diameter
The distance of the axis of the back oblong holes of the stairs.
Indent
The offset of the stair steps from the front edge of the step
backwards. Negative values push the step forwards.
989
The outer edge of the step is designed as a bent edge and adapted to the
radius of the spiral. Otherwise this is designed as a straight edge (string of
the arch).
Banister
Inner banister
Outer banister
Simplified display The banisters are not fully modeled, but only represented as
system lines.
Banister connection Here you input how the banister should be screwed to the stair
strings.
Automatic - The program tries to determine the most
convenient mounting.
Perpendicular - The banister is always screwed onto the stair
string from above, regardless of the specification in the
banister template used.
Laterally -The banister is always screwed onto the stair string
laterally, regardless of the specification in the banister
template used.
Individual The specification from the banister template is
used.
990
Side offset
Here you input an offset that pushes the banister from the
outer edge of the step outwards. So you can also mount the
banister outside the stair on other profiles or on the wall.
Height offset
Here you input an offset that pushes the banister from the
upper edge of the stair string upwards in order to be able to
attach a lining or an individual mounting, for example.
Side spacing
Banister template
991
Screws
If this field is selected, the stair strings are drilled so that the
stair steps can be screwed on.
Screw string/Step If this field is selected, strings and steps are screwed. You can
select the type of screw desired from the selection list.
Drill strings for banister If this field is selected, the stair strings are drilled so that the
banister can be screwed on.
Screw strings / banister If this field is selected, strings and banister are screwed, if
a banister exists. You can select the type of screw desired
from the selection list.
Assignment
As in every dialog, once the parts are created you also have the option to make
all assignments for each individual profile directly. To do this, select the part and
choose the setting.
992
Options
Data path
Input the complete path to the block files here, if you wish to
use stairs from user blocks.
993
994
E.3
Generalities
Layout
Dynamic
995
Draw Diagonal
No Auto-Update
Group Status
Group Name
For more detailed information about the group structure, please refer to the
section about workshop drawings in this chapter.
Dimensions
Connection Height
Railing Height
996
Handrail Radius
Thickening Dia.
997
Post Distance
Post Spacing
Post Distance
Maximum
Edge Offset
998
Offsets
Posts Inside
If this field is checked, the end posts are moved to the inside.
The post distances in the first and last segment are decreased
by the value specified for the offset of the railing head.
Start Offset
End Offset
Here you can individually determine start and end offset of the
different shapes if the option Keep All Equal has been
deactivated.
999
Segments
Create Segments
Length maximum... The indicated length is the maximum length of a segment and
mustnt be exceeded.
Segment Length
Gap
Distribution
Group Status
Group Name
For more detailed information about the group structure, please refer to the
section about workshop drawings in this chapter.
End form
1000
Radius
1001
Combine with
Radius
Close
1002
Shapes
Here you can select the shapes for the individual sections of the handrail.
However, the corresponding section is generated only if checked appropriately
in the check box.
For example, if you would like to generate a handrail with only two knee-high
guardrails, then deactivate one of the three options for knee-high guardrails. In
the selection lists you can select the required shape as usual. All shapes are
available for selection.
Click on the button to copy the default settings of another component part into
the current selection. A small dialog opens where you can select the source.
Thus it is e. g. possible to synchronize the settings for all knee-high guardrails.
Comp.Part Group
Shape Class
Shape Size
Shape Type
Insertion Plane
Angle
Mirror
BUTTON +
1003
Other Side
Side Offset
You specify the distance of outer edge of railing post and inner
edge of baseboard. This permits you to keep some space for
individual fastenings or grouts.
Height Offset
The distance between the drawn polyline and the lower edge
of baseboard. Negative values will move the baseboard
towards the bottom.
1004
Min. Segment Length The minimum segment length (distance from one post to the
other) from which on filler rods will be created.
Edge Distance
The distance between the center of the first and last filler rod
and the center of the corresponding handrail post
Intermediate Distance The distance of the center of two filler rods; this value can be
corrected depending on the segment length.
Distance Top
The distance between the filler rods and the upper insertion
position.
Distance Bottom
The distance between the filler rods and the lower insertion
position.
Insertion Offset
Filler rod offset from insertion plane towards the front or back
side.
Insertion from
Here you select at which position the filler rods start (upper
insertion position).
Insertion up to
Here you select at which position the filler rods end (lower
insertion position).
Insertion Position
Here you select the depth position of the filler rods towards the
knee-high guardrails. You can choose between front edge,
center and rear edge.
1005
Cut at
If Collision
1006
Posts
You can taper the post on top or bottom by means of cuts in order to reach a
better adaptation to the base plate or to the handrail.
Top horizontal
Top vertical
determines the vertical length of the two cuts at the upper end
of the post.
Bottom horizontal
Bottom vertical
determines the vertical length of the two cuts at the lower end
of the post.
1007
Post Connection
Here you select the fastening of the handrail posts. If None is checked, no
fastening will be provided. If Vertical is checked, the plates will be perpendicular
to the post (base plates). If Lateral is checked, plates or bent connections will be
welded to the outside of the post.
Layout
Outside
For Diagonals
Plate Layout
1008
Projection Side
Plate Wiidth
Plate Length
Plate Thickness
Hole Dia
w (horizontal)
w (vertical)
Side Offset
Start Radius
As Poly-plate
Turn by 90
Plate Connections
for Handrail Posts
1009
Post Post-Handrail
Here you select how to connect the different handrail posts with the handrail.
Depending on selection, you can describe the connection in a more detailed
way by means of further parameters.
Layout
Gap Distance
Cover Thickness
Cover Diameter
1010
Layout
Gap Distance
Here you enter an additional distance between post and kneehigh guardrail if you have selected the Straight Cut or
Complex Cut option.
Hole Diameter
Here you enter the diameter of the drill hole in the post if you
have selected the Drill option.
1011
Blocks
Apart from the parametrical construction, you can build the handrail by using
user-defined blocks. Different blocks are available for the post variants (e. g.
beginning, end, corners) and fillings.
You will find all necessary settings on this page and on the subordinate dialog
tabs. Partly they are identical with those of parametrical construction.
For more detailed information about selection and distribution of user-defined
blocks, please refer to section Working with User-defined Blocks in this
chapter.
Between Posts
Block Directory
1012
The settings on this dialog tab correspond to the post distribution of parametrical
construction. Please refer to this tab for more detailed information.
Blocks Segments
1013
Blocks Posts
Selection Lists
Here you select the block which has to be used for the
corresponding post variant.
Group Status
Group Name
1014
Blocks Fillings
Filling
Here you select the block to be used for the filling of the
handrail.
Width Adaptation
Here you specify how to adapt the inserted block of the filling
in longitudinal direction to the current space between two
posts.
Leave The block is not modified.
Stretch Across Center The block is stretched from the center
to the left and to the right side.
Stretch Poportionally All elements of the filling are regularly
stretched proportionally.
Dynamic All, Start... The elements are stretched dynamically
within the indicated borders and multiplied. You can choose
whether the length has to be balanced at the beginning, at the
end or at beginning and end.
Group Status
Group Name
1015
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is
possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the
component part and then select the settings.
1016
Posts
Posts are inserted at any possible corner and intermediate points of the polyline. You can specify different blocks for start, end and the straight intermediate
points of the poly-line. In addition, you can determine different blocks for rightangled corners (+90 and -90 each) and for the angles deviating from this
(positive and negative as well).
However, only one deviating intermediate angle is possible. You could use
corners of 45 beside the right-angled corners for your handrail, but not corners
of 45 and 30 at the same time.
The neighboring figure shows the selection of
the different post blocks.
You see the beginning (1) and the end (2) of
the poly-line as well as the intermediate post
(3). The corner post (4) is a +90 corner, the
corner post (5) is a -90 corner, corresponding
to the UCS and the running direction of the
poly-line. .
For all other angles the corner rotating in
positive direction (6) or the corner rotating in
negative direction (7) is selected.
1017
Fillings
The special characteristic of fillings is the fact that the distance between the
assigned posts is not known at definition.
To avoid having to define an own block for each possible distance, the elements
are adapted to the current dimension by means of the options Stretch/Upset and
Move. In addition, filling elements which once were defined can be regularly
multiplied by means of dynamic distribution.
A twisted filler rod has e. g. to be modelled only once to arrange it in a grid of
100-110 mm in the handrail segments.
The filling has to be defined in the WCS as well. The positive z-axis corresponds
to the height of the handrail. At insertion, the positive x-axis is always aligned
towards the running direction of the corresponding poly-line segment. The origin
(0, 0, 0) of the WCS lies in the middle of the block.
1018
1019
Example
The following example shows the possibilities of handrail construction with userdefined blocks and dynamic distribution of filler rods.
Corner support 45
The different posts and the filling element are constructed in the block templates
and the filling element only contains the principle. At generation along the polyline it will be adapted to the current segment length. As it is only a matter of
corners of 90 and 45, the whole construction can be saved in a template and
be reproduced.
The neighboring figure shows the block of
the filling element in detail.
Since both filler rods alternate, they are
modelled
together, too. An
exact
distribution in a 150 mm grid including
length compensation at the beginning and
at the end of the segment is desired. This
is why you find two block attributes
FBSTART and FBEND each on the right
and left side of the bars (with the input
demand MIN and MAX=150). The filler
rods and spheres have the code FB and in
the drill holes of the upper butt straps you
will find the block attributes DP1 and DP2
for the adaptation to the posts.
The posts also have such butt straps with
the same attributes in the drill holes of the
butt straps for fixation.
1020
The possible 2D-detailing of a whole assembly shows how the filling element is
placed between the different posts.
1021
1022
E.4
This function generates a hangar frame from two support members and two
crossbars, which can be connected to one another in different ways.
This requires that you click on the outer edge insertion point of the left and right
vertical frame members.
This is followed by a dialog where you can set the specifications while verifying
your input directly and immediately on screen. The dimensions of the frame can
be changed at a later time by modifying the (yellow) object frame using its grips.
Dimensions
Width
Ridge Width
Enter the roof ridge width into this field if you have selected an
asymmetrical hangar frame.
Centre Height
Dynamic
Symmetrical
Draw Diagonal
Box Frames
Left Eave Height Here, you indicate the left eaves height of the crossbars.
Right Eave Height Here, you indicate the right eaves height of the crossbars.
Top Side Base
Specify the distance of the supports from floor level (the pick
points of the supports) required to add base plates.
Left Column Offset Here, you indicate the projection of the left support upper
edge beyond the height of the eaves.
Right Column Offset Here, you indicate the projection of the right support
upper edge beyond the height of the eaves.
Left Roof Angle Here, you indicate the roof pitch of the left crossbar. Changing
the value will affect the ridge height of the roof.
Right Roof Angle Here, you indicate the roof pitch of the right crossbar.
Changing the value will affect the ridge height of the roof.
Shapes
This dialog tab is used to select the corresponding shapes for the left and right
vertical frame members as well as the crossbars. If you have selected a
symmetrical hangar frame, the values specified for the left side are applied to
the right side.
Which Shape
Here, you can select the shape the settings have to be applied
to. Please note that at Symmetrical setting, the right shapes
cannot be set because the values of the left shapes are
applied to them.
Shape Type
Here, you select the shape type (normal, special shapes, etc.)
Shape Class
Shape Size
1024
Alignment
1025
Attachment
Free Plate
Align As is
1026
Apex
This dialog tab is used to select the connection type for joining crossbars at the
ridge point.
Attachment
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too, you have
the possibility to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. To do
this, select the component part and then select the settings to be applied.
1027
1028
E.5
This function generates a truss girder from the upper and lower cord as well as
the diagonals and many existing intermediate studs. Upper and lower cords can
also be generated from two side-by-side shapes.
This requires that you click on the left and right outer edge of the truss girder,
which then adds the truss to the current plane of the user coordinate system.
This is followed by a dialog where you can set the specifications while verifying
your input directly and immediately on screen. The dimensions of the binder can
be changed at a later time by modifying the (yellow) object frame using its grips.
Dimensions
Type
Layout
Length
Height
Roof Angle
1029
Side Height
Outer Distance
Inner Distance
Segment Dist.
The spacing of the shapes, if, for example, upper and lower
cords are generated from two side-by-side (U-shaped)
shapes.
Shapes
Shape Offset
Shape Type
Shape Class
Shape Size
1030
Front/Back
Distances
Top Chord
The distance of the upper cord at the rim from the outer edge
of the roof truss (represented with the object frame).
The distance of the upper cord in the center of the roof truss
centerline
Bottom Chord
The distance of the lower cord at the rim from the outer edge
of the roof truss (represented with the object frame).
Top Diagonal
Bottom Diagonal The distance of the diagonal from lower cord, if, e.g.,
connective plates are to be inserted.
Fit Shape Ends
Top Vertical
1031
Bottom Vertical
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is
possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the
component part and then select the settings.
1032
E.6
Command Name:
PS_Pfette
This function generates a purlin course within a specified plane. For this, you
select the area to be filled by clicking on the left lower and the right upper
corner. The purlins are then inserted into this area with their lower edge flush
with the plane of the current user coordinate system.
An additional application consists of the possibility to insert secondary beams
(joists) within two main girders. For this purpose, you have to finish the input of
area at the first point using ESC. Then, you are prompted to enter the first main
girder, then the second one.
The dimensions for the purlin course then are defined by the end points of the
main girders. In addition, you have the possibility to connect them with each
other by means of a template.
This is followed by a dialog where you can set the specifications while verifying
your input directly and immediately on screen. The spacing of the purlin course
can be changed at a later time by modifying the (yellow) object frame using its
grips. Diagonals are possible as well.
1033
General
Angle
The purlins are rotated around this angle value, which means
they are arranged in a diagonal fashion.
Height Offset
Dynamic
Symmetrical
Draw Diagonal
Cut at Edge
1034
Dimensions
Fixed Grid
Free Grid
If the Grid field is not checked, you can freely define the grid
division within the area between the first and last purlin in the
Distances list. You can vary the number and the distance, as
you like.
Turn
Offset Bottom
Offset Top
Offsets Fixed
1035
Offset Left
Offset Right
Shapes
Selection Lists
Here, you can select the desired shape as usual; all shapes
are available for selection.
Position
Mirror
Rotation
Alternatively, you can also use a joist girder instead of a standard shape (see
structural element Joist Girder) the template of which can be selected on an
additional dialog tab.
1036
Border Lines
Cut Lines
Poly-cut
1037
Connections
If you have selected alternative insertion on the base of two main girders, the
following page will be displayed in addition:
Which Page
Here you select for which side the settings have to be valid.
You can define both sides simultaneously or each single side
individually.
No Connection
Cope
Connection
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is
possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the
component part and then select the settings.
1038
E.7
This function is used to create a ladder including its fastening at the wall. In
addition, you can add a safety cage to the ladder.
To do this, just click the left and right insertion point of the ladder and then the
height point (to determine the length) or any other point you like, if the length
has to be determined later.
Then a dialog opens where you can set the specifications by direct monitor
control. The ladder dimensions can be changed at a later time by modifying the
(yellow) object frame using its grips.
Dimensions
Width
Height
Riser
Actual Riser
Distance to Floor The distance between the upper edge of the first rung and the
ground area of the ladder.
1039
Top Distance
The distance between the upper edge of the last rung and the
climbing out surface of the ladder.
Offset
The height of the help for climbing out related to the climbing
out surface of the ladder (axis measure).
Stringer
Sharp Bend
The front jump-in of the help for climbing out (axis measure), if
it has to be created with a bend.
Dynamic
Diagonal
Fit Rungs
1040
Shapes
Selection Lists
0 Degree
You can rotate the shapes around their insertion axis here.
The upright shape can be rotated by increments of 90
whereas the rungs can be rotated by increments of 45.
Mirror
1041
Wall Mounting
You can add a wall fastening to the ladder here. The wall shape is, however,
only created if the Wall Shape field has been checked before.
In the Selection Lists, you can select the required shape as usual. All shapes
are available for selection.
0 Degree
You can rotate the wall shape around its insertion axis here by
checking the required angle.
Mirror
Position
Wall Distance
The distance between upright axes and wall surface where the
ladder has to be mounted.
Distance to Floor The distance between the axis of the first wall shape and the
ground area of the ladder.
Distance
1042
Top Distance
The distance between the axis of the last wall shape and the
climbing out area of the ladder.
Safety Cage
You can add a safety cage to the ladder here. The safety cage is only created if
the Safety Cage field has been checked before.
In the Selection Lists, you can select the required shape as usual. All shapes
are available for selection.
0 Degree
Here, you can rotate the shape around its insertion axis.
Mirror
Position
Here you can select the insertion position of the wall shape.
Inner Edge The wall shape is inserted at the inner edge of
the upright and shows to the inside.
Centrally The wall shape is inserted in axis position on the
height of upright axis.
Outer Edge The wall shape is inserted at the outer edge of
the upright and shows to the outside.
Radius
No. of Rungs
1043
Lower Radius
Lower Distance Specify the distance of the lowest shackle to the next shackle.
If you dont want to have a conical cage, you can keep the
value 0 in this field and in the lower radius field.
Depth etc.
Please refer to the below figure for the meaning of the other
distances.
Top Distance
1044
The lateral climbing out has to lead to the left, to the right or to
both sides.
Upper Distance The distance of the lateral climbing out to the upper upright of
the ladder.
Lower Distance The distance of the lateral climbing out to the upper edge of
the safety cage.
Extended Distance
The offset of the lateral climbing out in climbing out direction
beyond the dimensions of the safety cage.
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is
possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the
component part and then select the settings.
1045
1046
E.8
This function serves for creation of a joist as it is often used in the USA. This
joist is a pre-fabricated element in lightweight construction that is offered in
different executions and lengths.
Dimensions
Length
Height
Inner Distance
Calculate Spacing The inner distance is calculated for the vertical and
diagonal components based on the selected shapes.
Roof Angle
Continuous...
Seat Height
Seat Length
Here, you can define the length of the seats for both sides
separately.
Lower Retreat
Here, you can indicate the lower retreat referring to the upper
length for both sides separately.
Upper Shape Offset Here, you can indicate the upper shape offset above the
selected length for both sides separately.
1047
Lower Shape Offset Here, you can indicate the lower shape offset for both
sides separately.
Dynamic
2D Display
Layout
Layout
Here, you can select the kind of layout you want to have. 5
different types are available for selection:
Symmetrical The layout consists of upper and lower girder
as well as of vertical and diagonal shapes.
Single Lacing The layout consists of upper and ceiling joists
as well as of single bent intermediate beams.
Double Lacing - The layout consists of upper and ceiling joists
as well as of double bent intermediate beams.
Tension Rods Type1 - The layout consists of upper and ceiling
joists as well as of tension rods.
Tension Rods Type2 - The layout consists of upper and ceiling
joists as well as of tension rods.
1048
Distance A
Distance B
Distance C
The distance from the next to last maximum to the next to last
minimum.
Distance D
Distance E
Rounding Radius This indicates the rounding radius at the two lacing types.
Shapes
Shape Offset
Here, you select for which rod area the corresponding settings
have to be valid.
Shape Type
Shape Class
Shape Size
1049
Layout
Top Seats
Here, you specify the display and the design of the top seats. You can choose
between shapes, plates and seat sockets which can be determined by means of
parameters.
Due to the great number of different designs, it is, however, possible as well to
select the top seat as individual user block and to have designed it here.
Layout
Seat Length
Seat Width
Seat Thick
Insert Holes
Select this option if you want to insert a hole field into the seat.
At Length Direction Indicates the design of the hole field at length direction.
1050
In Cross Direction
Diameter
Workloose
Hole Distance
Down Seat
Here, you specify the display and the design of the down seats. For more
detailed information, please refer to the description of top seats.
1051
User-defined Blocks
You can design both seats and top and bottom chords as user-defined blocks.
In this case, no top or bottom chord shapes are generated, but your individual
blocks are inserted and resolved at the insertion position.
Upper Chords as Blocks You activate the insertion of upper chords as userdefined blocks.
Connect Shapes If this option has been activated, the corresponding shapes
if existing are connected with each other.
Left/Right
Here, you select the blocks for left and right side separately.
The same options are available for the selection of user-defined blocks for the
lower chord.
1052
Seat Blocks
If you have selected the top and down seats as blocks, you can select the
corresponding blocks here.
1053
Data
Here, you enter the general parts list data of the joist. They will be displayed in
the parts list.
Name
joist name
Item No.
Note1,2
Pos No.
Weight
Line Type
In Partlist
1054
Database
When a valid database has been entered in the options, you can choose a
previously defined joist from the available values.
Options
1055
Database
Assignments
As it is the case with each dialog creating component parts, here too it is
possible to carry out all assignments directly for each single shape. Select the
component part and then select the settings.
1056
E.9
1057
E.9.1 Shapes
Layout
On this dialog tab, you can modify the display of shapes individually. At
insertion, the shapes obtain the settings that were made and can be overwritten
individually.
Layout
Holes
Only Outer Cont. Only the first outer contour is displayed. At tubes, e.g., the
inner cylinder will not be displayed.
Modeller
The component part is displayed by means of the facetmodeler. Normally, the software independently decides when
the modeler has to be used for depiction. However, you can
explicitly define it using this option. If the modeler has to be
used, you cannot switch it off.
Acis
The ACIS-modeler is used for depiction instead of the facetmodeler. ACIS is much slower but more precise than the
facet-modeler. Please note that it is not possible to mix ACISand facet-modeller volume models.
2D Display
Center Line
1058
COG Line
Pitch Lines
If crack lines have been defined for this shape, they are
displayed.
Part Label
Short name
ECS Axes
Transparency
Direction marker If the component part has got a benchmark during detailing,
this will be displayed.
2D-Section
1059
Shape Type
Here, you can modify the shape type of one or several shapes.
Shape Type
Resolution
Shape Class
Shape Size
Treat As Singl If you have selected a combi shape or a weld shape, you can
specify whether the individual components have to be treated
as single parts. The same is valid if the shape has not yet
been exploded.
1060
Positions
Use this dialog tab to specify the insertion or reference axis. You can select the
desired points in the preview.
Select Line
X-Offset
X value of insertion
Y-Offset
Y value of insertion
Rotation Angle
+Phi
-Phi
+90
-90
1061
The insertion points are rotated and thus mirrored at the Yaxis.
A reference axis is added to the shape.
A reference axis is subtracted from the shape.
At Max. 2 reference points are added to the shape.
The reference points are subtracted from the shape.
Dimensioning points
This dialog page is used to manage the additional dimensioning points and
dimensioning references. Further information on work with dimensioning points
can be found in the description of the 2D detail style.
1062
Apply for
Views
Arrow buttons
If you would like to add a dimensioning or reference point, you will subsequently
be asked for the new point, which you must pick in the model. If you wish to
change or delete an existing point, select it by clicking on the point.
You define a reference area by picking two points in the model, which describe
the start and end of the area.
1063
Data
This dialog tab is used for management of non-graphical properties.
Name
Material
Note1
Note2
Pos No.
Shipping No.
Orig. Pos No
Item
Count
Total
Modified
Adopt
No Detail.
1064
Values
This dialog tab is used for management of non-graphical properties.
Length
Width
Height
Weight
Vol Weight
Addition
Number
Total
1065
Conical
Depending on the selected shape, this dialog tab can look different. This is the
dialog tab of a standard shape.
Slope
Show Cut
For weld shapes, the slope can also be defined via the climb. It is, however, also
possible to indicate starting and end height. In addition, some tools are available
to manipulate the cross-section or to realize a cross-section that changes
several times.
1066
Slope
Start Height
End Height
1067
Bottom Fl. Start The projection of the bottom flange at the starting point of the
shape is indicated.
Bottom Fl. End
Top Flange.Start
Top Flange. End The projection of the upper flange at the end point of the
shape is indicated.
This button permits the management of the flange thickness
table. Using this table, you can assign different widths and
thicknesses to individual segments of the shape.
The following dialog appears:
1068
Upper and bottom flange are considered separately. The indication of the flange
refers to the number of flanges from the starting point per side.
It is recommended to edit the thicknesses after having determined the bend
points. A modification of the form by insertion or deletion of points modifies the
table as well because the number of flanges is modified.
1069
Static View
If the static view has been activated in the global settings, the static values are
displayed in the dialog. For a more detailed description of the options please
refer to the chapter Static View.
Bend
If the selected shape is an arc shape, this dialog tab is additionally displayed.
Radius
Starting Angle
The angle between the x-axis of the ECS and the starting
point of the shape in degree
End Angle
The angle between the x-axis of the ECS and the end point of
the shape in degree.
Rotation
1070
Shortening
If the shape is displayed in 2D-mode, additional shortenings may have been
inserted into the shape. You can see these shortenings on this dialog tab.
1071
E.9.2 Plates
Layout
Use this dialog tab to modify the depiction of plates individually. At insertion, the
plates obtain the settings that were made and thus can be overwritten
individually.
Layout
Holes
Modeler
The component part is displayed by means of the facetmodeler. Normally, the software independently decides when
the modeler has to be used for depiction. However, you can
explicitly define it using this option. If the modeler has to be
used, you cannot switch it off.
Acis
The ACIS-modeler is used for depiction instead of the facetmodeler. ACIS is much slower but exacter than the facetmodeler. Please note that it is not possible to mix ACIS- and
facet-modeler volume models.
2D Display
Grid
Center Line
1072
Part Label
Short Name
ECS Axes
Transparency
Position
Use this dialog tab to specify the plate position related to the insertion point and
to the insertion plane.
Length
Width
Thickness
Plate thickness
Height Offset
Insert Edge
X-Offset
Y-Offset
1073
Rectangular
The rectangular basic form of the plate is kept, and you cannot
change it into another form using the grips. If this option is
deactivated, you cannot reset it.
Symbol Direction Size Specifies the size of the symbol direction on plate grids.
At most 2 reference points are added to the plate.
The reference points are subtracted from the plate.
Dimensioning points
This dialog page is used to manage the additional dimensioning points and
dimensioning references. Further information on work with dimensioning points
can be found in the description of the 2D detail style.
Apply for
1074
Views
Arrow buttons
If you would like to add a dimensioning or reference point, you will subsequently
be asked for the new point, which you must pick in the model. If you wish to
change or delete an existing point, select it by clicking on the point.
You define a reference area by picking two points in the model, which describe
the start and end of the area.
1075
Data
This dialog tab is used for management of non-graphical properties.
Name
Name
Material
Note1
Note2
Pos No
Ship.No.
Orig. Pos No
Item
Modified
In Partlist
No Detail.
Dont Position
1076
Values
This dialog tab is used for management of non-graphical properties.
Length
Width
Thickness
Weight
Vol Weight
Number
Total
Fixed Form
Man. Direction
Man. Surface
1077
E.9.3 Bolts
Layout
Use this dialog tab to modify the depiction of bolts individually. At insertion, the
bolts obtain the settings that were made and the selected bolt style; thus they
can be overwritten individually.
Layout
Coating
Modeller
The component part is displayed by means of the facetmodeler. Normally, the software independently decides when
the modeler has to be used for depiction. However, you can
explicitly define it using this option. If the modeler has to be
used, you cannot switch it off.
Acis
The ACIS-modeler is used for depiction instead of the facetmodeler. ACIS is much slower but exacter than the facetmodeler. Please note that it is not possible to mix ACIS- and
facet-modeler volume models.
2D Bolt
Mounting Space The assembly room is displayed as well. It mainly serves for
verifying whether an assembly is possible. Individually
specifies whether the mounting space has to be read out of
the bolt style.
1078
2D
Transparency
Countersunk
Bolt
Washer
Nut
Lock Nut
Tapered Washer The tapered washers are activated, but not displayed. They
serve as basis for the parts list entries. You can choose
between U- and I-form washers.
2
nd
Washer
nd
Tapered
1079
Data
Name
Material
Style
Note1
Note2
Pos No
Ship.No.
Item
Number
Total
Dont Position
1080
Values
Length
Bolt length
Dia
Bolt diameter
Grip Length
Weight
Addition
Modified
Adopt
Bolt
Washer
Nut
Safety Nut
The safety nut is listed in the parts list as single data record, if
desired.
Tapered Washer The tapered washer is listed in the parts list as single data
record, if desired.
2
nd
Washer
nd
Tapered
Pre-Tension
1082
Layout
Please refer to the section about the shapes for the individual descriptions of
these setting options.
Data
The parts list data of these component parts are identical with the parts
described until now. Please refer to the above chapters for the description of the
different fields.
1083
Values
The parts list values of these component parts are identical with the parts
described until now. Please refer to the above chapters for the description of the
different fields.
1084
In Bolt List
The special part at parts list output has to be adopted into the
bolt list. You can differ between mounting bolt and workshop
bolt.
PPS Z-Part
1085
E.9.6 Assemblies
Assemblies are separate objects in ProSteel. They serve for extending the
group structures. In contrast to groups and subgroups, they are not connected
with a main part and carry their group information themselves. The data are
managed as follows.
Layout
Sketch Size
2D
Indicates whether the assembly object is switched over to 2Dmode or not. This controls the depiction of the whole assembly
structure in the drawing.
1086
1087
E.9.9 Roof/Wall-Objects
Please refer to the corresponding chapter of this manual where the modification
of roof/wall-objects is described.
E.9.10
The properties of label objects such as position flags, elevations, weld marks,
manual dimensioning objects and benchmark can also be set specifically for
each component part.
E.9.11
Please refer to the corresponding chapters of this manual where the setting of a
drawing parts list and of a drawing containment list is described.
1088
E.9.12
3D Modifications
1089
Boolean Operations
Use this dialog tab to modify or delete the Boolean operations included in the
part.
Length
Width
Height
Operation
Type
Modeller
1090
Facet
Use this option to edit the chamfers included in the part. The dialog tab is
analogous to the Plate Editor. Please refer to this chapter for the description of
the different processing parameters.
1091
E.9.13
Flat Cuts
Use this dialog tab to process and delete flat cuts (diagonal cuts) included in the
component part.
Phi Dx
Phi Dy
1092
E.9.14
Poly-Cuts
On this dialog tab, all poly-cuts included in the part will be displayed.
Length
Offset
1093
E.9.15
Edge Processing
Here, you can modify the edge properties of plates. Please refer to the
corresponding chapter in this manual for the settings.
1094
E.9.16
Notches (Outlets)
Use this dialog tab to modify the properties of the currently selected notch.
Length
Width
Depth
1095
E.9.17
Common Properties
In this section, you will find a description of the general parts properties. The
properties described here are not always completely available, but are only
displayed if required.
Group
On this dialog tab the data of the group/subgroup/assembly are listed to which
the component part in question belongs.
1096
Logical Links
On this dialog tab, the logical links of the part are listed.
Active
Index
Link Type
Modification
Name
Ident
1097
1098
Assignments
Use this dialog tab to make the assignments to the drawing object. These
assignments may differ from one part to the other. They are however described
in the corresponding chapters.
Detail Style
Display
Area Class
Here, you can assign the part to an area class that you
created before.
Parts Family
Here, you can assign the part to a part family (e. g. support or
girder).
Process-Status
1099
1100
Chapter
Command Name
C.16
PS_CUT_OUT
B.11
PS_MODIFY
Add 3D-Volume
B.11.7
PS_ADD
B.8.5
PS_ADD_SECTION
Area Classes
B.5.4
PS_AREA_CLASS
Automatic 2D-Cut
C.18
PS_ADD_2DCUT
Benchmark
C.6
PS_BENCHMARK
B.9.4
PS_PLATE
BlockCenter
D.2
PS_BLOCKCENTER
Bolts
B.14
PS_BOLT
Bracings
B.24
PS_VERBAND
Bracings, dynamic
B.23
PS_BRACING
Butt-Joint Connection
B.20
PS_LASCHE
D.5.2
PS_WEIGHTCENTER
B.12.2
PS_CHAMFER
Circular Stairs
E.2
PS_CIRCULAR_STAIRS
Clean AutoCAD-Drawing
D.5.6
PS_CLEAN_PROXY
D.5.6
PS_BATCH_CLEAN_DWG
Collision Check
D.5.1
PS_COLLISION
2D
2D-Cut Out
3D
3D-Modifications
A
1101
Connection-Editor
B.26
PS_EDIT_CONNECTIONS
Construction Lines
B.2.1
PS_CONST
Containlist
B.32
PS_DWG_CONTAINLIST
Convert ADT-Shapes
D.5.7
PS_CONVERT_ADTSHAPES
Cranked 2D-Cut
C.5
PS_CRANKEDVIEW
Create ACIS-Solid
D.5.5
PS_CREATE_ACIS
D.5.5
PS_BATCH_CREATE_ACIS
Create 3D-Cone
B.10
PS_SOLID_CONE
B.10
PS_SOLID_CONICPIPE
B.10
PS_SOLID_RECT2CIRCLE
Create 3D-Cuboid
B.10
PS_SOLID_BOX
Create 3D-Cylinder
B.10
PS_SOLID_CYLINDER
B.10
PS_SOLID_EXTRUDE
B.10
PS_SOLID_ROTATE
Create 3D-Solid
B.10
PS_SOLID_HULL
Create 3D-Sphere
B.10
PS_SOLID_SPHERE
Create 3D-Torus
B.10
PS_SOLID_TORUS
Cut Plane
B.3.6
PS_CUTPLANE
Data Export
D.7.5
PS_EXPORT
Data Import
D.7.4
PS_IMPORT
DetailCenter
C.1
PS_DETCENTER
Dimensioning Points
C.7
PS_INSERT_MANDIM
D.4
PS_DISPATCH
Display Pickhelpers
C.1.6
PS_PICKHELPER
A.1.2
PS_VERSION
Drawing Information
B.29
PS_DWG_INFO
Drawing Frame
C.10
PS_FORMAT
Drawing Partslist
B.31
PS_DWG_PARTLIST
1102
B.13
PS_DRILL
DSTV NC-Interface
D.7.8
PS_NC_DATA
DSTV PPS-Interface
D.7.8
PS_PPS
DSTV Static-Interface
D.7.8
PS_STATIK
D.7.2
PS_EXCHANGE_MAP
Elevations
C.13
PS_KOTE
Endplates
B.16
PS_ENDPLATE
Face UCS
B.3.2
PS_FACE_UCS
Face View
B.3.2
PS_FACE_VIEW
Family Classes
B.5.5
PS_FAMILY_CLASS
Flatten Viewport
C.19
PS_VIEWPORT_FLATTEN
Free View
B.3.5
PS_FREEVIEW
Global Settings
A.6
PS_GLOBAL_SETTINGS
Global Scale
C.9
PS_SCALE
Global View
B.3.3
PS_GLOBAL_VIEW
Groundplates
B.17
PS_GROUNDPL
Groups
B.27
PS_GROUP
Gusset Plates
B.22
PS_GUSSET_PLATE
Hatches
B.25
PS_VOUTE
Hide
B.5.1
PS_HIDE
Hide Exclude
B.5.1
PS_HIDE_EXCLUDE
B.5.1
PS_HIDE_EXCLUDE_PLANE
B.5.1
PS_HIDE_GROUP_EXCLUDE
1103
Hide Group
B.5.1
PS_HIDE_GROUP
Hide Plane
B.5.1
PS_HIDE_PLANE
Hole Display
C.17
PS_HOLE_DISPLAY_STYLE
Insert Gratings
B.9.3
PS_PLATE
Insert Plates
B.9
PS_PLATE
Insert Shapes
B.8
PS_INS_PROF
Intersection 3D-Volume
B.11.7
PS_COMMEN
Language Selection
A.2
PS_LANGUAGE
Layer Functions
B.1
PS_LAYER
Manual 2D-Cut
C.11
PS_MAN_CUT
Manual 2D-Shortening
C.15
PS_SHORT2D
C.8
PS_MANUAL_LINK
Manual Dimensioning
C.12
PS_DIM
Measure Distance
B.2.2
PS_CONST_MSE
B.4
PS_COPY
B.11.6
PS_NOTCH
Object View
B.3.1
PS_OBJ_VIEW
Object-UCS
B.3.1
PS_OBJ_UCS
Outlet
B.11.1
PS_OUTLET
Perspective View
B.3.7
PS_PERSP
Plate Editor
B.12
PS_PLATE_EDITOR
Positioning
B.28
PS_POS
Process Partlist
B.30.2
PS_CREATE_PARTLIST
N
Notch
O
1104
Project Management
A.5
PS_PROJECT
Process Status
B.5.6
PS_PROCESS_STATUS
Purlin Connection
B.21
PS_PURLIN_CONN
Regenerate
B.5.2
PS_REGEN
RevisionCenter
D.6
PS_REVISIONCENTER
D.3
PS_ROWADISPATCH
B.12.2
PS_BEND_EDGE
Search Parts
B.5.7
PS_SEARCH
Seize Partslist
B.30.1
PS_PARTLIST
Shear Plates
B.19
PS_SCHEARPLATE
Simulate Movement
D.5.4
PS_KINEMATIK
Special Parts
D.1.1
PS_CREATE_SPEZPART
Special Shapes
D.1.2
PS_CREATE_SOPRO
D.6
PS_ANALYSIS
Stiffeners
B.15
PS_RIP
E.7
PS_JOIST
E.4
PS_TRUSS
E.2
PS_HANDRAIL
E.3
PS_FRAME
E.5
PS_PFETTE
E.6
PS_LADDER
E.1
PS_STAIRS
Subtract 3D-Volume
B.11.7
PS_SUB
B.11.7
PS_COMMEN_SUB
Top View
B.3.4
PS_TOPVIEW
Tubes Unwind
D.5.3
PS_UNWIND
1105
V
Visibility Classes
B.5.3
PS_HIDE_CLASS
Webangle
B.18
PS_STEGW
Weldmarks
C.14
PS_WELD
Workframe Views
B.7
PS_SETBKS
Workframes
B.6
PS_WORKFRAME
1106